b5c07d55db69d0c2abbd92cd2f1b8a79357977c9
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3121
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 .code
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 .endd
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3143 .code
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 .endd
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151 &%authenticators%&.
3152
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159 .vitem &%-bp%&
3160 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 .code
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174 .endd
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3184
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194 complete.
3195
3196
3197 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3198 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202 of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3206 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3214 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3230 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237 .vitem &%-brt%&
3238 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 .code
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 .endd
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 .code
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260 .endd
3261
3262 .vitem &%-brw%&
3263 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272 .vitem &%-bS%&
3273 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306 .vitem &%-bs%&
3307 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3315
3316 In
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325 .cindex "inetd"
3326 The
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3334
3335 .vitem &%-bt%&
3336 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350 security issues.
3351
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357 program.
3358
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368 always shown.
3369
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 message,
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379 doing such tests.
3380
3381 .vitem &%-bV%&
3382 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398 .vitem &%-bv%&
3399 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418 security issues.
3419
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432 to succeed.
3433
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438 The
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3450 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453 might happen.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bw%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457 .cindex "daemon"
3458 .cindex "inetd"
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513 configuration file.
3514
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542 synonymous:
3543 .code
3544 exim -DABC ...
3545 exim -DABC= ...
3546 .endd
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549 example:
3550 .code
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 .endd
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3821 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3824 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3825
3826 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3827 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3830 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3831 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3832 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3833 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3834
3835 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3836 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3839 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3840 connection.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3843 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3844 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3845 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3846 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3847
3848 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3849 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3850 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3851 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3852 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3853 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3854 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3855 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3856 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3857 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3858 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3859 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3860 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3861 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3862 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3863
3864 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3865 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3866 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3867 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3868 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3869 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3870 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3871 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3872 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3873 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3876 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3877 .cindex "freezing messages"
3878 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3879 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3880 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3881 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3882 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3883 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3884 user.
3885
3886 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3887 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3888 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3889 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3890 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3891 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3892 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3893 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3894 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3895 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3896 user.
3897
3898 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3899 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3900 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3901 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3902 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3903 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3904 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3905
3906 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3907 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3908 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3909 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3910 .cindex "removing recipients"
3911 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3912 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3913 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3914 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3915 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3916 can be used only by an admin user.
3917
3918 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3919 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3920 .cindex "removing messages"
3921 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3922 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3923 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3924 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3925 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3926 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3927 placed on the queue.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3930 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3931 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3932 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3933 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3934 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3935 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3936 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3937 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3938 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3939 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3940
3941 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3942 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3943 .cindex "thawing messages"
3944 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3945 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3946 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3947 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3948 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3949 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3950 by an admin user.
3951
3952 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3953 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3954 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3955 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3956 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3957 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3958
3959 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3960 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3961 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3962 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3963 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3964 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3965 only by an admin user.
3966
3967 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3968 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3969 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3970 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3971 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3972 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3973 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3974
3975 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3976 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3977 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3978 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3979 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3980 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3981
3982 .vitem &%-m%&
3983 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3984 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3985 treats it that way too.
3986
3987 .vitem &%-N%&
3988 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3989 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3990 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3991 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3992 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3993 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3994 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3995 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3996 than &"=>"&.
3997
3998 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3999 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4000 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4001 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4002 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4003 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4004 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4005 for that message.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-n%&
4008 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4010 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4011 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4012
4013 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4014 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4015 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4016 Exim.
4017
4018 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4019 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4020 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4021 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4022 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4023 description above.
4024
4025 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4026 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4027 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4028 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4029 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4030 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4031 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4032 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4033
4034 .vitem &%-odb%&
4035 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4036 .cindex "background delivery"
4037 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4038 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4039 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4040 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4041 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4042 processes to finish.
4043
4044 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4045 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4046 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4047 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4048
4049 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4050 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4051 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4052 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4053
4054 .vitem &%-odf%&
4055 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4056 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4057 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4058 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4059 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4060 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4061 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4062
4063 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4064 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4065 during deliveries.
4066
4067 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4068 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4069
4070 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4071 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4072 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4073 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4074
4075
4076 .vitem &%-odi%&
4077 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4078 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4079 Sendmail.
4080
4081 .vitem &%-odq%&
4082 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4083 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4084 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4085 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4086 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4087 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4088 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4089 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4090 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4091 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4092 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4093 forces queueing.
4094
4095 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4096 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4097 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4098 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4099 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4100 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4101 configuration file is in effect.
4102
4103 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4104 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4105 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4106 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4107 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4108 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4109 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4110 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4111 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4112 &%-qq%& option.
4113
4114 .vitem &%-oee%&
4115 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4116 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4117 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4118 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4119 message.
4120
4121 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4122 Provided
4123 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4124 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4125 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4126 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4127
4128 .vitem &%-oem%&
4129 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4130 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4131 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4132 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4133 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4134 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4135
4136 .vitem &%-oep%&
4137 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4138 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4139 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4140 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4141 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4142 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4145 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4148 effect as &%-oep%&.
4149
4150 .vitem &%-oew%&
4151 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4152 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4153 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4154 effect as &%-oem%&.
4155
4156 .vitem &%-oi%&
4157 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4158 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4159 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4160 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4161 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4162 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4163 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4164
4165 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4166 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4167 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4170 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4171 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4172 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4173 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4174 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4175 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4176 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4177
4178 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4179 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4180 .code
4181 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4182 .endd
4183 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4184 followed by a colon and the port number:
4185 .code
4186 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4187 .endd
4188 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4189 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4190 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4191 whichever one is last.
4192
4193 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4194 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4195 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4196 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4197 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4198 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4199 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4200 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4201
4202 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4203 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4204 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4205 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4206 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4207 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4208 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4209 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4210
4211 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4212 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4213 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4214 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4215 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4216 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4217 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4218 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4219 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4220 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4221
4222 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4223 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4224 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4225 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4226 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4227 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4228 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4229
4230 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4231 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4232 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4233 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4234 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4235 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4236 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4237 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4238 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4239
4240 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4241 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4242 is sending the bounce.
4243
4244 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4245 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4246 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4247 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4248 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4249 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4250 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4251 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4252 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4253 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4254 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4255 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4256
4257 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4258 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4259 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4260 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4261 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4262 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4263 uses the name it is given.
4264
4265 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4266 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4267 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4268 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4269 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4270 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4271 used, when there is no default.
4272
4273 .vitem &%-om%&
4274 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4275 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4276 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4277 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4278 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4279
4280 .vitem &%-oo%&
4281 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4282 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4283 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4284 whatever that means.
4285
4286 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4287 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4288 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4289 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4290 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4291 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4292 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4293 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4294 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4295
4296 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4297 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4298 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4299 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4300 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4301 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4302 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4303
4304 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4305 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4306 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4307 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4308 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4309 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4310 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4311 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4312
4313 .vitem &%-ov%&
4314 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4315 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4318 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4319 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4321 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4322 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4323 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4324 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4325 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4326 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4327
4328 .vitem &%-pd%&
4329 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4330 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4331 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4332 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4333 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4334 needed.
4335
4336 .vitem &%-ps%&
4337 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4338 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4339 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4340 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4341 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4342 started.
4343
4344 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4345 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4346 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4347 .display
4348 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4349 .endd
4350 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4351 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4352 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4353 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4354 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4355
4356 .vitem &%-q%&
4357 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4358 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4359 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4360 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4361 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4362 and &%-S%& options).
4363
4364 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4365 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4366 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4367 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4368 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4369 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4370
4371 If
4372 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4374 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4375 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4376 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4377 proceeding.
4378
4379 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4380 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4381 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4382 this to be repeated periodically.
4383
4384 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4385 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4386 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4387 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4388
4389 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4390 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4391 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4392
4393 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4394 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4395 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4396 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4397
4398 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4399 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4400 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4401 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4402 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4403 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4404 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4405 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4406 transports are run.
4407
4408 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4409 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4410 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4411 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4412 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4413 delivered down a single SMTP
4414 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4416 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4417 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4418 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4419 intermittently.
4420
4421 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4422 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4423 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4424 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4425 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4426 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4427 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4428
4429 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4430 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4431 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4432 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4433 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4434 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4435 their retry times are tried.
4436
4437 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4438 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4439 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4440 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4441 frozen or not.
4442
4443 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4444 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4445 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4446 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4447 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4448 for later delivery.
4449
4450 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4451 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4452 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4453 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4454 starting message id. For example:
4455 .code
4456 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4457 .endd
4458 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4459 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4460 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4461 .code
4462 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4463 .endd
4464 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4465 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4466 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4467 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4468 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4469 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4470
4471 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4472 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4473 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4474 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4475 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4476 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4477 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4478 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4479 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4480 .code
4481 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4482 .endd
4483 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4484 process every 30 minutes.
4485
4486 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4487 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4488
4489 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4490 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4491 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4492 compatibility.
4493
4494 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4495 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4496 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4497
4498 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4500 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4501 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4502 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4503 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4504 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4505 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4506 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4507
4508 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4509 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4510 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4511 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4512 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4513 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4514
4515 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4516 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4517 .code
4518 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4519 .endd
4520 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4521 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4522 applied to each queue run.
4523
4524 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4525 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4526 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4527 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4528 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4529 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4530 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4531 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4532 address will be skipped.
4533
4534 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4535 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4536 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4537 &'ff'& is present.
4538
4539 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4540 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4541 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4542 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4543 an arbitrary command instead.
4544
4545 .vitem &%-r%&
4546 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4547 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4548
4549 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4550 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4551 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4552 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4553 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4554 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4555 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4556 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4557
4558 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4559 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4560 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4561 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4562 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4563
4564 .vitem &%-t%&
4565 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4566 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4567 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4568 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4569 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4570 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4571 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4572 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4573 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4574 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4575
4576 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4577 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4578 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4579 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4580 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4581 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4582 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4583 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4584 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4585 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4586 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4587
4588 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4589 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4590 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4591 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4592 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4593 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4594
4595 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4596 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4597 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4598 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4599 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4600 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4601 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4602 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4603 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4604
4605 .vitem &%-ti%&
4606 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4607 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4608 compatibility with Sendmail.
4609
4610 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4611 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4612 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4613 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4614 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4615 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4616 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4617 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4618
4619
4620 .vitem &%-U%&
4621 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4623 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4624 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4625 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4626 set. Exim ignores this option.
4627
4628 .vitem &%-v%&
4629 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4630 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4631 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4632 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4633 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4634 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4635 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4636 unconditional.
4637
4638 .vitem &%-x%&
4639 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4640 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4641 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4642 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4643 this option.
4644
4645 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4646 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4647 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4648 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4649
4650 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4651 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4652 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4653 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4654 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4655 under most shells.
4656 .endlist
4657
4658 .ecindex IIDclo1
4659 .ecindex IIDclo2
4660
4661
4662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4663 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4664 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4665 . creates a man page for the options.
4666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4667
4668 .literal xml
4669 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4670 .literal off
4671
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4678
4679
4680 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4681 "The runtime configuration file"
4682
4683 .cindex "run time configuration"
4684 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4685 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4686 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4687 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4688 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4689 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4690 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4691 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4692 control.
4693
4694 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4695 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4696 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4697 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4698 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4699 actually alter the string.
4700
4701 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4702 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4703 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4704 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4705 existing file in the list.
4706
4707 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4708 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4709 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4710 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4711 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4712 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4713 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4714 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4715 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4716 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4717 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4718
4719 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4720 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4721 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4722 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4723 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4724
4725 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4726 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4727 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4728 compromise the Exim user account.
4729
4730 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4731 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4732 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4733 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4734 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4735 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4736 configuration.
4737
4738
4739
4740 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4741 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4742 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4743 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4744 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4745 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4746 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4747 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4748 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4749 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4750 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4751
4752 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4753 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4754 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4755 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4756 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4757 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4758 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4759 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4760 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4761 &%-M%&).
4762
4763 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4764 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4765 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4766 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4767 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4768
4769 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4770 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4771 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4772 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4773 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4774 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4775
4776 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4777 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4778 necessarily be discarded.
4779 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4780 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4781 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4782 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4783 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4784 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4785
4786 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4787 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4788 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4789 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4790 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4791 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4792 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4793
4794 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4795 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4796 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4797
4798
4799
4800 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4801 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4802 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4803 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4804 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4805 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4806 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4807 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4808
4809 .ilist
4810 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4811 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4812 .next
4813 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4814 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4815 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4816 .next
4817 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4818 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4819 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4820 .next
4821 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4822 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4823 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4824 .next
4825 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4826 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4827 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4828 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4829 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4830 .next
4831 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4832 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4833 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4834 .next
4835 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4836 want to use this feature, you must set
4837 .code
4838 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4839 .endd
4840 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4841 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4842 .endlist
4843
4844 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4845 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4846 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4847 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4848
4849 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4850 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4851 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4852 and does not introduce a comment.
4853
4854 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4855 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4856 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4857 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4858 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4859
4860 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4861 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4862 change settings as required.
4863
4864 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4865 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4866 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4867 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4868 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4869 described.
4870
4871
4872
4873 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4874 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4875 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4876 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4877 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4878 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4879 using this syntax:
4880 .display
4881 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4882 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4883 .endd
4884 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4885 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4886 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4887 name is required.
4888
4889 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4890 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4891 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4892 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4893
4894 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4895 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4896 for example:
4897 .code
4898 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4899 .include /some/file
4900 .endd
4901 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4902 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4903 inclusion appears.
4904
4905
4906
4907 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4908 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4909 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4910 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4911 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4912 definition, and must be of the form
4913 .display
4914 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4915 .endd
4916 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4917 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4918 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4919 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4920 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4921
4922 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4923 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4924 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4925
4926 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4927 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4928 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4929 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4930 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4931 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4932 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4933 define
4934 .display
4935 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4936 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4937 .endd
4938 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4939 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4940 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4941 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4942 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4943 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4944
4945
4946 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4947 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4948 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4949 &'='&. For example:
4950 .code
4951 MAC = initial value
4952 ...
4953 MAC == updated value
4954 .endd
4955 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4956 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4957 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4958 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4959 .code
4960 MAC = initial value
4961 ...
4962 MAC == MAC and something added
4963 .endd
4964 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4965 from a number of other files.
4966
4967 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4968 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4969 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4970 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4971 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4972 file to be ignored.
4973
4974
4975
4976 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4977 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4978 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4979 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4980 .code
4981 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4982 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4983 .endd
4984 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4985 .code
4986 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4987 .endd
4988 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4989 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4990 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4991
4992
4993 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4994 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4995 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4996 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4997 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4998 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4999 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5000
5001 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5002 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5003 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5004 line. Thus:
5005 .code
5006 .ifdef AAA
5007 message_size_limit = 50M
5008 .else
5009 message_size_limit = 100M
5010 .endif
5011 .endd
5012 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5013 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5014 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5015 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5016 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5017
5018 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5019 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5020 in this line"& will always be true.
5021
5022 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5023 to clarify complicated nestings.
5024
5025
5026
5027 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5028 .cindex "common option syntax"
5029 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5030 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5031 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5032 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5033 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5034 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5035 space) and then the value. For example:
5036 .code
5037 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5038 .endd
5039 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5040 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5041 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5042 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5043 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5044 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5045 word &"hide"&. For example:
5046 .code
5047 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5048 .endd
5049 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5050 .code
5051 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5052 .endd
5053 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5054 all instances of the same driver.
5055
5056 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5057 that are found in option settings.
5058
5059
5060 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5061 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5062 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5063 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5064 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5065 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5066 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5067 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5068 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5069 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5070 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5071 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5072 .code
5073 queue_only
5074 queue_only = true
5075 .endd
5076 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5077 .code
5078 no_queue_only
5079 queue_only = false
5080 .endd
5081 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5082
5083
5084
5085
5086 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5087 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5088 .cindex "format" "integer"
5089 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5090 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5091 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5092 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5093 hexadecimal number.
5094
5095 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5096 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5097 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5098 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5099 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5100 used.
5101
5102
5103 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5104 .cindex "integer format"
5105 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5106 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5107 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5108 Such options are always output in octal.
5109
5110
5111 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5112 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5114 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5115 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5116
5117
5118
5119 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5120 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5121 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5122 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5123 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5124
5125 .table2 30pt
5126 .irow &%s%& seconds
5127 .irow &%m%& minutes
5128 .irow &%h%& hours
5129 .irow &%d%& days
5130 .irow &%w%& weeks
5131 .endtable
5132
5133 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5134 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5135 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5136
5137
5138
5139 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5140 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5141 .cindex "format" "string"
5142 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5143 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5144 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5145 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5146 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5147 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5148 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5149 therefore equivalent:
5150 .code
5151 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5152 trusted_users = uucp:\
5153 # This comment line is ignored
5154 mail
5155 .endd
5156 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5157 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5158 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5159 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5160 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5161
5162 .table2 100pt
5163 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5164 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5165 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5166 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5167 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5168 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5169 character"
5170 .endtable
5171
5172 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5173 character, that character replaces the pair.
5174
5175 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5176 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5177 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5178 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5179 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5180 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5181
5182
5183 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5184 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5185 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5186 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5187 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5188 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5189 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5190 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5191 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5192 within a quoted configuration string.
5193
5194
5195 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5196 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5197 .cindex "format" "user name"
5198 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5199 .cindex "format" "group name"
5200 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5201 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5202 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5203 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5204
5205
5206 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5207 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5208 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5209 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5210 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5211 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5212 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5213 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5214 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5215 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5216 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5217
5218 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5219 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5220 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5221 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5222 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5223 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5224 example, the list
5225 .code
5226 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5227 .endd
5228 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5229
5230 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5231 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5232 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5233 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5234
5235 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5236 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5237 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5238 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5239 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5240 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5241 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5242 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5243 .code
5244 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5245 .endd
5246 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5247 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5248 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5249
5250 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5251 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5252 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5253 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5254 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5255 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5256 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5257 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5258 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5259 .code
5260 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5261 .endd
5262 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5263 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5264 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5265 the value in quotes. For example:
5266 .code
5267 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5268 .endd
5269 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5270 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5271 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5272 enclosing an empty list item.
5273
5274
5275
5276 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5277 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5278 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5279 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5280 .code
5281 senders = user@domain :
5282 .endd
5283 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5284 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5285 items, the second of which is empty:
5286 .code
5287 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5288 .endd
5289 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5290 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5291 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5292 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5293 .code
5294 senders = :
5295 .endd
5296 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5297 is at the end of the list.
5298
5299
5300
5301
5302 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5303 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5304 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5305 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5306 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5307 a sequence of lines like this:
5308 .display
5309 <&'instance name'&>:
5310 <&'option'&>
5311 ...
5312 <&'option'&>
5313 .endd
5314 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5315 followed by three options settings:
5316 .code
5317 localuser:
5318 driver = accept
5319 check_local_user
5320 transport = local_delivery
5321 .endd
5322 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5323 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5324 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5325 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5326 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5327 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5328
5329 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5330 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5331
5332 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5333 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5334 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5335 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5336 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5337 server.
5338
5339 .cindex "generic options"
5340 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5341 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5342 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5343 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5344 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5345 .cindex "private options"
5346 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5347 they all have default values.
5348
5349 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5350 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5351 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5352
5353 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5354 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5355 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5356 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5357 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5358 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5359 configuration lines:
5360 .code
5361 remote_smtp:
5362 driver = smtp
5363 .endd
5364 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5365 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5366 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5367 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5368 thus:
5369 .code
5370 special_smtp:
5371 driver = smtp
5372 port = 1234
5373 command_timeout = 10s
5374 .endd
5375 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5376 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5377 lines.
5378
5379 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5380 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5381 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5382 option.
5383
5384
5385
5386
5387
5388
5389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5391
5392 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5393 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5394 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5395 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5396 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5397 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5398 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5399 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5400 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5401 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5402 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5403
5404
5405
5406 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5407 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5408 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5409 the line
5410 .code
5411 # primary_hostname =
5412 .endd
5413 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5414 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5415 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5416 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5417
5418 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5419 .code
5420 domainlist local_domains = @
5421 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5422 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5423 .endd
5424 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5425 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5426 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5427 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5428
5429 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5430 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5431 on the local host.
5432
5433 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5434 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5435 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5436 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5437 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5438 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5439
5440 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5441 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5442 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5443 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5444 domain is permitted.
5445
5446 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5447 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5448 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5449 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5450 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5451 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5452
5453 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5454 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5455 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5456
5457 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5458 .code
5459 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5460 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5461 .endd
5462 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5463 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5464 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5465 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5466 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5467 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5468 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5469 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5470 contents of a message to be checked.
5471
5472 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5473 .code
5474 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5475 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5476 .endd
5477 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5478 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5479 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5480 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5481
5482 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5483 .code
5484 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5485 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5486 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5487 .endd
5488 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5489 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5490 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5491 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5492 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5493 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5494 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5495
5496 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5497 .code
5498 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5499 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5500 .endd
5501 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5502 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5503 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5504 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5505 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5506 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5507 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5508 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5509 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5510 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5511 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5512 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5513 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5514 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5515 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5516 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5517
5518 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5519 .code
5520 # qualify_domain =
5521 # qualify_recipient =
5522 .endd
5523 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5524 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5525 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5526 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5527 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5528 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5529
5530 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5531 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5532 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5533 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5534 .code
5535 # allow_domain_literals
5536 .endd
5537 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5538 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5539 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5540 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5541 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5542 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5543
5544 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5545 .code
5546 never_users = root
5547 .endd
5548 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5549 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5550 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5551 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5552 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5553 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5554 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5555 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5556
5557 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5558 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5559 line,
5560 .code
5561 host_lookup = *
5562 .endd
5563 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5564 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5565 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5566 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5567 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5568 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5569 unreachable.
5570
5571 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5572 1413 (hence their names):
5573 .code
5574 rfc1413_hosts = *
5575 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5576 .endd
5577 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5578 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5579 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5580 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5581 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5582 information, you can change this.
5583
5584 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5585 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5586 .code
5587 prdr_enable = true
5588 .endd
5589
5590 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5591 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5592 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5593 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5594 .code
5595 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5596 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5597 .endd
5598 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5599 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5600
5601 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5602 over the default:
5603 .code
5604 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5605 +tls_certificate_verified
5606 .endd
5607
5608 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5609 .code
5610 # percent_hack_domains =
5611 .endd
5612 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5613 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5614 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5615
5616 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5617 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5618 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5619 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5620 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5621 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5622 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5623 always bounce messages.
5624 .code
5625 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5626 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5627 .endd
5628 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5629 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5630 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5631 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5632 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5633
5634
5635
5636 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5637 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5638 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5639 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5640 It starts with the line
5641 .code
5642 begin acl
5643 .endd
5644 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5645 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5646 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5647
5648 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5649 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5650 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5651 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5652 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5653 result of the ACL processing.
5654 .code
5655 acl_check_rcpt:
5656 .endd
5657 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5658 ACL, and names it.
5659 .code
5660 accept hosts = :
5661 .endd
5662 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5663 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5664 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5665 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5666 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5667 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5668
5669 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5670 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5671 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5672 manner.
5673 .code
5674 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5675 domains = +local_domains
5676 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5677
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = !+local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5681 .endd
5682 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5683 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5684 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5685 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5686 in Internet mail addresses.
5687
5688 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5689 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5690 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5691 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5692 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5693 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5694 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5695 policy of being as safe as possible.
5696
5697 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5698 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5699 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5700 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5701 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5702 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5703
5704 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5705 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5706 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5707 have to modify this rule.
5708
5709 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5710 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5711 common convention of local parts constructed as
5712 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5713 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5714 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5715 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5716 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5717 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5718
5719 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5720 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5721 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5722 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5723 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5724 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5725 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5726 .code
5727 accept local_parts = postmaster
5728 domains = +local_domains
5729 .endd
5730 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5731 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5732 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5733 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5734 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5735
5736 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5737 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5738 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5739 .code
5740 require verify = sender
5741 .endd
5742 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5743 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5744 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5745 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5746 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5747 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5748 discusses the details of address verification.
5749 .code
5750 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5751 control = submission
5752 .endd
5753 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5754 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5755 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5756 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5757 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5758 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5759 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5760 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5761 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5762 .code
5763 accept authenticated = *
5764 control = submission
5765 .endd
5766 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5767 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5768 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5769 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5770 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5771 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5772 .code
5773 require message = relay not permitted
5774 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5775 .endd
5776 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5777 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5778 .code
5779 require verify = recipient
5780 .endd
5781 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5782 fails, the address is rejected.
5783 .code
5784 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5785 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5786 # $dnslist_text
5787 # dnslists = black.list.example
5788 #
5789 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5790 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5791 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5792 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5793 .endd
5794 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5795 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5796 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5797 line.
5798 .code
5799 # require verify = csa
5800 .endd
5801 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5802 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5803 records.
5804 .code
5805 accept
5806 .endd
5807 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5808 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5809 .code
5810 acl_check_data:
5811 .endd
5812 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5813 of this ACL are commented out:
5814 .code
5815 # deny malware = *
5816 # message = This message contains a virus \
5817 # ($malware_name).
5818 .endd
5819 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5820 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5821 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5822 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5823 .code
5824 # warn spam = nobody
5825 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5826 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5827 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5828 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5829 .endd
5830 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5831 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5832 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5833 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5834 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5835 whatever the spam score.
5836 .code
5837 accept
5838 .endd
5839 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5840
5841
5842 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5843 .cindex "default" "routers"
5844 .cindex "routers" "default"
5845 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5846 by the line
5847 .code
5848 begin routers
5849 .endd
5850 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5851 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5852 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5853 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5854 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5855 .code
5856 # domain_literal:
5857 # driver = ipliteral
5858 # domains = !+local_domains
5859 # transport = remote_smtp
5860 .endd
5861 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5862 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5863 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5864 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5865 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5866 .code
5867 dnslookup:
5868 driver = dnslookup
5869 domains = ! +local_domains
5870 transport = remote_smtp
5871 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5872 no_more
5873 .endd
5874 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5875 domains. This is specified by the line
5876 .code
5877 domains = ! +local_domains
5878 .endd
5879 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5880 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5881 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5882 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5883 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5884 passed on to the following routers.
5885
5886 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5887 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5888 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5889 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5890 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5891
5892 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5893 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5894 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5895 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5896 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5897 the address fails and is bounced.
5898
5899 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5900 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5901 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5902 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5903 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5904 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5905 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5906 out.
5907 .code
5908 system_aliases:
5909 driver = redirect
5910 allow_fail
5911 allow_defer
5912 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5913 # user = exim
5914 file_transport = address_file
5915 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5916 .endd
5917 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5918 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5919 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5920 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5921 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5922 the next router.
5923
5924 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5925 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5926 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5927 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5928 .code
5929 userforward:
5930 driver = redirect
5931 check_local_user
5932 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5933 # local_part_suffix_optional
5934 file = $home/.forward
5935 # allow_filter
5936 no_verify
5937 no_expn
5938 check_ancestor
5939 file_transport = address_file
5940 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5941 reply_transport = address_reply
5942 .endd
5943 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5944 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5945 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5946 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5947 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5948 namely:
5949 .code
5950 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5951 # local_part_suffix_optional
5952 .endd
5953 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5954 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5955 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5956 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5957 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5958 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5959 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5960
5961 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5962 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5963 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5964 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5965
5966 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5967 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5968 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5969 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5970 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5971 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5972 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5973
5974 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5975 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5976 There are two reasons for doing this:
5977
5978 .olist
5979 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5980 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5981 unnecessary work.
5982 .next
5983 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5984 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5985 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5986 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5987 this time.
5988 .endlist
5989
5990 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5991 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5992 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5993 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5994
5995 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5996 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5997 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5998 .code
5999 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6000 .endd
6001 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6002 transport.
6003 .code
6004 localuser:
6005 driver = accept
6006 check_local_user
6007 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6008 # local_part_suffix_optional
6009 transport = local_delivery
6010 .endd
6011 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6012 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6013 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6014 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6015 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6016
6017
6018 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6019 .cindex "default" "transports"
6020 .cindex "transports" "default"
6021 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6022 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6023 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6024 .code
6025 begin transports
6026 .endd
6027 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6028 .code
6029 remote_smtp:
6030 driver = smtp
6031 hosts_try_prdr = *
6032 .endd
6033 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6034 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6035 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6036 It is negotiated between client and server
6037 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6038 All other options are defaulted.
6039 .code
6040 local_delivery:
6041 driver = appendfile
6042 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6043 delivery_date_add
6044 envelope_to_add
6045 return_path_add
6046 # group = mail
6047 # mode = 0660
6048 .endd
6049 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6050 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6051 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6052 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6053 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6054 show how this can be done.
6055
6056 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6057 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6058 similarly-named options above.
6059 .code
6060 address_pipe:
6061 driver = pipe
6062 return_output
6063 .endd
6064 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6065 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6066 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6067 be returned to the sender.
6068 .code
6069 address_file:
6070 driver = appendfile
6071 delivery_date_add
6072 envelope_to_add
6073 return_path_add
6074 .endd
6075 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6076 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6077 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6078 .code
6079 address_reply:
6080 driver = autoreply
6081 .endd
6082 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6083 filter files.
6084
6085
6086
6087 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6088 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6089 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6090 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6091 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6092 introduced by the line
6093 .code
6094 begin retry
6095 .endd
6096 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6097 errors:
6098 .code
6099 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6100 .endd
6101 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6102 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6103 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6104 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6105
6106 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6107 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6108 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6109
6110
6111 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6112 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6113 .code
6114 begin rewrite
6115 .endd
6116 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6117 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6118
6119
6120
6121 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6122 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6123 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6124 .code
6125 begin authenticators
6126 .endd
6127 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6128 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6129 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6130 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6131 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6132 to support most MUA software.
6133
6134 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6135 .code
6136 #PLAIN:
6137 # driver = plaintext
6138 # server_set_id = $auth2
6139 # server_prompts = :
6140 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6141 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6142 .endd
6143 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6144 .code
6145 #LOGIN:
6146 # driver = plaintext
6147 # server_set_id = $auth1
6148 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6149 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6150 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6151 .endd
6152
6153 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6154 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6155 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6156 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6157 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6158 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6159 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6160 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6161
6162 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6163 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6164 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6165 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6166
6167 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6168 usercode and password are in different positions.
6169 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6170
6171 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6172
6173
6174
6175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6177
6178 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6179
6180 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6181 .cindex "PCRE"
6182 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6183 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6184 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6185 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6186 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6187 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6188
6189 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6190 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6191 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6192 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6193 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6194 case-insensitive.
6195
6196 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6197 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6198 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6199 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6200 .code
6201 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6202 .endd
6203 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6204 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6205 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6206 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6207 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6208 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6209 matched.
6210
6211 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6212 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6213 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6214 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6215 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6216 match anywhere in the subject string.
6217
6218 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6219 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6220 .code
6221 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6222 .endd
6223 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6224 You need to use:
6225 .code
6226 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6227 .endd
6228 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6229 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6230
6231
6232
6233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6235
6236 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6237 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6238 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6239 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6240 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6241 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6242
6243 .olist
6244 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6245 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6246 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6247 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6248 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6249 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6250 .next
6251 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6252 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6253 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6254 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6255 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6256 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6257 .endlist
6258
6259 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6260 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6261 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6262 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6263 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6264 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6265
6266 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6267 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6268 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6269 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6270 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6271 .code
6272 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6273 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6274 .endd
6275 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6276 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6277 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6278 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6279 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6280 .code
6281 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6282 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6283 .endd
6284 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6285 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6286
6287 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6288 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6289 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6290 .code
6291 domain1:
6292 domain2:
6293 .endd
6294 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6295 matches the list item.
6296
6297 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6298 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6299 .code
6300 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6301 .endd
6302 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6303 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6304 causes a second lookup to occur.
6305
6306 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6307 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6308 lookup is permitted.
6309
6310
6311 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6312 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6313 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6314 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6315
6316 .ilist
6317 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6318 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6319 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6320 .next
6321 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6322 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6323 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6324 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6325 .endlist
6326
6327 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6328 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6329 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6330 .code
6331 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6332 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6333 .endd
6334 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6335 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6336 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6337
6338
6339
6340
6341 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6342 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6343 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6344 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6345
6346 .ilist
6347 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6349 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6350 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6351 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6352 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6353 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6354 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6355 be found in several places:
6356 .display
6357 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6358 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6359 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6360 .endd
6361 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6362 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6363 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6364 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6365 .next
6366 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6367 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6368 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6369 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6370 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6371 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6372 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6373
6374 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6375 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6376 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6377 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6378 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6379 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6380 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6381 .next
6382 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6383 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6384 .cindex "sasldb2"
6385 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6386 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6387 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6388 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6389 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6390 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6391 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6392 .next
6393 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6394 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6395 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6396 .cindex "Courier"
6397 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6398 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6399 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6400 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6401 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6402 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6403 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6404 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6405 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6406 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6407 .next
6408 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6409 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6410 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6411 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6412 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6413 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6414 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6415 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6416 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6417 .next
6418 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6419 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6420 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6421 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6422 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6423 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6424 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6425 .code
6426 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6427 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6428 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6429 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6430 .endd
6431 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6432 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6433 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6434 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6435 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6436
6437 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6438 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6439 lookup types support only literal keys.
6440
6441 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6442 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6443 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6444 .next
6445 .cindex "linear search"
6446 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6447 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6448 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6449 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6450 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6451 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6452 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6453 in the file is used.
6454
6455 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6456 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6457 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6458 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6459 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6460 colon, for example:
6461 .code
6462 baduser: :fail:
6463 .endd
6464 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6465 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6466 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6467 wildcarding of any kind.
6468
6469 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6470 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6471 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6472 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6473 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6474 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6475 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6476 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6477 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6478
6479 .next
6480 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6481 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6482 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6483 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6484 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6485 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6486 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6487 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6488
6489 .next
6490 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6491 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6492 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6493 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6494 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6495 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6496 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6497 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6498 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6499
6500 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6501 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6502 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6503 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6504
6505 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6506 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6507
6508 .olist
6509 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6510 .code
6511 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6512 *fish data for anythingfish
6513 .endd
6514 .next
6515 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6516 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6517 .code
6518 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6519 .endd
6520 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6521 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6522 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6523 .code
6524 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6525 .endd
6526 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6527 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6528 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6529 .code
6530 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6531 .endd
6532
6533 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6534 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6535 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6536 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6537 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6538
6539 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6540 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6541 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6542 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6543 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6544
6545 .next
6546 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6547 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6548 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6549 example:
6550 .code
6551 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6552 .endd
6553 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6554 .endlist olist
6555
6556 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6557 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6558 be followed by optional colons.
6559
6560 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6561 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6562 lookup types support only literal keys.
6563 .endlist ilist
6564
6565
6566 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6568 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6569 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6570 many of them are given in later sections.
6571
6572 .ilist
6573 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6574 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6575 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6576 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6577 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6578 .next
6579 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6580 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6581 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6585 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6586 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6587 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6588 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6589 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6590 .next
6591 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6592 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6593 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6594 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6595 .next
6596 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6597 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6598 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6599 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6600 .next
6601 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6602 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6603 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6604 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6605 .next
6606 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6607 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6608 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6609 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6610 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6611 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6612 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6613 password value. For example:
6614 .code
6615 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6616 .endd
6617 .next
6618 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6620 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6621 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6622
6623 .next
6624 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6626 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6627 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6628
6629 .next
6630 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6631 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6632 .next
6633 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6634 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6635 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6636 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6637 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6638 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6639 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6640 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6641 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6642 .code
6643 require condition = \
6644 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6645 .endd
6646 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6647 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6648 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6649 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6650 .endlist
6651
6652
6653
6654 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6655 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6656 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6657 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6658 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6659 options such as a list of local domains.
6660
6661 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6662 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6663 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6664 or may give up altogether.
6665
6666
6667
6668 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6669 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6670 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6671 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6672 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6673 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6674 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6675 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6676
6677 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6678 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6679 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6680
6681 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6682 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6683 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6684
6685 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6686 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6687 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6688 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6689 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6690 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6691 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6692 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6693 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6694 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6695 .code
6696 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6697 .endd
6698 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6699 looks up these keys, in this order:
6700 .code
6701 jane@eyre.example
6702 *@eyre.example
6703 *
6704 .endd
6705 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6706 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6707 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6708 Exim move on to try the next key.
6709
6710
6711
6712 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6713 .cindex "partial matching"
6714 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6716 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6717 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6718 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6719 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6720 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6721 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6722 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6723 a key in a DBM file is
6724 .code
6725 *.dates.fict.example
6726 .endd
6727 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6728 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6729 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6730 file.
6731
6732 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6733 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6734 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6735
6736 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6737 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6738 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6739 partial matching keys
6740 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6741 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6742 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6743
6744 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6745 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6746 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6747 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6748 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6749 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6750 remains.
6751
6752 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6753 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6754 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6755 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6756 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6757 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6758 .code
6759 2250.dates.fict.example
6760 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6761 *.dates.fict.example
6762 *.fict.example
6763 .endd
6764 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6765 finishes.
6766
6767 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6768 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6769 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6770 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6771 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6772 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6773 .code
6774 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6775 .endd
6776 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6777 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6778 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6779 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6780 .code
6781 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6782 .endd
6783 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6784 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6785
6786 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6787 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6788 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6789
6790 .ilist
6791 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6792 .next
6793 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6794 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6795 .next
6796 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6797 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6798 for &"*"& on its own.
6799 .next
6800 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6801 .endlist
6802
6803
6804 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6805 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6806 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6807 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6808 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6809 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6810 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6811
6812 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6813 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6814 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6815 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6816 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6817
6818
6819
6820
6821 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6822 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6823 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6824 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6825 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6826 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6827 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6828
6829 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6830 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6831 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6832 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6833 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6834 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6835
6836 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6837 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6838 complete.
6839
6840
6841
6842
6843 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6844 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6845 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6846 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6847 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6848 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6849 .code
6850 [name=$local_part]
6851 .endd
6852 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6853 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6854 .code
6855 [name="$local_part"]
6856 .endd
6857 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6858 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6859 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6860 of the following form is provided:
6861 .code
6862 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6863 .endd
6864 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6865 .code
6866 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6867 .endd
6868 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6869 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6870 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6871
6872
6873
6874
6875 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6876 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6877 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6878 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6879 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6880 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6881 an expansion string could contain:
6882 .code
6883 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6884 .endd
6885 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6886 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6887 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6888 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6889
6890 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6891 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6892 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6893
6894 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6895 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6896 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6897 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6898 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6899 .code
6900 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6901 .endd
6902 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6903 white space is ignored.
6904 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6905 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6906 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6907
6908 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6909 When the type is PTR,
6910 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6911 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6912 .code
6913 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6914 .endd
6915 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6916 altered and nothing is added.
6917
6918 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6919 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6920 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6921 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6922 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6923 The field separator can be modified as above.
6924
6925 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6926 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6927 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6928 unless a field separator is specified.
6929 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6930 For SPF records the
6931 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6932 .code
6933 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6934 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6935 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6936 .endd
6937 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6938 white space is ignored.
6939
6940 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6941 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6942 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6943 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6944 specified.
6945 .code
6946 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6947 .endd
6948
6949 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6950 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6951 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6952 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6953 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6954 each followed by a comma,
6955 that may appear before the record type.
6956
6957 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6958 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6959 a defer-option modifier.
6960 The possible keywords are
6961 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6962 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6963 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6964 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6965 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6966 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6967 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6968 .code
6969 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6970 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6971 .endd
6972 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6973 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6974
6975 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6976 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6977 The possible keywords are
6978 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6979 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6980 with the lookup.
6981 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6982 is not labelled as authenticated data
6983 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6984 The default is &"never"&.
6985
6986 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6987
6988 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6989 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6990 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6991 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6992 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6993 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6994
6995 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6996 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6997 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6998
6999 .new
7000 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7001 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7002 .cindex DNS TTL
7003 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7004 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7005 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7006 .wen
7007
7008
7009 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7010 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7011 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7012 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7013 the pseudo-type MXH:
7014 .code
7015 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7016 .endd
7017 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7018 returned.
7019
7020 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7021 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7022 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7023 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7024 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7025 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7026 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7027 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7028 .code
7029 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7030 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7031 .endd
7032 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7033 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7034 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7035
7036 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7037 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7038 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7039 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7040 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7041 such a list.
7042
7043 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7044 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7045 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7046 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7047 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7048 result of a successful lookup such as:
7049 .code
7050 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7051 .endd
7052 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7053 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7054 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7055
7056 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7058 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7059 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7060 .code
7061 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7062 .endd
7063
7064
7065 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7066 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7067 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7068 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7069 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7070 .code
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7073 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7074 .endd
7075 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7076 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7077 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7078 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7079
7080 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7081 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7082 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7083
7084
7085
7086
7087 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7088 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7089 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7090 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7091 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7092 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7093 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7094 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7095 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7096 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7097 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7098 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7099 .code
7100 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7101 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7102 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7103 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7104 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7105 .endd
7106 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7107 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7108
7109 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7110 the way they handle the results of a query:
7111
7112 .ilist
7113 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7114 gives an error.
7115 .next
7116 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7117 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7118 .next
7119 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7120 from all of them are returned.
7121 .endlist
7122
7123
7124 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7125 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7126 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7127 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7128
7129
7130 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7131 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7132 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7133 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7134 .code
7135 data = ${lookup ldap \
7136 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7137 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7138 .endd
7139 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7140 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7141 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7142 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7143
7144 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7145 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7146 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7147
7148 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7149 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7150 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7151 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7152 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7153 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7154 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7155 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7156 &_exim.conf_&.
7157
7158
7159 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7160 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7161 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7162 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7163 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7164 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7165
7166 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7167 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7168 the string:
7169 .code
7170 * => \2A
7171 ( => \28
7172 ) => \29
7173 \ => \5C
7174 .endd
7175 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7176 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7177 .code
7178 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7179 .endd
7180 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7181 .code
7182 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7183 .endd
7184 yields
7185 .code
7186 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7187 .endd
7188 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7189 .code
7190 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7191 .endd
7192 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7193 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7194 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7195 .code
7196 , + " \ < > ;
7197 .endd
7198 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7199 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7200 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7201 .code
7202 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7203 .endd
7204 yields
7205 .code
7206 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7207 .endd
7208 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7209 .code
7210 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7211 .endd
7212 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7213 authentication below.
7214
7215
7216 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7217 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7218 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7219 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7220 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7221 by starting it with
7222 .code
7223 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7224 .endd
7225 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7226 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7227 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7228 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7229 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7230 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7231 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7232 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7233 failures, and timeouts.
7234
7235 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7236 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7237 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7238 doubled. For example
7239 .code
7240 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7241 .endd
7242 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7243 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7244 the local host) is used.
7245
7246 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7247 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7248 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7249 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7250 not available.
7251
7252 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7253 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7254 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7255 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7256 .code
7257 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7258 .endd
7259 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7260 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7261 .code
7262 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7263 .endd
7264 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7265 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7266 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7267 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7268 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7269 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7270 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7271 backup host.
7272
7273 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7274 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7275 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7276
7277 .ilist
7278 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7279 interface.
7280 .next
7281 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7282 .endlist
7283
7284
7285 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7286 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7287
7288
7289
7290 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7291 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7292 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7293 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7294 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7295 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7296 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7297 them. The following names are recognized:
7298 .display
7299 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7300 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7301 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7302 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7303 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7304 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7305 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7306 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7307 .endd
7308 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7309 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7310 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7311 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7312
7313 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7314 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7315 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7316 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7317 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7318 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7319 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7320 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7321 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7322
7323 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7324 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7325
7326 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7327 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7328 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7329 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7330 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7331 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7332 alternate list (colon-separated).
7333
7334 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7335 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7336 .code
7337 ${lookup ldap
7338 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7339 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7340 {$value}fail}
7341 .endd
7342 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7343 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7344 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7345 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7346
7347 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7348 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7349 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7350
7351 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7352 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7353 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7354 quoting has two advantages:
7355
7356 .ilist
7357 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7358 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7359 .next
7360 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7361 .endlist
7362
7363 For example, a setting such as
7364 .code
7365 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7366 .endd
7367 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7368
7369 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7370 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7371 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7372 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7373 .code
7374 PASS=${quote:$3}
7375 .endd
7376 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7377 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7378 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7379
7380
7381
7382 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7383 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7384 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7385 as a sequence of values, for example
7386 .code
7387 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7388 .endd
7389 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7390 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7391 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7392 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7393 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7394 directory.
7395
7396 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7397 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7398 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7399
7400 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7401 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7402 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7403 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7404 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7405 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7406 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7407 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7408 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7409
7410 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7411 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7412 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7413 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7414 .code
7415 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7416 value1.1,value1,,2
7417
7418 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7419 value two
7420
7421 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7422 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7423
7424 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7425 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7426 .endd
7427 You can
7428 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7429 results of LDAP lookups.
7430 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7431 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7432 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7433 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7434 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7435 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7436
7437
7438
7439
7440 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7441 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7442 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7443 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7444 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7445 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7446 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7447 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7448 .code
7449 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7450 .endd
7451 might return the string
7452 .code
7453 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7454 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7455 .endd
7456 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7457 .code
7458 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7459 .endd
7460 would just return
7461 .code
7462 Martin Guerre
7463 .endd
7464 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7465 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7466 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7467
7468
7469
7470 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7471 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7472 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7473 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7475 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7476 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7477 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7478 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7479 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7480 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7481 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7482 might be
7483 .code
7484 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7485 {$value}fail}
7486 .endd
7487 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7488 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7489 .code
7490 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7491 {$value}}
7492 .endd
7493 might be
7494 .code
7495 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7496 .endd
7497 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7498 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7499 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7500 .code
7501 Mister X
7502 .endd
7503 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7504 with a newline between the data for each row.
7505
7506
7507 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7508 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7509 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7510 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7511 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7512 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7513 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7514 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7515 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7516 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7517 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7518 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7519 information.
7520 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7521 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7522 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7523 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7524 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7525 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7526 .code
7527 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7528 .endd
7529 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7530 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7531 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7532 .code
7533 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7534 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7535 .endd
7536 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7537 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7538 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7539 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7540 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7541 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7542
7543 .new
7544 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7545 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7546 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7547 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7548 .wen
7549
7550 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7551 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7552 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7553 done by starting the query with
7554 .display
7555 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7556 .endd
7557 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7558 .olist
7559 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7560 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7561 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7562 taken from there.
7563 .next
7564 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7565 .endlist
7566 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7567 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7568 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7569
7570 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7571 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7572 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7573 like this:
7574 .code
7575 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7576 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7577 master/db/name/pw
7578 .endd
7579 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7580 .code
7581 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7582 .endd
7583 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7584 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7585 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7586 .code
7587 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7588 .endd
7589
7590
7591 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7592 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7593 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7594 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7595 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7596 .display
7597 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7598 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7599 .endd
7600 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7601 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7602
7603 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7604 the queries.
7605
7606 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7607 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7608
7609 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7610 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7611 is zero because no rows are affected.
7612
7613
7614 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7615 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7616 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7617 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7618 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7619 looks like this:
7620 .code
7621 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7622 .endd
7623 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7624 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7625 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7626
7627 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7628 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7629 affected.
7630
7631 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7632 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7633 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7634 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7635 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7636 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7637 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7638 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7639 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7640 .code
7641 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7642 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7643 .endd
7644 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7645 .code
7646 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7647 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7648 .endd
7649 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7650 quote, which it doubles.
7651
7652 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7653 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7654 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7655 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7656 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7657 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7658 option.
7659 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7660 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7661
7662
7663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7665
7666 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7667 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7668 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7669 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7670 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7671 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7672 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7673 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7674 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7675
7676 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7677 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7678 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7679 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7680
7681 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7682 support all the complexity available in
7683 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7684
7685
7686
7687 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7688 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7689 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7690 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7691 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7692 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7693 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7694 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7695
7696
7697 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7698 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7699 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7700
7701 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7702 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7703 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7704 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7705 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7706 .code
7707 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7708 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7709 .endd
7710 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7711 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7712 senders based on the receiving domain.
7713
7714
7715
7716
7717 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7718 .cindex "list" "negation"
7719 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7720 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7721 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7722 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7723 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7724 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7725
7726 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7727 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7728 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7729 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7730 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7731 .code
7732 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7733 .endd
7734 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7735 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7736 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7737 .code
7738 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7739 .endd
7740 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7741 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7742 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7743
7744 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7745 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7746 item.
7747
7748
7749
7750 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7751 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7752 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7753 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7754 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7755 file names are not allowed,
7756 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7757 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7758 lines:
7759
7760 .ilist
7761 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7762 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7763 .next
7764 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7765 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7766 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7767 .code
7768 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7769 .endd
7770 .endlist
7771
7772 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7773 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7774 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7775 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7776
7777 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7778 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7779 .code
7780 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7781 .endd
7782 and the file contains the lines
7783 .code
7784 !a.b.c
7785 *.b.c
7786 .endd
7787 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7788 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7789
7790
7791
7792 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7793 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7794 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7795 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7796 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7797 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7798 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7799 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7800
7801 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7802 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7803 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7804 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7805
7806
7807
7808
7809 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7810 .cindex "named lists"
7811 .cindex "list" "named"
7812 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7813 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7814 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7815 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7816 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7817 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7818 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7819 .code
7820 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7821 .endd
7822 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7823 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7824 configured with the line
7825 .code
7826 domains = +local_domains
7827 .endd
7828 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7829 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7830 .code
7831 dnslookup:
7832 driver = dnslookup
7833 domains = ! +local_domains
7834 transport = remote_smtp
7835 no_more
7836 .endd
7837 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7838 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7839 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7840 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7841 .code
7842 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7843 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7844 .endd
7845 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7846 .code
7847 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7848 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7849 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7850 .endd
7851 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7852 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7853 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7854 .code
7855 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7856 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7857 .endd
7858 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7859 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7860 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7861 .code
7862 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7863 .endd
7864 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7865 referenced lists if you can.
7866
7867 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7868 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7869 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7870 .code
7871 domains = +local_domains
7872 .endd
7873 on several of your routers
7874 or in several ACL statements,
7875 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7876 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7877 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7878 the same each time they are referenced.
7879
7880 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7881 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7882 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7883 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7884
7885
7886
7887 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7888 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7889 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7890 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7891 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7892 write
7893 .code
7894 ALIST = host1 : host2
7895 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7896 .endd
7897 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7898 .code
7899 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7900 .endd
7901 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7902 list, and write
7903 .code
7904 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7905 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7906 .endd
7907 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7908 .code
7909 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7910 .endd
7911
7912
7913 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7914 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7915 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7916 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7917 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7918 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7919 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7920 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7921 message. For example:
7922 .code
7923 domainlist special_domains = \
7924 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7925 .endd
7926 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7927 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7928 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7929 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7930 same list each time.
7931
7932 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7933 cache the result anyway. For example:
7934 .code
7935 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7936 .endd
7937 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7938 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7939
7940
7941
7942 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7943 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7944 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7945 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7946 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7947
7948 .ilist
7949 .cindex "primary host name"
7950 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7951 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7952 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7953 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7954 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7955 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7956 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7957 differ only in their names.
7958 .next
7959 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7960 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7961 .cindex "domain literal"
7962 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7963 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7964 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7965 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7966 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7967 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7968 .next
7969 .cindex "@mx_any"
7970 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7971 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7972 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7973 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7974 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7975 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7976 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7977 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7978 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7979 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7980 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7981
7982 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7983 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7984 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7985 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7986 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7987
7988 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7989 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7990 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7991 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7992 on a router). For example:
7993 .code
7994 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7995 .endd
7996 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7997 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7998
7999 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8000 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8001 contain negative items.
8002
8003 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8004 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8005 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8006 .code
8007 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8008 an.other.domain : ...
8009 .endd
8010 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8011 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8012 .code
8013 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8014 an.other.domain ? ...
8015 .endd
8016 .next
8017 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8018 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8019 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8020 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8021 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8022 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8023 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8024 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8025 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8026 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8027
8028 .next
8029 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8030 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8031 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8032 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8033 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8034 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8035 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8036 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8037 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8038
8039 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8040 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8041 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8042 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8043 expression by expansion, of course).
8044 .next
8045 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8046 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8047 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8048 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8049 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8050 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8051 .code
8052 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8053 .endd
8054 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8055 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8056 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8057 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8058 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8059 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8060 other statements in the same ACL.
8061
8062 .next
8063 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8064 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8065 .code
8066 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8067 .endd
8068 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8069 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8070
8071 .next
8072 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8073 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8074 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8075 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8076 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8077 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8078 expansion variable.
8079 .next
8080 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8081 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8082 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8083 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8084 .code
8085 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8086 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8087 .endd
8088 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8089 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8090 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8091 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8092 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8093 .next
8094 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8095 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8096 between the pattern and the domain.
8097 .endlist
8098
8099 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8100 .code
8101 domainlist funny_domains = \
8102 @ : \
8103 lib.unseen.edu : \
8104 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8105 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8106 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8107 nis;domains.byname : \
8108 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8109 .endd
8110 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8111 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8112 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8113 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8114 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8115 patterns earlier.
8116
8117
8118
8119 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8120 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8121 .cindex "list" "host list"
8122 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8123 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8124 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8125 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8126 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8127 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8128 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8129
8130
8131 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8132 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8133 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8134 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8135 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8136 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8137 not used.
8138
8139 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8140 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8141 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8142
8143
8144
8145 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8146 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8147 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8148 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8149 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8150 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8151 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8152 concerns.)
8153
8154 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8155 inspecting its IP address:
8156
8157 .ilist
8158 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8159 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8160 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8161 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8162 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8163 with the IP address of the subject host.
8164
8165 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8166 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8167 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8168 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8169 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8170
8171 .next
8172 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8173 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8174 domain name, as just described.
8175
8176 .next
8177 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8178 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8179 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8180 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8181 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8182 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8183 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8184 that can never match a client host.
8185
8186 .next
8187 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8188 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8189 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8190 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8191 .code
8192 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8193 accept hosts = @[]
8194 .endd
8195 .next
8196 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8197 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8198 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8199 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8200 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8201 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8202 significant end of the address.
8203
8204 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8205 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8206 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8207 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8208 .code
8209 192.168.23.236/31
8210 .endd
8211 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8212 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8213 matches.
8214
8215 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8216 .code
8217 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8218 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8219 .endd
8220 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8221 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8222 For example:
8223 .code
8224 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8225 .endd
8226 could make use of a file containing
8227 .code
8228 172.16.0.0/12
8229 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8230 .endd
8231 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8232 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8233 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8234 .code
8235 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8236 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8237 .endd
8238 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8239 list.
8240 .endlist
8241
8242
8243
8244 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8245 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8246 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8247 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8248 address, the pattern takes this form:
8249 .display
8250 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8251 .endd
8252 For example:
8253 .code
8254 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8255 .endd
8256 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8257 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8258 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8259 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8260 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8261 returned by the lookup is not used.
8262
8263 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8264 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8265 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8266 patterns of this form:
8267 .display
8268 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8269 .endd
8270 For example:
8271 .code
8272 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8273 .endd
8274 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8275 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8276 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8277 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8278 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8279
8280 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8281 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8282 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8283 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8284 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8285 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8286 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8287 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8288 addresses are always used.
8289
8290 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8291 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8292 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8293 configurations.
8294
8295 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8296 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8297 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8298 case the IP address is used on its own.
8299
8300
8301
8302 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8303 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8304 .cindex "unknown host name"
8305 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8306 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8307 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8308 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8309 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8310 above.)
8311
8312 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8313 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8314 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8315 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8316 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8317 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8318 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8319
8320 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8321 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8322
8323 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8324 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8325 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8326 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8327 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8328 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8329 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8330 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8331 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8332
8333 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8334 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8335
8336 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8337 .cindex "alias for host"
8338 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8339 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8340
8341 .ilist
8342 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8343 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8344 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8345 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8346 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8347 expression.
8348 .next
8349 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8350 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8351 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8352 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8353 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8354 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8355 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8356 example,
8357 .code
8358 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8359 .endd
8360 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8361 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8362 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8363 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8364 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8365 .code
8366 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8367 .endd
8368 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8369 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8370 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8371 required.
8372 .endlist
8373
8374
8375
8376
8377 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8378 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8379 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8380 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8381 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8382 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8383
8384 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8385 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8386
8387 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8388 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8389 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8390 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8391 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8392 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8393 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8394 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8395 not recognized in an indirected file).
8396
8397 .ilist
8398 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8399 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8400 .code
8401 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8402 .endd
8403 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8404 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8405
8406 .next
8407 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8408 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8409 example:
8410 .code
8411 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8412 192.168.4.5
8413 .endd
8414 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8415 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8416 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8417 .endlist
8418
8419 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8420 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8421 list.
8422
8423 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8424 "SECTmixwilhos"
8425 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8426
8427 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8428 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8429 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8430
8431 .ilist
8432 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8433 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8434 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8435 .code
8436 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8437 .endd
8438 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8439 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8440 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8441 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8442 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8443 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8444 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8445
8446 .next
8447 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8448 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8449 .code
8450 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8451 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8452 .endd
8453 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8454 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8455 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8456 this section.
8457 .endlist
8458
8459
8460 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8461 "SECTtemdnserr"
8462 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8463 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8464 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8465 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8466 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8467 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8468 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8469 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8470 host lists such as whitelists.
8471
8472
8473
8474 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8475 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8476 .cindex "unknown host name"
8477 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8478 If a pattern is of the form
8479 .display
8480 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8481 .endd
8482 for example
8483 .code
8484 dbm;/host/accept/list
8485 .endd
8486 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8487 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8488 is not used.
8489
8490 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8491 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8492 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8493 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8494 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8495 lookup, both using the same file.
8496
8497
8498
8499 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8500 If a pattern is of the form
8501 .display
8502 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8503 .endd
8504 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8505 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8506 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8507 .code
8508 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8509 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8510 .endd
8511 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8512 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8513 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8514 operator.
8515
8516 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8517 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8518 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8519
8520 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8521 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8522 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8523 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8524 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8525 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8526
8527
8528
8529
8530
8531 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8532 .cindex "list" "address list"
8533 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8534 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8535 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8536 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8537 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8538 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8539 using this option setting:
8540 .code
8541 senders = :
8542 .endd
8543 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8544 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8545 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8546 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8547
8548 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8549 example:
8550 .code
8551 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8552 .endd
8553 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8554 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8555 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8556 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8557 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8558 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8559 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8560 .code
8561 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8562 *@+hostile_domains:\
8563 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8564 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8565 .endd
8566 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8567 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8568 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8569 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8570 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8571
8572 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8573 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8574 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8575 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8576 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8577 .code
8578 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8579 .endd
8580
8581 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8582 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8583 senders:
8584
8585 .ilist
8586 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8587 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8588 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8589 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8590 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8591 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8592 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8593 .code
8594 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8595 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8596 .endd
8597 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8598 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8599
8600 .next
8601 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8602 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8603 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8604 example:
8605 .code
8606 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8607 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8608 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8609 .endd
8610 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8611 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8612 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8613 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8614
8615 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8616 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8617 panic log.
8618 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8619 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8620 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8621 default. For example, with this lookup:
8622 .code
8623 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8624 .endd
8625 the file could contains lines like this:
8626 .code
8627 user1@domain1.example
8628 *@domain2.example
8629 .endd
8630 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8631 that are tried is:
8632 .code
8633 nimrod@jaeger.example
8634 *@jaeger.example
8635 *
8636 .endd
8637 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8638 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8639
8640 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8641 .code
8642 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8643 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8644 .endd
8645 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8646 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8647 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8648 .endlist
8649
8650
8651 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8652 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8653 always fails.
8654
8655
8656 .ilist
8657 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8658 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8659 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8660 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8661 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8662 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8663 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8664 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8665 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8666
8667 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8668 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8669 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8670 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8671 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8672 with
8673 .code
8674 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8675 .endd
8676 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8677 .code
8678 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8679 .endd
8680 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8681
8682 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8683 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8684 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8685 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8686 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8687 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8688 .code
8689 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8690 spammer3 : spammer4
8691 .endd
8692 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8693 doubling.
8694
8695 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8696 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8697 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8698 might have entries like
8699 .code
8700 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8701 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8702 *: ^\d{8}$
8703 .endd
8704 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8705 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8706 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8707 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8708
8709 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8710 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8711 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8712
8713 .next
8714 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8715 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8716 can only return a single list of local parts.
8717 .endlist
8718
8719 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8720 in these two examples:
8721 .code
8722 senders = +my_list
8723 senders = *@+my_list
8724 .endd
8725 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8726 example it is a named domain list.
8727
8728
8729
8730
8731 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8732 .cindex "case of local parts"
8733 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8734 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8735 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8736 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8737 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8738 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8739 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8740 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8741 default.
8742
8743 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8744 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8745 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8746 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8747 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8748 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8749 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8750 case-independent.
8751
8752 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8753 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8754 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8755 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8756 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8757 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8758 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8759 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8760
8761
8762
8763 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8764 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8765 .cindex "local part" "list"
8766 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8767 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8768 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8769 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8770 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8771 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8772 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8773 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8774
8775 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8776 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8777 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8778 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8779 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8780 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8781 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8782 types.
8783 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8784
8785
8786
8787
8788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8790
8791 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8792 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8793 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8794 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8795
8796 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8797 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8798 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8799 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8800 escape character, as described in the following section.
8801
8802 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8803 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8804 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8805 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8806 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8807 reasons.
8808
8809
8810
8811 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8812 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8813 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8814 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8815 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8816 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8817 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8818 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8819
8820 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8821 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8822 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8823 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8824 .code
8825 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8826 .endd
8827 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8828 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8829 string.
8830
8831
8832
8833 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8834 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8835 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8836 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8837 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8838 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8839 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8840 encoding.
8841
8842 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8843 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8844 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8845
8846
8847 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8848 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8849 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8850 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8851 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8852 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8853 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8854 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8855 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8856 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8857 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8858 and &%nhash%&.
8859
8860 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8861 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8862 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8863
8864 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8865 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8866 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8867 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8868 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8869 .code
8870 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8871 .endd
8872 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8873 Exim message identifier. For example:
8874 .code
8875 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8876 .endd
8877 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8878 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8879
8880
8881 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8882 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8883 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8884 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8885 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8886 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8887 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8888 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8889 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8890 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8891 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8892 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8893 being expanded.
8894
8895
8896
8897
8898 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8899 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8900 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8901 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8902 white space is significant.
8903
8904 .vlist
8905 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8906 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8907 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8908 .code
8909 $local_part
8910 ${domain}
8911 .endd
8912 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8913 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8914 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8915 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8916 given, the expansion fails.
8917
8918 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8919 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8920 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8921 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8922 .code
8923 ${lc:$local_part}
8924 .endd
8925 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8926 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8927 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8928 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8929 string easier to understand.
8930
8931 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8932 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8933 expansion item below.
8934
8935
8936 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8937 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8938 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8939 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8940 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8941 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8942 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8943 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8944 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8945 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8946 the result of the expansion.
8947 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8948 the expansion result is an empty string.
8949 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8950
8951
8952 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8953 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8954 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8955 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8956 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8957 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8958 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8959 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8960 .display
8961 &`version `&
8962 &`serial_number `&
8963 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8964 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8965 &`notbefore `& time
8966 &`notafter `& time
8967 &`sig_algorithm `&
8968 &`signature `&
8969 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8970 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8971 &`crl_uri `& list
8972 .endd
8973 If the field is found,
8974 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8975 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8976 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8977 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8978
8979 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8980 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8981 extracted is used.
8982
8983 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8984
8985 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8986 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8987 not quite
8988 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8989 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8990 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8991 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8992 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8993 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8994 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8995 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8996
8997 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8998 take an optional modifier of "int"
8999 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9000 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9001 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9002
9003 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9004 newline-separated by default,
9005 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9006 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9007 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9008
9009 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9010 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9011 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9012 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9013 if so the element tags are omitted.
9014
9015 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9016
9017 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9018 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9019 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9020 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9021 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9022 .code
9023 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9024 .endd
9025 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9026 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9027 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9028
9029 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9030 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9031 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9032 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9033 must have the following type:
9034 .code
9035 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9036 .endd
9037 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9038 function should return one of the following values:
9039
9040 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9041 into the expanded string that is being built.
9042
9043 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9044 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9045
9046 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9047 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9048
9049 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9050
9051 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9052 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9053 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9054
9055
9056 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9057 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9058 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9059 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9060 removed.
9061 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9062 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9063 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9064
9065 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9066 appear, for example:
9067 .code
9068 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9069 .endd
9070 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9071 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9072
9073 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9074 search failure.
9075 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9076 search success.
9077
9078
9079 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9080 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9081 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9082 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9083 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9084 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9085 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9086 form:
9087 .display
9088 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9089 .endd
9090 .vindex "&$value$&"
9091 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9092 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9093 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9094 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9095 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9096 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9097 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9098 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9099 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9100
9101 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9102 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9103 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9104 yield &"2001"&:
9105 .code
9106 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9107 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9108 .endd
9109 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9110 appear, for example:
9111 .code
9112 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9113 .endd
9114 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9115 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9116
9117
9118 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9119 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9120 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9121 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9122 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9123 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9124 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9125 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9126 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9127 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9128 <&'string3'&> as before.
9129
9130 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9131 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9132 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9133 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9134 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9135 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9136 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9137 provided. For example:
9138 .code
9139 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9140 .endd
9141 yields &"42"&, and
9142 .code
9143 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9144 .endd
9145 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9146 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9147
9148
9149 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9150 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9151 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9152 .vindex "&$item$&"
9153 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9154 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9155 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9156 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9157 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9158 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9159 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9160 .code
9161 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9162 .endd
9163 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9164 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9165
9166
9167 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9168 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9169 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9170 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9171 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9172 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9173
9174 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9175 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9176 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9177 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9178 .code
9179 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9180 .endd
9181 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9182 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9183 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9184 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9185 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9186 .code
9187 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9188 .endd
9189 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9190 letters appear. For example:
9191 .display
9192 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9193 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9194 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9195 .endd
9196
9197 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9198 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9199 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9200 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9201 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9202 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9203 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9204 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9205 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9206 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9207 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9208 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9209 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9210 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9211 .code
9212 $header_reply-to:
9213 .endd
9214 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9215 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9216 lines) may be present.
9217
9218 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9219 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9220
9221 .ilist
9222 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9223 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9224 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9225
9226 .next
9227 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9228 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9229 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9230 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9231 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9232 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9233 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9234 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9235
9236 .next
9237 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9238 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9239 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9240 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9241 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9242 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9243 .endlist ilist
9244
9245 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9246 command of the following form:
9247 .code
9248 headers charset "UTF-8"
9249 .endd
9250 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9251 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9252 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9253 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9254 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9255 ISO-8859-1.
9256
9257 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9258 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9259 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9260 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9261
9262 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9263 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9264 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9265 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9266 router or transport are not accessible.
9267
9268 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9269 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9270 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9271 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9272 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9273 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9274
9275 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9276 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9277 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9278 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9279 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9280 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9281 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9282 header.)
9283
9284 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9285 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9286 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9287 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9288 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9289 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9290 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9291 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9292
9293
9294 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9295 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9296 .cindex &%hmac%&
9297 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9298 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9299 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9300 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9301 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9302 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9303 present. For example:
9304 .code
9305 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9306 .endd
9307 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9308 produces:
9309 .code
9310 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9311 .endd
9312 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9313 an Exim configuration:
9314 .code
9315 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9316 .endd
9317 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9318 .code
9319 headers_add = \
9320 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9321 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9322 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9323 .endd
9324 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9325 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9326 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9327 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9328 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9329 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9330
9331
9332 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9333 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9334 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9335 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9336 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9337 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9338 .code
9339 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9340 .endd
9341 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9342 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9343 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9344 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9345 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9346
9347 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9348 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9349 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9350 .code
9351 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9352 .endd
9353 you can use
9354 .code
9355 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9356 .endd
9357
9358 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9359 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9360 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9361 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9362 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9363 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9364 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9365 some of the braces:
9366 .code
9367 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9368 .endd
9369 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9370 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9371 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9372
9373
9374 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9375 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9376 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9377 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9378 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9379 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9380 apart from an optional leading minus,
9381 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9382
9383 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9384 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9385
9386 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9387 If the number is negative, the fields are
9388 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9389 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9390 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9391
9392 If the modulus of the
9393 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9394 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9395
9396 For example:
9397 .code
9398 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9399 .endd
9400 yields &"42"&, and
9401 .code
9402 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9403 .endd
9404 yields &"result: 42"&.
9405
9406 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9407 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9408 extracted is used.
9409 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9410
9411
9412 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9413 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9414 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9415 described in the next item.
9416
9417 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9418 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9419 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9420 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9421 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9422 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9423 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9424 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9425 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9426
9427 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9428 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9429 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9430 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9431 out by the system administrator.
9432
9433 .vindex "&$value$&"
9434 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9435 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9436 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9437 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9438 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9439 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9440 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9441 original lookup fails.
9442
9443 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9444 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9445 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9446 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9447 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9448 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9449 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9450 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9451
9452 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9453 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9454 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9455 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9456
9457 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9458 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9459 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9460 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9461
9462 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9463 .code
9464 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9465 .endd
9466 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9467 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9468 .code
9469 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9470 {$value}fail}
9471 .endd
9472
9473
9474 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9475 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9476 .vindex "&$item$&"
9477 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9478 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9479 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9480 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9481 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9482 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9483 .code
9484 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9485 .endd
9486 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9487 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9488 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9489
9490 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9491 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9492 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9493 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9494 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9495 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9496 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9497 .code
9498 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9499 .endd
9500 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9501 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9502 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9503 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9504 example,
9505 .code
9506 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9507 .endd
9508 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9509
9510
9511
9512 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9513 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9514 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9515 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9516 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9517 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9518 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9519 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9520
9521 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9522 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9523 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9524 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9525 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9526 not its contents.
9527
9528 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9529 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9530 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9531
9532 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9533 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9534
9535
9536 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9537 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9538 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9539 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9540 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9541 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9542 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9543 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9544
9545 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9546 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9547 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9548 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9549 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9550 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9551 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9552 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9553 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9554 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9555
9556 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9557 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9558 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9559 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9560
9561 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9562 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9563 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9564 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9565 is the expansion of the third argument.
9566
9567 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9568 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9569 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9570
9571 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9572 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9573 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9574 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9575 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9576 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9577 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9578 newlines are left in the string.
9579 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9580 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9581 the string expansion fails.
9582
9583 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9584 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9585
9586
9587
9588 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9589 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9590 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9591 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9592 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9593 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9594 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9595 examples:
9596 .code
9597 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9598 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9599 .endd
9600 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9601 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9602 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9603 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9604 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9605 example:
9606 .code
9607 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9608 .endd
9609 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9610 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9611 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9612 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9613 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9614 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9615 .code
9616 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9617 .endd
9618 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9619 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9620 turns them into spaces:
9621 .code
9622 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9623 .endd
9624 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9625 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9626 addition, the following errors can occur:
9627
9628 .ilist
9629 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9630 .next
9631 Failure to connect the socket;
9632 .next
9633 Failure to write the request string;
9634 .next
9635 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9636 .endlist
9637
9638 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9639 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9640 errors occurs. For example:
9641 .code
9642 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9643 {socket failure}}
9644 .endd
9645 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9646 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9647 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9648 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9649 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9650
9651 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9652 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9653
9654
9655 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9656 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9657 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9658 .vindex "&$value$&"
9659 .vindex "&$item$&"
9660 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9661 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9662 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9663 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9664 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9665 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9666 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9667 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9668 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9669 .code
9670 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9671 .endd
9672 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9673 can be found:
9674 .code
9675 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9676 .endd
9677 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9678 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9679 expansion items.
9680
9681 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9682 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9683 expansion item above.
9684
9685 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9686 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9687 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9688 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9689 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9690 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9691 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9692 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9693 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9694
9695 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9696 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9697 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9698 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9699 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9700 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9701 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9702 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9703 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9704 character.
9705
9706 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9707 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9708 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9709 .vindex "&$value$&"
9710 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9711 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9712 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9713 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9714 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9715 &$value$&.
9716
9717 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9718 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9719 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9720 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9721
9722 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9723 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9724 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9725 troubleshoot:
9726 .code
9727 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9728 log_message = Output of id: $value
9729 .endd
9730 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9731 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9732 .code
9733 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9734 .endd
9735
9736 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9737 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9738 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9739 .code
9740 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9741 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9742 ...
9743 endif
9744 .endd
9745 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9746 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9747 commands.
9748
9749 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9750 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9751 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9752 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9753
9754 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9755 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9756
9757
9758 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9759 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9760 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9761 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9762 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9763 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9764 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9765 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9766 .code
9767 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9768 .endd
9769 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9770 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9771 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9772 .code
9773 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9774 .endd
9775 yields &"defabc"&, and
9776 .code
9777 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9778 .endd
9779 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9780 the regular expression from string expansion.
9781
9782
9783
9784 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9785 .cindex sorting "a list"
9786 .cindex list sorting
9787 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9788 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9789 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9790 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9791 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9792 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9793 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9794 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9795 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9796 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9797 to give values for comparison.
9798
9799 The item result is a sorted list,
9800 with the original list separator,
9801 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9802
9803 Examples:
9804 .code
9805 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9806 .endd
9807 sorts a list of numbers, and
9808 .code
9809 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9810 .endd
9811 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9812
9813
9814 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9815 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9816 .cindex "substring extraction"
9817 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9818 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9819 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9820 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9821 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9822 .code
9823 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9824 .endd
9825 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9826 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9827 omitted.
9828
9829 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9830 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9831 length required. For example
9832 .code
9833 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9834 .endd
9835 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9836 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9837 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9838 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9839
9840 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9841 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9842 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9843 .code
9844 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9845 .endd
9846 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9847 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9848 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9849 .code
9850 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9851 .endd
9852 yields an empty string, but
9853 .code
9854 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9855 .endd
9856 yields &"1"&.
9857
9858 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9859 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9860 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9861 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9862 .code
9863 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9864 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9865 .endd
9866 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9867
9868
9869
9870 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9871 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9872 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9873 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9874 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9875 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9876 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9877 replacement list. For example
9878 .code
9879 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9880 .endd
9881 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9882 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9883 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9884 place.
9885 .endlist
9886
9887
9888
9889 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9891 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9892 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9893 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9894 following operations can be performed:
9895
9896 .vlist
9897 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9898 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9899 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9900 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9901 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9902 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9903
9904
9905 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9907 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9908 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9909 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9910 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9911 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9912 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9913 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9914
9915 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9916 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9917 character. For example:
9918 .code
9919 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9920 .endd
9921 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9922 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9923 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9924 processing lists.
9925
9926 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9927 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9928 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9929 email address separator. For the example header line:
9930 .code
9931 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9932 .endd
9933 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9934 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9935 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9936 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9937 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9938 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9939 quoted.
9940 .code
9941 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9942 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9943 user@example.com
9944 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9945 Last:user@example.com
9946 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9947 user@example.com
9948 .endd
9949
9950 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9951 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9952 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9953 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9954 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9955 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9956 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9957 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9958 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9959
9960 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9961 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9962 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9963 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9964 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9965 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9966 string.
9967
9968
9969 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9970 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9971 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9972 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9973 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9974
9975
9976 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9977 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9978 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9979 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9980 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9981 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9982 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9983
9984
9985 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9986 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9987 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9988 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9989 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9990 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9991 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9992 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9993 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9994 C programming language):
9995 .table2 70pt 300pt
9996 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9997 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9998 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9999 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10000 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10001 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10002 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10003 .endtable
10004 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10005 space is permitted before or after operators.
10006
10007 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10008 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10009 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10010 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10011 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10012
10013 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10014 or 1024*1024*1024,
10015 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10016 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10017
10018 .display
10019 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10020 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10021 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10022 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10023 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10024 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10025 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10026 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10027 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10028 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10029 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10030 .endd
10031
10032 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10033 .code
10034 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10035 condition = \
10036 ${if and { \
10037 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10038 { \
10039 < \
10040 {$recipients_count} \
10041 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10042 } \
10043 }{yes}{no}}
10044 .endd
10045 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10046 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10047
10048
10049 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10050 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10051 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10052 example,
10053 .code
10054 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10055 .endd
10056 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10057 and then re-expands what it has found.
10058
10059
10060 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10061 .cindex "Unicode"
10062 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10063 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10064 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10065 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10066 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10067 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10068 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10069 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10070 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10071
10072 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10073 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10074 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10075 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10076 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10077 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10078 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10079
10080
10081 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10082 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10083 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10084 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10085 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10086 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10087 .code
10088 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10089 .endd
10090 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10091 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10092
10093
10094
10095 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10096 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10097 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10098 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10099 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10100 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10101
10102
10103
10104 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10105 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10106 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10107 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10108 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10109 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10110 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10111
10112
10113 .new
10114 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10115 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10116 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10117 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10118 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10119 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10120 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10121
10122 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10123 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10124 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10125 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10126 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10127 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10128 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10129 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10130 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10131 .wen
10132
10133
10134 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10135 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10136 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10137 .cindex "lower casing"
10138 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10139 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10140 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10141 .code
10142 ${lc:$local_part}
10143 .endd
10144
10145 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10146 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10147 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10148 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10149 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10150 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10151 .code
10152 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10153 .endd
10154 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10155 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10156 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10157
10158
10159 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10160 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10161 .cindex "list" "item count"
10162 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10163 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10164 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10165
10166
10167 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10168 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10169 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10170 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10171 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10172 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10173 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10174 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10175 matching list is returned.
10176
10177
10178 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10179 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10180 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10181 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10182 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10183 empty.
10184
10185
10186 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10187 .cindex "masked IP address"
10188 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10189 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10190 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10191 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10192 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10193 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10194 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10195 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10196 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10197 .code
10198 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10199 .endd
10200 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10201 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10202 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10203 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10204 .code
10205 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10206 .endd
10207 returns the string
10208 .code
10209 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10210 .endd
10211 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10212
10213
10214 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10215 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10216 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10217 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10218 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10219 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10220 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10221
10222
10223 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10224 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10225 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10226 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10227 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10228 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10229 .code
10230 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10231 .endd
10232 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10233
10234
10235 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10236 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10237 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10238 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10239 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10240 is an empty string or
10241 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10242 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10243 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10244 respectively For example,
10245 .code
10246 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10247 .endd
10248 becomes
10249 .code
10250 "ab\"*\"cd"
10251 .endd
10252 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10253 variable or a message header.
10254
10255 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10256 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10257 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10258 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10259 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10260 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10261 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10262
10263
10264 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10265 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10266 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10267 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10268 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10269 .code
10270 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10271 .endd
10272 returns
10273 .code
10274 two%20%5C2A%20two
10275 .endd
10276 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10277 yields an unchanged string.
10278
10279
10280 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10281 .cindex "random number"
10282 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10283 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10284 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10285 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10286 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10287 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10288 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10289 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10290 random().
10291
10292
10293 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10294 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10295 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10296 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10297 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10298 for DNS. For example,
10299 .code
10300 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10301 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10302 .endd
10303 returns
10304 .code
10305 4.2.0.192
10306 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10307 .endd
10308
10309
10310 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10311 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10312 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10313 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10314 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10315 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10316 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10317 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10318 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10319 characters
10320 .code
10321 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10322 .endd
10323 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10324 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10325 characters.
10326
10327
10328 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10329 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10330 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10331 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10332 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10333 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10334 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10335 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10336
10337 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10338 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10339 to use this operator as well.
10340
10341
10342
10343 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10344 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10345 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10346 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10347 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10348 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10349 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10350
10351
10352 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10353 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10354 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10355 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10356 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10357 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10358 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10359
10360
10361 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10362 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10363 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10364 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10365 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10366 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10367 certificate,
10368 and returns
10369 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10370 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10371
10372
10373 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10374 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10375 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10376 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10377 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10378 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10379 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10380 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10381 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10382 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10383 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10384 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10385 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10386
10387 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10388 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10389 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10390
10391 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10393 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10394 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10395 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10396
10397
10398
10399 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10400 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10401 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10402 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10403 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10404 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10405
10406
10407 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10409 .cindex "substring extraction"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10411 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10412 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10413 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10414 .code
10415 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10416 .endd
10417 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10418 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10419
10420 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10421 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10422 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10423 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10424 seconds.
10425
10426 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10427 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10428 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10429 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10430 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10431 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10432 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10433
10434 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10435 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10436 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10437 .cindex "upper casing"
10438 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10439 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10440 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10441
10442 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10443 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10444 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10445 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10446 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10447 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10448 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10449 .endlist
10450
10451
10452
10453
10454
10455
10456 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10457 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10458 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10459 while expanding strings:
10460
10461 .vlist
10462 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10463 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10464 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10465 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10466 condition.
10467
10468 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10469 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10470 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10471 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10472 are:
10473 .display
10474 &`= `& equal
10475 &`== `& equal
10476 &`> `& greater
10477 &`>= `& greater or equal
10478 &`< `& less
10479 &`<= `& less or equal
10480 .endd
10481 For example:
10482 .code
10483 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10484 .endd
10485 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10486 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10487 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10488 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10489 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10490 zero.
10491
10492 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10493 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10494 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10495
10496
10497 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10498 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10499 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10500 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10501 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10502 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10503 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10504 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10505 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10506 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10507 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10508 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10509 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10510 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10511
10512 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10514 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10515 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10516 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10517 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10518 false if zero.
10519 An empty string is treated as false.
10520 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10521 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10522 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10523
10524 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10525 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10526 For example:
10527 .code
10528 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10529 .endd
10530
10531
10532 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10533 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10534 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10535 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10536 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10537 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10538 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10539 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10540
10541 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10542
10543 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10544 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10545 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10546 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10547 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10548 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10549 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10550 included in the binary.
10551
10552 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10553 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10554 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10555 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10556 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10557 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10558 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10559 string in LDAP form is:
10560 .code
10561 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10562 .endd
10563 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10564 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10565 .code
10566 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10567 .endd
10568 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10569 supported:
10570
10571 .ilist
10572 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10573 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10574 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10575 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10576 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10577 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10578 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10579 comparison fails.
10580
10581 .next
10582 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10583 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10584 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10585 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10586 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10587 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10588
10589 .next
10590 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10591 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10592 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10593 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10594 whatever its length.
10595
10596 .next
10597 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10598 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10599 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10600 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10601 .endlist
10602 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10603 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10604 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10605 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10606 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10607 support &[crypt16()]&.
10608
10609 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10610 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10611 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10612 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10613 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10614
10615 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10616 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10617 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10618
10619 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10620 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10621 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10622 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10623 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10624
10625 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10626 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10627 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10628 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10629 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10630 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10631 .code
10632 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10633 .endd
10634 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10635 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10636
10637 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10638 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10639 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10640 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10641 exists in the message. For example,
10642 .code
10643 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10644 .endd
10645 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10646 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10647
10648 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10649 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10650 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10651 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10652 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10653 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10654 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10655 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10656 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10657
10658 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10659 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10660 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10661 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10662 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10663 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10664 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10665 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10666
10667 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10668 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10669 .cindex "first delivery"
10670 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10671 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10672 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10673 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10674
10675
10676 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10677 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10678 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10679 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10680 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10681 .vindex "&$item$&"
10682 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10683 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10684 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10685 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10686 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10687 .ilist
10688 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10689 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10690 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10691 .next
10692 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10693 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10694 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10695 .endlist
10696 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10697 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10698 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10699 list separator is changed to a comma:
10700 .code
10701 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10702 .endd
10703 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10704 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10705
10706 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10707
10708
10709 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10710 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10711 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10712 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10713 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10714 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10715 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10716 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10717 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10718 case-independent.
10719
10720 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10721 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10722 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10723 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10724 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10725 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10726 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10727 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10728 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10729 case-independent.
10730
10731 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10732 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10733 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10734 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10735 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10736 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10737 is true.
10738
10739 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10740 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10741 .code
10742 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10743 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10744 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10745 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10746 .endd
10747
10748 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10749 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10750 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10752 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10753 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10754 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10755 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10756 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10757 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10758 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10759
10760 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10761 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10762 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10763 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10764 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10765
10766 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10767 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10768 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10769 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10770 .code
10771 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10772 .endd
10773 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10774
10775 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10776 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10777 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10778 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10779 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10780 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10781 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10782 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10783 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10784 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10785 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10786 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10787 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10788 this can be used.
10789
10790
10791 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10792 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10793 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10794 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10795 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10796 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10797 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10798 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10799 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10800 case-independent.
10801
10802 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10803 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10804 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10805 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10806 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10807 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10808 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10809 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10810 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10811 case-independent.
10812
10813
10814 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10815 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10816 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10817 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10818 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10819 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10820 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10821 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10822 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10823 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10824 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10825 For example,
10826 .code
10827 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10828 .endd
10829 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10830 backslashes is also required.
10831
10832 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10833 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10834 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10835 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10836 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10837 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10838
10839 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10840 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10841 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10842 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10843 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10844 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10845 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10846 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10847
10848 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10849 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10850 See &*match_local_part*&.
10851
10852 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10853 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10854 See &*match_local_part*&.
10855
10856 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10857 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10858 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10859 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10860 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10861 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10862 .code
10863 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10864 .endd
10865 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10866
10867 .ilist
10868 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10869 .next
10870 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10871 .next
10872 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10873 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10874 in a single test such as
10875 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10876 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10877 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10878 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10879 .code
10880 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10881 .endd
10882 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10883 .next
10884 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10885 .next
10886 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10887 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10888 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10889 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10890 masks. For example:
10891 .code
10892 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10893 .endd
10894 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10895 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10896 address mask, for example:
10897 .code
10898 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10899 .endd
10900 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10901 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10902 .code
10903 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10904 .endd
10905 .endlist ilist
10906
10907 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10908 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10909
10910 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10911
10912 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10913 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10914 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10915 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10916 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10917 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10918 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10919 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10920 example is:
10921 .code
10922 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10923 .endd
10924 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10925 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10926 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10927 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10928 .code
10929 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10930 .endd
10931 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10932 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10933 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10934 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10935 caselessly.
10936
10937 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10938 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10939
10940 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10941 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10942 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10943 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10944
10945 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10946 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10947 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10948 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10949 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10950 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10951 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10952 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10953 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10954 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10955 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10956 .code
10957 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10958 .endd
10959 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10960 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10961
10962 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10963 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10964 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10965 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10966 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10967 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10968 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10969
10970 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10971 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10972 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10973 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10974 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10975 .code
10976 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10977 .endd
10978 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10979 .code
10980 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10981 .endd
10982 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10983 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10984 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10985 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10986 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10987 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10988 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10989 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10990
10991
10992 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10993 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10994 .cindex "Cyrus"
10995 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10996 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10997 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10998 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10999 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11000 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11001
11002 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11003 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11004 building Exim. For example:
11005 .code
11006 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11007 .endd
11008 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11009 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11010 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11011 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11012
11013 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11014 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11015 configuration, you might have this:
11016 .code
11017 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11018 .endd
11019 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11020 .code
11021 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11022 .endd
11023 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11024 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11025 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11026 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11027 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11028 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11029
11030
11031 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11032 .cindex "Radius"
11033 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11034 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11035 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11036 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11037 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11038 support.
11039
11040 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11041 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11042 this library, you need to set
11043 .code
11044 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11045 .endd
11046 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11047 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11048 .code
11049 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11050 .endd
11051 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11052 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11053 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11054
11055 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11056 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11057 the authentication is successful. For example:
11058 .code
11059 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11060 .endd
11061
11062
11063 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11064 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11065 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11066 .cindex "Cyrus"
11067 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11068 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11069 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11070 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11071 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11072 by a process that is not running as root.
11073
11074 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11075 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11076 building Exim. For example:
11077 .code
11078 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11079 .endd
11080 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11081 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11082 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11083
11084 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11085 two are mandatory. For example:
11086 .code
11087 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11088 .endd
11089 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11090 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11091 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11092 .endlist vlist
11093
11094
11095
11096 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11097 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11098 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11099 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11100 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11101 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11102 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11103
11104
11105 .vlist
11106 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11107 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11108 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11109 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11110 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11111 For example,
11112 .code
11113 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11114 .endd
11115 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11116 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11117 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11118
11119 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11120 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11121 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11122 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11123 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11124 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11125 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11126 parsed but not evaluated.
11127 .endlist
11128 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11129
11130
11131
11132
11133 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11134 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11135 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11136 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11137 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11138
11139 .vlist
11140 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11141 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11142 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11143 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11144 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11145 In the expansion condition case
11146 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11147 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11148 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11149 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11150 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11151 matching condition.
11152
11153 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11154 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11155 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11156 any unused variables being made empty.
11157
11158 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11159 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11160 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11161 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11162 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11163 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11164 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11165 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11166 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11167 during subsequent delivery.
11168
11169 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11170 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11171 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11172 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11173 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11174 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11175 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11176 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11177 delivery.
11178
11179 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11180 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11181 this variable has the number of arguments.
11182
11183 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11184 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11185 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11186 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11187 be preserved by coding like this:
11188 .code
11189 warn !verify = sender
11190 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11191 .endd
11192 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11193 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11194 failure.
11195
11196 .vitem &$address_data$&
11197 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11198 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11199 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11200 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11201 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11202 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11203 user filter files.
11204
11205 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11206 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11207 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11208 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11209 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11210 from the child's routing.
11211
11212 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11213 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11214 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11215 address.
11216
11217 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11218 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11219 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11220
11221 .vitem &$address_file$&
11222 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11223 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11224 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11225 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11226 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11227 .code
11228 /home/r2d2/savemail
11229 .endd
11230 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11231 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11232 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11233 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11234 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11235 to the relevant file.
11236
11237 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11238 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11239 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11240 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11241
11242 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11243 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11244 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11245 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11246
11247 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11248 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11249 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11250 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11251 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11252 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11253 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11254 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11255 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11256 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11257 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11258 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11259 command line option.
11260
11261 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11262 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11263 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11264 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11265 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11266 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11267 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11268 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11269 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11270 the ACL's as well.
11271
11272
11273 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11274 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11275 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11276 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11277 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11278 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11279 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11280 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11281 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11282 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11283 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11284
11285 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11286 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11287 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11288 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11289 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11290
11291
11292 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11293 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11294 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11295 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11296 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11297 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11298 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11299 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11300 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11301 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11302 an undefined mechanism.
11303
11304 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11305 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11306 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11307 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11308 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11309 the ACL malware condition.
11310
11311 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11312 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11313 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11314 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11315 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11316 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11317
11318 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11319 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11320 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11321 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11322 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11323 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11324 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11325
11326 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11327 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11328 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11329 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11330 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11331
11332 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11333 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11334 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11335 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11336 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11337
11338 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11339 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11340 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11341 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11342 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11343 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11344 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11345
11346 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11347 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11348 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11349 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11350 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11351 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11352 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11353
11354 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11355 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11356 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11357 address that was connected to.
11358
11359 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11360 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11361 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11362 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11363 compilations of the same version of the program.
11364
11365 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11366 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11367 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11368 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11369 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11370 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11371
11372 .vitem &$config_file$&
11373 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11374 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11375
11376 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11377 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11378 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11379 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11380 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11381
11382 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11383 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11384 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11385 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11386 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11387
11388 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11389 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11390 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11391 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11392 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11393 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11394 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11395 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11396 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11397 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11398 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11399 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11400 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11401 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11402 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11403 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11404 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11405 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11406 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11407 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11408 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11409
11410 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11411 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11412 When a message has been received this variable contains
11413 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11414 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11415
11416 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11417 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11418 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11419 &$dnslist_value$&
11420 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11421 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11422 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11423 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11424 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11425 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11426 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11427 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11428 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11429
11430 .vitem &$domain$&
11431 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11432 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11433 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11434 case for &$domain$&.
11435
11436 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11437 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11438 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11439 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11440
11441 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11442 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11443 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11444 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11445 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11446 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11447
11448 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11449 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11450 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11451
11452 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11453
11454 .ilist
11455 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11456 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11457 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11458 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11459 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11460 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11461 the &(smtp)& transport.
11462
11463 .next
11464 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11465 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11466 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11467 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11468
11469 .next
11470 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11471 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11472 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11473 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11474 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11475 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11476
11477 .next
11478 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11479 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11480 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11481 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11482 .endlist
11483
11484
11485 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11486 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11487 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11488 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11489 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11490 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11491 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11492 used.
11493
11494 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11495 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11496 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11497 to nothing.
11498
11499 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11500 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11501 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11502
11503 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11504 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11505 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11506
11507 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11508 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11509 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11510
11511 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11512 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11513 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11514 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11515 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11516 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11517
11518 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11519 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11520 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11521 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11522 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11523
11524 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11525 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11526 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11527 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11528 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11529
11530 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11531 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11532 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11533 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11534 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11535
11536 .vitem &$home$&
11537 .vindex "&$home$&"
11538 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11539 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11540 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11541 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11542 by a setting on the transport itself.
11543
11544 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11545 of the environment variable HOME.
11546
11547 .vitem &$host$&
11548 .vindex "&$host$&"
11549 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11550 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11551 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11552 to local and remote transports.
11553
11554 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11555 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11556 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11557 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11558 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11559 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11560 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11561 is connected.
11562
11563 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11564 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11565 client is connected.
11566
11567
11568 .vitem &$host_address$&
11569 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11570 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11571 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11572 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11573
11574 .vitem &$host_data$&
11575 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11576 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11577 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11578 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11579 .code
11580 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11581 message = $host_data
11582 .endd
11583 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11584 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11585 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11586 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11587 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11588 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11589 variables is set to &"1"&.
11590
11591 .ilist
11592 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11593 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11594
11595 .next
11596 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11597 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11598 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11599 .endlist ilist
11600
11601 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11602 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11603 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11604 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11605 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11606 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11607 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11608 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11609 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11610 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11611
11612 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11613 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11614 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11615
11616 .vitem &$host_port$&
11617 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11618 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11619 for an outbound connection.
11620
11621
11622 .vitem &$inode$&
11623 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11624 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11625 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11626 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11627 a unique name for the file.
11628
11629 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11630 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11631 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11632
11633 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11634 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11635 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11636
11637 .vitem &$item$&
11638 .vindex "&$item$&"
11639 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11640 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11641 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11642 empty.
11643
11644 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11645 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11646 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11647 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11648 lookup.
11649
11650 .vitem &$load_average$&
11651 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11652 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11653 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11654 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11655
11656 .vitem &$local_part$&
11657 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11658 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11659 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11660 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11661 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11662
11663 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11664 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11665 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11666 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11667 once.
11668
11669 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11670 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11671 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11672 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11673 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11674 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11675
11676 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11677 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11678 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11679 &$address_pipe$&).
11680
11681 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11682 local part of the recipient address.
11683
11684 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11685 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11686 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11687
11688 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11689 the addresses
11690 .code
11691 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11692 abc\:xyz@test.example
11693 .endd
11694 the value of &$local_part$& is
11695 .code
11696 abc:xyz
11697 .endd
11698 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11699 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11700 have:
11701 .code
11702 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11703 .endd
11704 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11705 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11706 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11707
11708 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11709 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11710 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11711 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11712 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11713 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11714 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11715
11716 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11717 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11718 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11719 variable expands to nothing.
11720
11721 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11722 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11723 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11724 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11725 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11726
11727 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11728 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11729 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11730 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11731 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11732
11733 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11734 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11735 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11736 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11737
11738 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11739 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11740 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11741
11742 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11743 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11744 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11745 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11746 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11747 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11748 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11749 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11750
11751 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11752 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11753 This contains the expanded value of the
11754 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11755 been read.
11756
11757 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11758 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11759 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11760 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11761 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11762 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11763
11764 .vitem &$log_space$&
11765 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11766 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11767 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11768 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11769 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11770 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11771
11772
11773 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11774 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11775 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11776 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11777 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11778 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11779 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11780 and &"yes"& if it was.
11781 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11782 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11783 as authenticated data.
11784
11785 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11786 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11787 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11788 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11789 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11790 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11791 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11792 variable is empty.
11793
11794 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11795 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11796 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11797 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11798 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11799
11800 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11801 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11802 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11803 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11804 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11805 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11806 character(s).
11807
11808 .vitem &$message_age$&
11809 .cindex "message" "age of"
11810 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11811 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11812 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11813 delivery attempt.
11814
11815 .vitem &$message_body$&
11816 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11817 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11818 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11819 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11820 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11821 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11822 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11823 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11824 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11825
11826 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11827 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11828 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11829 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11830 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11831
11832 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11833 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11834 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11835 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11836 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11837 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11838 &$message_body$&.
11839
11840 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11841 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11842 .cindex "message body" "size"
11843 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11844 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11845 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11846 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11847 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11848
11849 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11850 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11851 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11852 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11853 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11854 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11855 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11856 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11857
11858 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11859 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11860 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11861 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11862 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11863 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11864
11865 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11866 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11867 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11868 contents of header lines is done.
11869
11870 .vitem &$message_id$&
11871 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11872
11873 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11874 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11875 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11876 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11877 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11878 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11879 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11880 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11881 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11882 from the body is not counted.
11883
11884 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11885 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11886 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11887 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11888 header and the body).
11889
11890 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11891 .code
11892 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11893 condition = \
11894 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11895 .endd
11896 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11897 message has not yet been received.
11898
11899 .vitem &$message_size$&
11900 .cindex "size" "of message"
11901 .cindex "message" "size"
11902 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11903 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11904 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11905 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11906 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11907 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11908 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11909 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11910 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11911
11912 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11913 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11914 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11915 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11916
11917 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11918 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11919 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11920 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11921
11922 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11923 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11924 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11925
11926 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11927 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11928 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11929 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11930 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11931 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11932 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11933 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11934 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11935 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11936
11937 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11938 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11939 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11940
11941 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11942 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11943 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11944 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11945 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11946 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11947 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11948 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11949 the original address.
11950
11951 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11952 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11953 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11954 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11955 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11956
11957 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11958 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11959 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11960
11961 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11962 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11963 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11964 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11965 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11966 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11967 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11968 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11969 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11970
11971 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11972 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11973 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11974 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11975 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11976 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11977 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11978 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11979 user.
11980
11981 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11982 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11983 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11984 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11985
11986 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11987 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11988 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11989 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11990
11991 .vitem &$pid$&
11992 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11993 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11994 This variable contains the current process id.
11995
11996 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11997 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11998 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11999 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12000 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12001 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12002 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12003 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12004 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12005 variable"& error if encountered.
12006
12007 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12008 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12009 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12010 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12011 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12012 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12013 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12014
12015
12016 .new
12017 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12018 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12019 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12020 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12021 .wen
12022
12023 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12024 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12025 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12026 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12027
12028 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12029 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12030 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12031 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12032
12033 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12034 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12035 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12036 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12037
12038 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12039 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12040 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12041
12042 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12043 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12044 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12045 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12046
12047 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12048 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12049 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12050 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12051 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12052
12053 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12054 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12055 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12056 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12057 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12058 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12059
12060 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12061 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12062 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12063 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12064 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12065
12066 .vitem &$received_count$&
12067 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12068 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12069 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12070 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12071 delivering.
12072
12073 .vitem &$received_for$&
12074 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12075 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12076 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12077 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12078 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12079
12080 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12081 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12082 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12083 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12084 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12085 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12086 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12087 option.
12088
12089 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12090 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12091 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12092 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12093 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12094 time.
12095 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12096
12097 .vitem &$received_port$&
12098 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12099 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12100
12101 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12102 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12103 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12104 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12105 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12106 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12107 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12108 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12109 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12110
12111 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12112 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12113 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12114 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12115 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12116 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12117
12118 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12119 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12120 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12121
12122 .vitem &$received_time$&
12123 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12124 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12125 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12126
12127 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12128 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12129 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12130 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12131 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12132 .display
12133 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12134 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12135 .endd
12136 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12137 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12138 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12139 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12140
12141 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12142 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12143 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12144 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12145
12146 .ilist
12147 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12148 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12149
12150 .next
12151 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12152
12153 .next
12154 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12155 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12156 MAIL).
12157
12158 .next
12159 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12160 .next
12161
12162 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12163 .endlist
12164
12165 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12166 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12167
12168 .vitem &$recipients$&
12169 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12170 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12171 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12172 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12173 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12174 cases:
12175
12176 .olist
12177 In a system filter file.
12178 .next
12179 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12180 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12181 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12182 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12183 .next
12184 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12185 .endlist
12186
12187
12188 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12189 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12190 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12191 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12192 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12193 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12194
12195
12196 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12197 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12198 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12199 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12200
12201 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12202 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12203 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12204 these variables contain the
12205 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12206
12207
12208 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12209 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12210 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12211 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12212 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12213 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12214 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12215
12216 .vitem &$return_path$&
12217 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12218 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12219 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12220 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12221 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12222 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12223 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12224 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12225 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12226 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12227 envelope sender.
12228
12229 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12230 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12231 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12232
12233 .vitem &$router_name$&
12234 .cindex "router" "name"
12235 .cindex "name" "of router"
12236 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12237 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12238
12239 .vitem &$runrc$&
12240 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12241 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12242 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12243 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12244 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12245 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12246 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12247 another.
12248
12249 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12250 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12251 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12252 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12253 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12254 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12255 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12256 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12257
12258 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12259 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12260 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12261 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12262 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12263 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12264
12265 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12266 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12267 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12268 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12269 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12270 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12271 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12272 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12273
12274 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12275 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12276 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12277
12278 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12279 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12280 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12281
12282 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12283 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12284 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12285 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12286 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12287 this:
12288 .display
12289 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12290 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12291 .endd
12292 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12293 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12294 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12295 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12296
12297 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12298 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12299 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12300 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12301 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12302 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12303 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12304 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12305 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12306 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12307 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12308 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12309 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12310
12311 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12312 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12313 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12314 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12315 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12316
12317 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12318 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12319 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12320 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12321 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12322 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12323
12324 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12325 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12326 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12327 this variable contains that
12328 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12329
12330 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12331 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12332 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12333 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12334 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12335 &$authenticated_id$&.
12336
12337 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12338 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12339 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12340 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12341 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12342 resolver library states that both
12343 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12344 other times, this variable is false.
12345
12346 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12347 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12348 library, by setting:
12349 .code
12350 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12351 .endd
12352
12353 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12354 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12355
12356 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12357 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12358
12359
12360 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12361 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12362 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12363 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12364 other means, this variable is empty.
12365
12366 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12367 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12368 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12369 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12370 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12371 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12372 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12373
12374 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12375 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12376 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12377 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12378
12379 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12380 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12381 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12382 is set to &"1"&.
12383
12384 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12385 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12386 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12387 following are true:
12388
12389 .ilist
12390 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12391 .next
12392 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12393 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12394 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12395 .next
12396 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12397 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12398 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12399 .next
12400 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12401 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12402 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12403 .next
12404 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12405 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12406 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12407 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12408 .code
12409 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12410 .endd
12411 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12412 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12413 .endlist
12414
12415
12416 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12417 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12418 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12419 number that was used on the remote host.
12420
12421 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12422 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12423 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12424 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12425 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12426 called Exim.
12427
12428 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12429 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12430 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12431 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12432
12433 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12434 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12435 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12436 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12437 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12438 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12439 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12440 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12441 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12442 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12443 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12444 the parentheses.
12445
12446 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12447 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12448 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12449 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12450 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12451
12452 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12453 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12454 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12455 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12456 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12457
12458 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12459 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12460 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12461 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12462 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12463 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12464 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12465
12466 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12467 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12468 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12469 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12470 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12471
12472 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12473 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12474 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12475 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12476 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12477 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12478
12479 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12480 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12481 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12482 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12483 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12484 .code
12485 MAIL FROM:<>
12486 MAIL FROM: <>
12487 .endd
12488 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12489 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12490 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12491 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12492
12493 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12494 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12495 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12496 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12497 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12498 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12499 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12500
12501 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12502 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12503 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12504 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12505 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12506 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12507 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12508 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12509 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12510 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12511 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12512
12513 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12514 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12515 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12516 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12517 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12518 message is junk mail.
12519
12520 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12521 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12522 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12523 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12524
12525
12526 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12527 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12528 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12529
12530 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12531 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12532 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12533 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12534 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12535 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12536
12537 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12538 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12539 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12540 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12541 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12542 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12543 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12544 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12545 .code
12546 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12547 .endd
12548 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12549
12550
12551 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12552 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12553 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12554 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12555 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12556 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12557
12558 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12559 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12560 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12561 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12562 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12563 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12564 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12565 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12566
12567 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12568 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12569 the outbound.
12570
12571 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12572 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12573 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12574 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12575 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12576 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12577
12578 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12579 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12580 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12581 inbound connection when the message was received.
12582 It is only useful as the argument of a
12583 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12584 or a &%def%& condition.
12585
12586 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12587 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12588 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12589 inbound connection when the message was received.
12590 It is only useful as the argument of a
12591 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12592 or a &%def%& condition.
12593 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12594 which is not the leaf.
12595
12596 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12597 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12598 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12599 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12600 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12601 or a &%def%& condition.
12602
12603 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12604 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12605 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12606 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12607 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12608 or a &%def%& condition.
12609 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12610 which is not the leaf.
12611
12612 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12613 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12614 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12615 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12616
12617 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12618 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12619 the outbound.
12620
12621 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12622 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12623 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12624 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12625 and &"0"& otherwise.
12626
12627 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12628 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12629 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12630 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12631 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12632 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12633 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12634 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12635 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12636
12637 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12638 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12639 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12640
12641 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12642 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12643 This variable is
12644 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12645 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12646 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12647 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12648
12649 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12650 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12651 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12652 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12653 .code
12654 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12655 1 No response to request
12656 2 Response not verified
12657 3 Verification failed
12658 4 Verification succeeded
12659 .endd
12660
12661 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12662 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12663 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12664 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12665 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12666
12667 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12668 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12669 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12670 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12671 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12672 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12673 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12674 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12675 which is not the leaf.
12676
12677 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12678 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12679 the outbound.
12680
12681 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12682 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12683 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12684 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12685 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12686 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12687 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12688 which is not the leaf.
12689
12690 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12691 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12692 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12693 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12694 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12695 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12696 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12697 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12698 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12699 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12700 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12701
12702 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12703 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12704 the outbound.
12705
12706 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12707 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12708 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12709 During outbound
12710 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12711 the transport.
12712
12713 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12714 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12715 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12716 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12717
12718 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12719 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12720 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12721
12722 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12723 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12724 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12725
12726 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12727 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12728 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12729 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12730 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12731 values for those that are behind (west).
12732
12733 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12734 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12735 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12736 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12737
12738 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12739 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12740 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12741 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12742 flag.
12743
12744 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12745 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12746 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12747 -0500.
12748
12749 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12750 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12751 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12752 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12753
12754 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12755 .cindex "transport" "name"
12756 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12757 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12758 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12759
12760 .vitem &$value$&
12761 .vindex "&$value$&"
12762 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12763 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12764 &*reduce*& expansion.
12765
12766 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12767 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12768 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12769 or for cutthrough delivery,
12770 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12771 Otherwise, empty.
12772
12773 .vitem &$version_number$&
12774 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12775 The version number of Exim.
12776
12777 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12778 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12779 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12780 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12781
12782 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12783 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12784 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12785 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12786 .endlist
12787 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12788
12789
12790
12791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12793
12794 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12795 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12796 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12797 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12798 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12799 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12800 the line
12801 .code
12802 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12803 .endd
12804 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12805
12806
12807 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12808 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12809 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12810 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12811 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12812 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12813 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12814 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12815 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12816
12817 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12818 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12819 should usually be something like
12820 .code
12821 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12822 .endd
12823 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12824 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12825 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12826 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12827 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12828 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12829 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12830 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12831 two ways:
12832
12833 .ilist
12834 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12835 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12836 a startup when Exim is entered.
12837 .next
12838 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12839 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12840 .endlist
12841
12842 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12843 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12844
12845
12846 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12847 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12848 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12849 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12850 forms:
12851 .code
12852 ${perl{foo}}
12853 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12854 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12855 .endd
12856 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12857 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12858 with an error message of the form
12859 .code
12860 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12861 .endd
12862 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12863 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12864 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12865 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12866 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12867 that was passed to &%die%&.
12868
12869
12870 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12871 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12872 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12873 the Perl code
12874 .code
12875 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12876 .endd
12877 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12878 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12879 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12880
12881 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12882 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12883 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12884 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12885
12886 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12887 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12888 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12889 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12890 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12891 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12892 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12893
12894
12895 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12896 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12897 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12898 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12899 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12900 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12901 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12902 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12903 avoided, but the output is lost.
12904
12905 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12906 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12907 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12908 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12909 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12910 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12911 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12912 .code
12913 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12914 .endd
12915 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12916 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12917 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12918 as the first subroutine argument.
12919 .ecindex IIDperl
12920
12921
12922 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12923 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12924
12925 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12926 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12927 "Starting the daemon"
12928 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12929 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12930 .cindex "network interface"
12931 .cindex "interface" "network"
12932 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12933 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12934 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12935 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12936 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12937 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12938 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12939 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12940 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12941 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12942 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12943
12944 .olist
12945 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12946 and ports to listen on.
12947 .next
12948 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12949 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12950 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12951 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12952 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12953 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12954 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12955 as an error situation.
12956 .next
12957 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12958 for the outgoing connection.
12959 .endlist
12960
12961
12962 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12963 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12964 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12965 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12966 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12967
12968 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12969 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12970 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12971 chapter describes how they operate.
12972
12973 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12974 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12975
12976
12977
12978 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12979 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12980 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12981 following options:
12982
12983 .ilist
12984 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12985 or service names.
12986 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12987 .next
12988 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12989 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12990 .endlist
12991
12992 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12993 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12994 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12995 colons. For example:
12996 .code
12997 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12998 192.168.23.65 ; \
12999 ::1 ; \
13000 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13001 .endd
13002 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13003 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13004
13005 .olist
13006 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13007 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13008 .code
13009 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13010 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13011 .endd
13012 .next
13013 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13014 with a colon separator, for example:
13015 .code
13016 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13017 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13018 .endd
13019 .endlist
13020
13021 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13022 default setting contains just one port:
13023 .code
13024 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13025 .endd
13026 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13027 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13028 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13029 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13030 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13031
13032
13033
13034 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13035 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13036 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13037 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13038 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13039 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13040 .code
13041 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13042 .endd
13043 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13044 .code
13045 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13046 .endd
13047 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13048
13049
13050
13051 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13052 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13053 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13054 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13055 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13056 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13057 exim.
13058
13059 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13060 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13061 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13062 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13063 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13064 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13065 .code
13066 -oX 1225
13067 .endd
13068 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13069 whereas
13070 .code
13071 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13072 .endd
13073 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13074 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13075 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13076
13077
13078
13079 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13080 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13081 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13082 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13083 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13084 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13085 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13086 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13087 list of port numbers or service names,
13088 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13089 common use of this option is expected to be
13090 .code
13091 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13092 .endd
13093 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13094 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13095 this way when a daemon is started.
13096
13097 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13098 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13099 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13100 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13101 connections via the daemon.)
13102
13103
13104
13105
13106 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13107 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13108 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13109 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13110 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13111 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13112 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13113 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13114 .code
13115 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13116 .endd
13117 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13118 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13119 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13120 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13121 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13122 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13123 .code
13124 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13125 .endd
13126 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13127 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13128 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13129 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13130 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13131
13132 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13133 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13134 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13135 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13136 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13137 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13138 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13139 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13140 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13141 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13142 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13143 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13144
13145 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13146 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13147 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13148 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13149 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13150
13151
13152
13153 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13154 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13155 .code
13156 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13157 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13158 .endd
13159 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13160 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13161 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13162 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13163
13164 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13165 .code
13166 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13167 .endd
13168 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13169 .code
13170 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13171 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13172 .endd
13173 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13174 IPv4 loopback address only:
13175 .code
13176 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13177 .endd
13178 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13179 .code
13180 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13181 .endd
13182 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13183
13184
13185
13186 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13187 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13188 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13189 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13190 treated as local.
13191
13192 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13193 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13194 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13195 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13196
13197 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13198 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13199 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13200 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13201 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13202 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13203 used for listening. Consider this example:
13204 .code
13205 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13206 192.168.53.235 ; \
13207 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13208
13209 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13210 .endd
13211 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13212 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13213 Exim is routing.
13214
13215 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13216 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13217 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13218 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13219 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13220 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13221 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13222 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13223
13224
13225
13226 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13227 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13228 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13229 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13230 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13231 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13232 details.
13233
13234
13235
13236
13237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13239
13240 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13241 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13242 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13243 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13244
13245 .ilist
13246 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13247 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13248 .next
13249 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13250 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13251 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13252 .next
13253 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13254 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13255 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13256 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13257 settings.
13258 .endlist
13259
13260 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13261 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13262 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13263 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13264 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13265 listed in more than one group.
13266
13267 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13268 .table2
13269 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13270 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13271 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13272 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13273 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13274 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13275 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13276 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13277 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13278 .endtable
13279
13280
13281 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13282 .table2
13283 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13284 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13285 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13286 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13287 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13288 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13289 .endtable
13290
13291
13292
13293 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13294 .table2
13295 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13296 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13297 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13298 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13299 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13300 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13301 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13302 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13303 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13304 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13305 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13306 .endtable
13307
13308
13309
13310 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13311 .table2
13312 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13313 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13314 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13315 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13316 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13317 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13318 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13319 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13320 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13321 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13322 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13323 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13324 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13325 .endtable
13326
13327
13328
13329 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13330 .table2
13331 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13332 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13333 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13334 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13335 .endtable
13336
13337
13338
13339 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13340 .table2
13341 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13342 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13343 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13344 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13345 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13346 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13347 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13348 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13349 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13350 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13351 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13352 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13353 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13354 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13355 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13356 .endtable
13357
13358
13359
13360 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13361 .table2
13362 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13363 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13364 .endtable
13365
13366
13367
13368 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13369 .table2
13370 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13371 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13372 .endtable
13373
13374
13375
13376 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13377 .table2
13378 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13379 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13380 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13381 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13382 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13383 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13384 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13385 .endtable
13386
13387
13388
13389 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13390 .table2
13391 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13392 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13393 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13394 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13395 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13396 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13397 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13398 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13399 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13400 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13401 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13402 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13403 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13404 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13405 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13406 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13407 connection"
13408 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13409 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13410 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13411 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13412 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13413 .endtable
13414
13415
13416
13417 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13418 .table2
13419 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13420 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13421 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13422 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13423 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13424 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13425 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13426 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13427 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13428 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13429 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13430 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13431 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13432 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13433 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13434 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13435 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13436 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13437 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13438 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13439 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13440 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13441 words""&"
13442 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13443 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13444 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13445 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13446 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13447 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13448 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13449 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13450 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13451 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13452 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13453 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13454 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13455 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13456 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13457 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13458 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13459 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13460 .endtable
13461
13462
13463
13464 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13465 .table2
13466 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13467 item"
13468 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13469 item"
13470 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13471 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13472 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13473 .endtable
13474
13475
13476
13477 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13478 .table2
13479 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13480 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13481 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13482 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13483 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13484 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13485 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13486 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13487 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13488 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13489 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13490 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13491 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13492 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13493 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13494 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13495 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13496 .endtable
13497
13498
13499
13500 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13501 .table2
13502 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13503 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13504 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13505 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13506 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13507 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13508 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13509 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13510 .endtable
13511
13512
13513
13514 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13515 .table2
13516 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13517 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13518 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13519 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13520 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13521 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13522 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13523 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13524 .endtable
13525
13526
13527
13528
13529 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13530 .table2
13531 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13532 .endtable
13533
13534
13535
13536
13537
13538 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13539 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13540
13541 .table2
13542 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13543 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13544 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13545 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13546 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13547 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13548 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13549 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13550 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13551 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13552 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13553 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13554 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13555 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13556 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13557 connection"
13558 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13559 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13560 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13561 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13562 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13563 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13564 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13565 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13566 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13567 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13568 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13569 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13570 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13571 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13572 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13573 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13574 .endtable
13575
13576
13577
13578 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13579 .table2
13580 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13581 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13582 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13583 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13584 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13585 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13586 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13587 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13588 .endtable
13589
13590
13591
13592 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13593 .table2
13594 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13595 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13596 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13597 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13598 words""&"
13599 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13600 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13601 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13602 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13603 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13604 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13605 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13606 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13607 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13608 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13609 .endtable
13610
13611
13612
13613 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13614 .table2
13615 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13616 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13617 directory"
13618 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13619 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13620 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13621 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13622 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13623 .endtable
13624
13625
13626
13627 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13628 .table2
13629 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13630 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13631 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13632 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13633 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13634 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13635 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13636 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13637 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13638 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13639 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13640 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13641 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13642 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13643 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13644 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13645 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13646 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13647 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13648 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13649 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13650 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13651 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13652 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13653 .endtable
13654
13655
13656
13657 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13658 .table2
13659 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13660 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13661 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13662 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13663 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13664 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13665 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13666 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13667 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13668 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13669 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13670 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13671 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13672 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13673 .endtable
13674
13675
13676
13677 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13678 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13679 &dagger;.
13680
13681 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13682 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13683 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13684 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13685 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13686 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13687 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13688 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13689 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13690
13691 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13692 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13693 It now defaults to true.
13694 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13695 .display
13696 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13697 .endd
13698
13699 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13700 .code
13701 log_selector = +8bitmime
13702 .endd
13703
13704 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13705 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13706 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13707 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13708 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13709 further details.
13710
13711 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13712 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13713 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13714 SMTP messages.
13715
13716 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13717 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13718 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13719 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13720 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13721
13722 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13723 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13724 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13725 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13726 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13727
13728 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13729 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13730 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13731 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13732
13733 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13734 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13735 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13736 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13737 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13738
13739 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13740 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13741 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13742 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13743 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13744 This option defines the ACL that,
13745 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13746 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13747 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13748 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13749
13750 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13751 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13752 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13753 of a received message.
13754 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13755
13756 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13757 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13758 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13759 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13760
13761 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13762 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13763 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13764 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13765
13766 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13767 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13768 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13769 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13770 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13771
13772
13773 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13774 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13775 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13776 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13777
13778 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13779 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13780 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13781 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13782 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13783
13784 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13785 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13786 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13787 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13788 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13789
13790 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13791 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13792 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13793 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13794 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13795
13796 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13797 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13798 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13799 further details.
13800
13801 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13802 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13803 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13804 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13805
13806 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13807 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13808 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13809 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13810
13811 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13812 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13813 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13814 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13815
13816 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13817 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13818 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13819 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13820
13821 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13822 .cindex "admin user"
13823 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13824 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13825 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13826 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13827 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13828 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13829 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13830
13831 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13832 .cindex "domain literal"
13833 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13834 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13835 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13836 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13837
13838 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13839 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13840 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13841 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13842 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13843 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13844 the local host's IP addresses.
13845
13846
13847 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13848 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13849 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13850 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13851 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13852 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13853 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13854 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13855 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13856
13857 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13858 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13859 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13860 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13861 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13862 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13863 experiment if they wish.
13864
13865 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13866 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13867 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13868 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13869 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13870 suitable setting is:
13871 .code
13872 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13873 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13874 .endd
13875 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13876 .code
13877 dns_check_names_pattern =
13878 .endd
13879 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13880
13881
13882 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13883 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13884 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13885 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13886 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13887 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13888 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13889 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13890 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13891 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13892 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13893
13894 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13895 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13896 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13897 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13898 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13899 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13900
13901 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13902 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13903 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13904 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13905 .code
13906 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13907 .endd
13908 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13909 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13910 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13911 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13912
13913
13914 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13915 .cindex "thawing messages"
13916 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13917 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13918 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13919 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13920 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13921 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13922
13923 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13924 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13925 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13926
13927
13928 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13929 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13930 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13931 .code
13932 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13933 .endd
13934 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13935 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13936
13937
13938 .option bi_command main string unset
13939 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13940 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13941 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13942 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13943 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13944
13945
13946 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13947 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13948 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13949 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13950 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13951 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13952
13953
13954 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13955 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13956 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13957 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13958
13959 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13960 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13961 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13962 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13963 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13964 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13965 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13966 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13967 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13968 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13969
13970 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13971 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13972 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13973 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13974
13975
13976 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13977 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13978 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13979 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13980 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13981 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13982 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13983 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13984 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13985
13986 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13987 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13988 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13989 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13990 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13991 messages.
13992
13993 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13994 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13995 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13996 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13997 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13998 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13999 connection. A typical setting might be:
14000 .code
14001 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14002 .endd
14003 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14004 .code
14005 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14006 .endd
14007 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14008 address.
14009
14010 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14011 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14012 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14013 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14014 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14015 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14016
14017
14018 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14019 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14020 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14021 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14022
14023
14024 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14025 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14026 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14027 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14028
14029
14030 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14031 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14032 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14033 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14034
14035
14036 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14037 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14038 callout verification. The default value is
14039 .code
14040 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14041 .endd
14042 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14043
14044
14045 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14046 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14047
14048
14049 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14050 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14051
14052 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14053 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14054 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14055 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14056 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14057 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14058 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14059 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14060 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14061 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14062
14063
14064 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14065 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14066
14067
14068 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14069 .cindex "checking disk space"
14070 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14071 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14072 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14073 message is accepted.
14074
14075 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14076 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14077 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14078 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14079 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14080 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14081 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14082 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14083
14084
14085 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14086 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14087 .code
14088 check_spool_space = 10M
14089 check_spool_inodes = 100
14090 .endd
14091 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14092 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14093 transit.
14094
14095 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14096 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14097 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14098
14099 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14100 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14101 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14102 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14103 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14104 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14105
14106 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14107 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14108
14109 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14110 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14111 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14112
14113 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14114 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14115 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14116 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14117 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14118 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14119
14120 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14121 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14122 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14123 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14124 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14125 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14126 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14127
14128 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14129 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14130
14131 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14132 .cindex "warning of delay"
14133 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14134 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14135 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14136 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14137 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14138 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14139 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14140 with
14141 .code
14142 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14143 .endd
14144 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14145 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14146 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14147 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14148 .code
14149 delay_warning = 6h
14150 .endd
14151 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14152 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14153 .code
14154 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14155 .endd
14156 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14157 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14158 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14159
14160 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14161 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14162 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14163 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14164 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14165 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14166 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14167 not sent. The default is:
14168 .code
14169 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14170 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14171 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14172 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14173 } {no}{yes}}
14174 .endd
14175 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14176 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14177 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14178 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14179
14180 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14181 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14182 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14183 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14184 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14185 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14186 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14187 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14188
14189 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14190 .cindex "load average"
14191 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14192 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14193 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14194 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14195 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14196
14197
14198 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14199 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14200 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14201 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14202 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14203 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14204 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14205 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14206
14207 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14208 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14209 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14210 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14211 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14212 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14213 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14214 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14215
14216 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14217 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14218 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14219 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14220
14221
14222 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14223 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14224 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14225 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14226 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14227 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14228 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14229
14230
14231 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14232 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14233 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14234 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14235 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14236 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14237
14238
14239 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14240 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14241 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14242 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14243 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14244 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14245 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14246 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14247 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14248 by a setting such as this:
14249 .code
14250 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14251 .endd
14252 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14253 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14254 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14255 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14256 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14257 options are applied after this global option.
14258
14259 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14260 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14261 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14262 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14263 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14264 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14265 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14266 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14267 value of this option. The default pattern is
14268 .code
14269 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14270 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14271 .endd
14272 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14273 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14274 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14275 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14276 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14277 empty string.
14278
14279 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14280 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14281 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14282
14283 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14284 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14285 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14286 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14287
14288
14289 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14290 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14291 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14292 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14293 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14294 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14295
14296 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14297
14298
14299 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14300 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14301 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14302 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14303 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14304 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14305 domain matches this list.
14306
14307 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14308 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14309 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14310
14311
14312 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14313 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14314 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14315 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14316 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14317 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14318 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14319 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14320 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14321 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14322 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14323 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14324 to set in them.
14325 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14326
14327
14328 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14329 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14330
14331
14332 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14333 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14334 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14335 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14336 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14337 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14338 match with this expanded domain list.
14339
14340 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14341 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14342 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14343 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14344 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14345 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14346
14347 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14348 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14349 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14350
14351 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14352 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14353 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14354 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14355 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14356
14357 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14358 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14359 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14360 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14361 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14362 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14363 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14364 on.
14365
14366 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14367
14368
14369 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14370 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14371 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14372 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14373
14374 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14375 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14376 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14377 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14378 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14379 and accepted from, these hosts.
14380 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14381 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14382 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14383 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14384 are sent.
14385
14386 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14387 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14388 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14389 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14390 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14391 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14392 .code
14393 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14394 .endd
14395 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14396 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14397
14398 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14399 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14400 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14401 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14402 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14403 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14404 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14405 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14406 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14407
14408
14409 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14410 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14411 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14412 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14413 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14414 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14415 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14416 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14417 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14418
14419 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14420 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14421 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14422 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14423 are examined. For example:
14424 .code
14425 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14426 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14427 postmaster@mydomain.example
14428 .endd
14429 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14430 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14431 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14432 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14433 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14434 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14435 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14436
14437
14438 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14439 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14440 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14441 .display
14442 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14443 .endd
14444 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14445 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14446 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14447 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14448 overrides the default.
14449
14450 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14451 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14452 and warning messages. For example:
14453 .code
14454 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14455 .endd
14456 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14457 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14458 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14459 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14460 not used.
14461
14462
14463 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14464 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14465 .cindex "Exim group"
14466 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14467 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14468 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14469 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14470 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14471 security issues.
14472
14473
14474 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14475 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14476 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14477 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14478 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14479 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14480 other place.
14481 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14482 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14483 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14484 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14485
14486
14487 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14488 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14489 .cindex "Exim user"
14490 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14491 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14492 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14493 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14494
14495 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14496 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14497 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14498 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14499
14500
14501 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14502 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14503 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14504 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14505
14506
14507 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14508 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14509
14510 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14511 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14512 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14513 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14514 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14515 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14516 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14517 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14518 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14519 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14520 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14521 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14522 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14523 addresses.
14524
14525
14526 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14527 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14528 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14529 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14530 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14531 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14532 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14533 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14534 retries.
14535
14536 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14537 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14538 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14539 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14540
14541
14542
14543 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14544 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14545 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14546 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14547 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14548 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14549 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14550 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14551 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14552 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14553 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14554 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14555 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14556 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14557 logging that you require.
14558
14559
14560 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14561 .cindex "HP-UX"
14562 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14563 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14564 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14565 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14566 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14567 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14568 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14569 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14570
14571 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14572 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14573 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14574 user's name.
14575
14576 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14577 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14578 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14579 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14580 .code
14581 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14582 gecos_name = $1
14583 .endd
14584
14585 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14586 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14587
14588
14589 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14590 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14591 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14592 implementations of TLS.
14593
14594
14595 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14596 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14597 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14598
14599 See
14600 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14601 for documentation.
14602
14603
14604
14605 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14606 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14607 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14608 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14609 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14610 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14611
14612
14613
14614 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14615 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14616 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14617 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14618 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14619 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14620 sections are rejected.
14621
14622
14623 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14624 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14625 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14626 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14627 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14628 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14629 zero means &"no limit"&.
14630
14631
14632
14633
14634 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14635 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14636 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14637 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14638 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14639 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14640 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14641 if you want to do semantic checking.
14642 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14643 set.
14644
14645
14646 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14647 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14648 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14649 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14650 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14651 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14652 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14653 .code
14654 helo_allow_chars = _
14655 .endd
14656 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14657
14658
14659 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14660 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14661 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14662 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14663 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14664 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14665 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14666 do.
14667
14668
14669 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14670 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14671 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14672 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14673 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14674 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14675 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14676 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14677 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14678 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14679 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14680 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14681
14682 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14683 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14684 EHLO command either:
14685
14686 .ilist
14687 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14688 .next
14689 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14690 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14691 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14692 calling host address, or
14693 .next
14694 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14695 .endlist
14696
14697 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14698 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14699 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14700
14701 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14702 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14703 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14704
14705 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14706 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14707 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14708 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14709 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14710 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14711 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14712 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14713 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14714 error.
14715
14716 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14717 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14718 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14719 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14720 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14721 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14722 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14723 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14724 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14725
14726 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14727 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14728 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14729 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14730 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14731
14732 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14733 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14734 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14735 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14736
14737
14738 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14739 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14740 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14741 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14742 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14743 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14744 default configuration file contains
14745 .code
14746 host_lookup = *
14747 .endd
14748 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14749 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14750
14751 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14752 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14753 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14754
14755 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14756 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14757 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14758 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14759 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14760 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14761
14762
14763 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14764 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14765 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14766 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14767 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14768 if you want.
14769
14770 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14771 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14772 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14773 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14774
14775
14776
14777 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14778 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14779 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14780 as soon as the connection is made.
14781 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14782 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14783 connections immediately.
14784
14785 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14786 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14787 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14788 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14789 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14790
14791
14792 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14793 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14794 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14795 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14796 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14797 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14798 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14799 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14800 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14801 .code
14802 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14803 .endd
14804 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14805
14806
14807
14808 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14809 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14810 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14811 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14812 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14813 records
14814 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14815 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14816
14817 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14818 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14819 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14820 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14821 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14822 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14823 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14824
14825
14826 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14827 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14828 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14829 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14830 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14831
14832
14833
14834 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14835 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14836 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14837 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14838 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14839 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14840
14841 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14842 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14843 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14844 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14845 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14846 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14847 for frozen messages. For example,
14848 .code
14849 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14850 .endd
14851 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14852 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14853 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14854 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14855 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14856 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14857
14858
14859 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14860 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14861 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14862 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14863 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14864 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14865 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14866 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14867 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14868 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14869
14870
14871 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14872 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14873
14874
14875 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14876 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14877 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14878 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14879 logged.
14880
14881
14882 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14883 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14884 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14885 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14886 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14887 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14888 and constrained to be a directory.
14889
14890
14891 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14892 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14893 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14894 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14895 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14896 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14897 and constrained to be a file.
14898
14899
14900 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14901 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14902 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14903 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14904 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14905
14906
14907 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14908 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14909 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14910 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14911 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14912 identity to be proven.
14913
14914
14915 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14916 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14917 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14918 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14919 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14920
14921
14922 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14923 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14924 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14925 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14926 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14927 with LDAP support.
14928
14929
14930 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14931 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14932 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14933 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14934 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14935 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14936 to hard/demand.
14937
14938
14939 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14940 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14941 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14942 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14943 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14944 of SSL-on-connect.
14945 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14946 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14947
14948
14949 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14950 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14951 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14952 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14953 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14954 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14955 has been built with LDAP support.
14956
14957
14958
14959 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14960 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14961 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14962 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14963 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14964 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14965 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14966
14967 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14968 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14969 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14970
14971 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14972 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14973 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14974 and the default qualify domain.
14975
14976 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14977 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14978 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14979 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14980
14981 .cindex "envelope sender"
14982 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14983 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14984 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14985
14986 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14987 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14988 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14989
14990
14991
14992
14993 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14994 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14995 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14996 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14997 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14998 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14999 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15000 example, if
15001 .code
15002 local_from_prefix = *-
15003 .endd
15004 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15005 .code
15006 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15007 .endd
15008 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15009 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15010 qualify domain.
15011
15012
15013 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15014 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15015
15016
15017 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15018 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15019 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15020 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15021 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15022 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15023 &%local_interfaces%& is
15024 .code
15025 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15026 .endd
15027 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15028 .code
15029 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15030 .endd
15031
15032 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15033 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15034 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15035 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15036 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15037 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15038 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15039 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15040
15041
15042
15043 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15044 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15045 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15046 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15047 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15048 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15049 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15050 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15051
15052
15053
15054
15055 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15056 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15057 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15058 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15059 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15060 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15061 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15062 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15063 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15064 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15065 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15066 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15067 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15068 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15069 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15070
15071
15072
15073 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15074 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15075 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15076 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15077 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15078 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15079 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15080 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15081 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15082 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15083 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15084 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15085 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15086 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15087 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15088
15089
15090 .option log_selector main string unset
15091 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15092 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15093 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15094 minus characters. For example:
15095 .code
15096 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15097 .endd
15098 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15099 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15100
15101
15102 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15103 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15104 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15105 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15106 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15107 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15108 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15109 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15110 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15111 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15112 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15113 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15114 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15115
15116
15117 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15118 .cindex "too many open files"
15119 .cindex "open files, too many"
15120 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15121 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15122 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15123 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15124 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15125 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15126 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15127 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15128 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15129 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15130 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15131 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15132
15133
15134 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15135 .cindex "length of login name"
15136 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15137 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15138 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15139 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15140 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15141 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15142
15143
15144 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15145 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15146 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15147 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15148 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15149 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15150 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15151 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15152
15153
15154 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15155 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15156 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15157 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15158 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15159 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15160 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15161
15162
15163 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15164 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15165 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15166 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15167 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15168 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15169 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15170 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15171 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15172 empty string, the option is ignored.
15173
15174
15175 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15176 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15177 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15178 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15179 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15180 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15181 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15182 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15183 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15184 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15185 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15186 colons will become hyphens.
15187
15188
15189 .option message_logs main boolean true
15190 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15191 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15192 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15193 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15194 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15195 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15196 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15197 which is not affected by this option.
15198
15199
15200 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15201 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15202 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15203 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15204 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15205 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15206 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15207 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15208 optionally followed by K or M.
15209
15210 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15211 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15212 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15213 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15214 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15215
15216 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15217 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15218 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15219 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15220 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15221 message that an individual transport can process.
15222
15223 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15224 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15225 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15226 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15227 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15228 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15229 some problems may result.
15230
15231 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15232 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15233 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15234
15235
15236 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15237 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15238 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15239 .code
15240 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15241 .endd
15242 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15243 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15244 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15245 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15246 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15247
15248
15249 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15250 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15251 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15252 contains a full description of this facility.
15253
15254
15255
15256 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15257 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15258 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15259 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15260 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15261
15262
15263 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15264 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15265 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15266 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15267 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15268 safety precaution.
15269
15270 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15271 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15272 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15273 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15274 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15275
15276 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15277 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15278 example is
15279 .code
15280 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15281 .endd
15282 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15283 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15284 transport driver.
15285
15286
15287 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15288 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15289 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15290 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15291 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15292
15293 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15294 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15295 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15296 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15297 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15298 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15299 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15300
15301 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15302 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15303 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15304 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15305 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15306
15307 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15308
15309 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15310 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15311 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15312 some now infamous attacks.
15313
15314 Examples:
15315 .code
15316 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15317 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15318 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15319
15320 # Disable older protocol versions:
15321 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15322 .endd
15323
15324 Possible options may include:
15325 .ilist
15326 &`all`&
15327 .next
15328 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15329 .next
15330 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15331 .next
15332 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15333 .next
15334 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15335 .next
15336 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15337 .next
15338 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15339 .next
15340 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15341 .next
15342 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15343 .next
15344 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15345 .next
15346 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15347 .next
15348 &`no_compression`&
15349 .next
15350 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15351 .next
15352 &`no_sslv2`&
15353 .next
15354 &`no_sslv3`&
15355 .next
15356 &`no_ticket`&
15357 .next
15358 &`no_tlsv1`&
15359 .next
15360 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15361 .next
15362 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15363 .next
15364 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15365 .next
15366 &`single_dh_use`&
15367 .next
15368 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15369 .next
15370 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15371 .next
15372 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15373 .next
15374 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15375 .next
15376 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15377 .next
15378 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15379 .endlist
15380
15381 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15382 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15383 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15384 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15385 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15386 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15387
15388
15389 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15390 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15391 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15392 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15393 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15394
15395
15396 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15397 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15398 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15399 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15400 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15401 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15402 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15403 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15404 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15405 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15406 an ACL.
15407
15408 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15409 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15410 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15411 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15412 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15413 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15414 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15415
15416
15417 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15418 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15419 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15420
15421
15422 .option perl_startup main string unset
15423 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15424 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15425
15426
15427 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15428 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15429 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15430 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15431 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15432 PostgreSQL support.
15433
15434
15435 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15436 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15437 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15438 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15439 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15440 to the host name:
15441 .code
15442 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15443 .endd
15444 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15445 spool directory.
15446 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15447 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15448 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15449
15450
15451 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15452 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15453 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15454 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15455 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15456 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15457 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15458 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15459 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15460
15461
15462 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15463 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15464 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15465 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15466 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15467 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15468 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15469 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15470
15471 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15472 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15473 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15474 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15475 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15476 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15477 volume of mail. Use with care!
15478
15479
15480 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15481 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15482 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15483 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15484 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15485 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15486 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15487 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15488 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15489 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15490
15491 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15492 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15493 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15494 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15495 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15496 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15497
15498
15499 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15500 .cindex "printing characters"
15501 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15502 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15503 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15504 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15505 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15506 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15507 characters.
15508
15509 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15510 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15511 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15512 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15513 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15514 standards.
15515
15516
15517 .option process_log_path main string unset
15518 .cindex "process log path"
15519 .cindex "log" "process log"
15520 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15521 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15522 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15523 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15524 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15525 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15526 different spool directories.
15527
15528
15529 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15530 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15531 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15532 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15533 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15534 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15535 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15536
15537
15538 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15539 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15540 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15541 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15542 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15543 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15544 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15545 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15546 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15547
15548 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15549 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15550 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15551 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15552 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15553 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15554 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15555
15556
15557 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15558 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15559 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15560
15561
15562
15563 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15564 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15565 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15566 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15567 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15568 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15569 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15570 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15571
15572
15573 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15574 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15575 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15576 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15577 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15578
15579
15580 .option queue_only main boolean false
15581 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15582 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15583 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15584 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15585 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15586 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15587
15588 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15589 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15590 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15591 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15592
15593
15594 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15595 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15596 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15597 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15598 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15599 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15600 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15601 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15602 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15603 .code
15604 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15605 .endd
15606 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15607 &_/some/file_& exists.
15608
15609
15610 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15611 .cindex "load average"
15612 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15613 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15614 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15615 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15616 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15617 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15618 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15619 false.
15620
15621 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15622 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15623 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15624 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15625
15626
15627 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15628 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15629 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15630 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15631 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15632 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15633 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15634 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15635 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15636 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15637 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15638 re-evaluated for each message.
15639
15640
15641 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15642 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15643 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15644 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15645 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15646 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15647
15648
15649 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15650 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15651 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15652 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15653 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15654 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15655 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15656 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15657 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15658 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15659 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15660 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15661 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15662
15663
15664
15665 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15666 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15667 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15668 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15669 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15670 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15671 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15672 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15673 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15674
15675 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15676 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15677 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15678 the daemon's command line.
15679
15680 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15681 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15682 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15683 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15684 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15685 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15686 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15687 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15688 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15689 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15690 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15691 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15692 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15693 &%queue_domains%&.
15694
15695
15696 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15697 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15698 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15699 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15700 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15701 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15702 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15703
15704 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15705 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15706 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15707 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15708 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15709 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15710 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15711 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15712 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15713 header lines. The default setting is:
15714
15715 .code
15716 received_header_text = Received: \
15717 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15718 {${if def:sender_ident \
15719 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15720 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15721 by $primary_hostname \
15722 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15723 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15724 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15725 ${if def:sender_address \
15726 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15727 id $message_exim_id\
15728 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15729 .endd
15730
15731 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15732 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15733 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15734 header lines such as the following:
15735 .code
15736 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15737 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15738 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15739 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15740 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15741 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15742 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15743 .endd
15744 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15745 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15746 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15747 message was accepted.
15748
15749
15750 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15751 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15752 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15753 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15754 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15755 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15756 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15757 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15758
15759
15760 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15761 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15762 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15763 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15764 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15765 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15766 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15767 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15768 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15769 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15770 option was not set.
15771
15772
15773 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15774 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15775 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15776 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15777 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15778 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15779 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15780 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15781 done.
15782
15783 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15784 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15785 RCPT commands in a single message.
15786
15787
15788 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15789 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15790 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15791 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15792 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15793 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15794 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15795
15796
15797 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15798 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15799 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15800 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15801 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15802 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15803 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15804 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15805 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15806 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15807 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15808 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15809 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15810 tagged with its process id.
15811
15812 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15813 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15814 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15815 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15816 is received.
15817
15818 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15819 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15820 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15821 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15822 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15823 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15824 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15825 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15826 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15827 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15828 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15829
15830 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15831 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15832 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15833 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15834
15835
15836 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15837 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15838 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15839 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15840 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15841 .code
15842 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15843 .endd
15844 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15845 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15846
15847
15848 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15849 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15850 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15851 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15852 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15853 past failures.
15854
15855
15856 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15857 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15858 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15859 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15860 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15861 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15862 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15863 the default value.
15864
15865
15866 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15867 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15868 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15869 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15870 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15871 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15872 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15873 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15874 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15875 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15876
15877
15878 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15879 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15880
15881
15882 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15883 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15884 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15885 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15886 an item in the list.
15887 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15888 for the system.
15889
15890 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15891 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15892 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15893 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15894 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15895
15896
15897 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15898 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15899 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15900 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15901 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15902 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15903 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15904 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15905 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15906 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15907
15908
15909 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15910 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15911 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15912 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15913 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15914 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15915 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15916
15917
15918
15919 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15920 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15921 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15922 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15923 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15924 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15925 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15926 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15927 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15928 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15929 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15930
15931
15932
15933 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15934 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15935 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15936 .cindex "inetd"
15937 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15938 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15939 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15940 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15941 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15942 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15943
15944 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15945 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15946 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15947 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15948
15949
15950 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15951 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15952 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15953 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15954 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15955 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15956 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15957 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15958
15959 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15960 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15961 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15962 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15963 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15964 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15965 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15966 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15967
15968
15969 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15970 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15971 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15972 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15973 live with.
15974
15975
15976 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15977 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15978 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15979 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15980 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15981 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15982 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15983 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15984 . the option name to split.
15985
15986 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15987 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15988 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15989 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15990 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15991 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15992 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15993 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15994 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15995 seen).
15996
15997
15998 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15999 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16000 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16001 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16002 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16003 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16004 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16005 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16006 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16007 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16008 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16009
16010 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16011 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16012 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16013 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16014 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16015 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16016
16017
16018
16019 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16020 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16021 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16022 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16023 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16024 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16025 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16026 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16027 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16028 to all messages received in the same connection.
16029
16030 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16031 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16032 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16033 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16034
16035
16036 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16037
16038 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16039 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16040 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16041 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16042 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16043 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16044 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16045 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16046 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16047 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16048 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16049 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16050 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16051
16052
16053 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16054 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16055 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16056 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16057 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16058 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16059 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16060 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16061 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16062 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16063 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16064 individual host.
16065
16066 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16067 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16068 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16069 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16070
16071
16072 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16073 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16074 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16075 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16076 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16077 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16078 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16079 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16080 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16081
16082 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16083 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16084 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16085 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16086
16087 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16088 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16089 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16090 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16091 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16092 For example:
16093 .code
16094 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16095 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16096 .endd
16097
16098 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16099 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16100 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16101 &%helo_data%& value.
16102
16103 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16104 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16105 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16106 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16107 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16108 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16109 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16110 .code
16111 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16112 $version_number $tod_full
16113 .endd
16114 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16115 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16116 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16117 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16118 multiline response).
16119
16120
16121 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16122 .cindex "checking disk space"
16123 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16124 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16125 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16126 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16127 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16128 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16129 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16130
16131
16132 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16133 .cindex "connection backlog"
16134 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16135 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16136 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16137 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16138 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16139 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16140 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16141 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16142 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16143 attacks by SYN flooding.
16144
16145
16146 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16147 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16148 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16149 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16150 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16151 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16152 fewer, but they still exist.
16153
16154 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16155 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16156 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16157 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16158 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16159 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16160 does detect many instances.
16161
16162 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16163 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16164 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16165 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16166
16167
16168
16169 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16170 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16171 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16172 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16173 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16174 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16175 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16176 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16177 example:
16178 .code
16179 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16180 $sender_host_address
16181 .endd
16182 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16183 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16184 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16185 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16186 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16187 the command.
16188
16189
16190 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16191 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16192 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16193 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16194 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16195
16196
16197 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16198 .cindex "load average"
16199 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16200 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16201 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16202 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16203 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16204 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16205
16206
16207
16208 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16209 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16210 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16211 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16212 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16213 .code
16214 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16215 .endd
16216 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16217 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16218 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16219 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16220 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16221
16222 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16223 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16224 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16225 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16226 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16227 not count towards the limit.
16228
16229
16230
16231 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16232 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16233 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16234 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16235 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16236 that subvert web
16237 clients
16238 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16239 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16240
16241
16242
16243 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16244 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16245 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16246 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16247 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16248 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16249 recipients.
16250
16251 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16252 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16253 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16254 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16255
16256 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16257 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16258 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16259 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16260 values:
16261
16262 .ilist
16263 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16264 .next
16265 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16266 fractional parts are allowed here.
16267 .next
16268 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16269 .next
16270 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16271 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16272 .endlist
16273
16274 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16275 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16276 .code
16277 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16278 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16279 .endd
16280 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16281 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16282 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16283 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16284
16285
16286 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16287 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16288
16289
16290 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16291 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16292
16293
16294 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16295 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16296 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16297 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16298 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16299 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16300 the message is abandoned.
16301 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16302 .code
16303 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16304 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16305 .endd
16306 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16307 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16308
16309 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16310 expanded before use and may depend on
16311 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16312
16313
16314 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16315 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16316 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16317 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16318 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16319 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16320
16321
16322 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16323 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16324 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16325
16326
16327 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16328 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16329 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16330 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16331 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16332 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16333 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16334 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16335 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16336 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16337 .code
16338 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16339 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16340 .endd
16341
16342 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16343 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16344 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16345 The default value is
16346 .code
16347 127.0.0.1 783
16348 .endd
16349 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16350
16351
16352
16353 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16354 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16355 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16356 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16357 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16358 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16359 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16360 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16361 arrival of the message.
16362
16363 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16364 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16365 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16366 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16367 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16368
16369 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16370 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16371 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16372 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16373 automatically deleted.
16374
16375 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16376 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16377 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16378 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16379 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16380 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16381 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16382 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16383 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16384
16385
16386 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16387 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16388 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16389 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16390 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16391 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16392 &$primary_hostname$&.
16393
16394 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16395 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16396 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16397 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16398 as failures in the configuration file.
16399
16400 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16401 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16402
16403 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16404 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16405 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16406 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16407
16408 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16409 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16410 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16411 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16412 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16413 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16414
16415 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16416 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16417 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16418 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16419 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16420 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16421 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16422
16423
16424 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16425 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16426 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16427 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16428 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16429 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16430 domain causes a syntax error.
16431 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16432 syntax checking.
16433
16434
16435 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16436 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16437 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16438 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16439 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16440 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16441 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16442 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16443 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16444 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16445 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16446 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16447
16448
16449 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16450 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16451 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16452 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16453 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16454 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16455 details of Exim's logging.
16456
16457
16458
16459 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16460 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16461 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16462 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16463 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16464
16465
16466
16467 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16468 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16469 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16470 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16471 details of Exim's logging.
16472
16473
16474 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16475 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16476 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16477 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16478 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16479 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16480 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16481 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16482 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16483 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16484 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16485
16486
16487 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16488 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16489 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16490 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16491 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16492 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16493
16494
16495 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16496 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16497 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16498 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16499 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16500
16501 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16502 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16503 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16504 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16505 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16506
16507 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16508 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16509 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16510 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16511 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16512 contains the pipe command.
16513
16514
16515 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16516 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16517 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16518 is used in a system filter.
16519
16520
16521 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16522 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16523 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16524 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16525 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16526 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16527 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16528 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16529 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16530 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16531
16532 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16533 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16534 transport option overrides.
16535
16536
16537 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16538 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16539 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16540 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16541 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16542 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16543 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16544 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16545 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16546 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16547 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16548 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16549 TCP_NODELAY.
16550
16551
16552 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16553 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16554 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16555 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16556 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16557 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16558 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16559 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16560 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16561 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16562
16563 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16564 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16565 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16566
16567
16568 .option timezone main string unset
16569 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16570 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16571 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16572 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16573 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16574 .code
16575 timezone = UTC
16576 .endd
16577 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16578 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16579 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16580 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16581 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16582 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16583
16584
16585 .new
16586 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16587 .wen
16588 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16589 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16590 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16591 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16592 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16593 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16594 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16595 .new
16596 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16597 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16598 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16599 .wen
16600
16601
16602 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16603 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16604 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16605 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16606 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16607 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16608 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16609
16610 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16611 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16612 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16613 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16614
16615 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16616 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16617 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16618 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16619
16620 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16621 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16622 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16623 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16624 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16625
16626 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16627
16628
16629 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16630 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16631 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16632 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16633 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16634 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16635
16636 The value must be at least 1024.
16637
16638 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16639 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16640 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16641
16642 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16643 number.
16644
16645 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16646 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16647 larger prime than requested.
16648
16649
16650 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16651 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16652 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16653 to be used by Exim.
16654
16655 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16656 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16657 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16658 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16659 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16660 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16661 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16662
16663 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16664 loaded by Exim.
16665
16666 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16667 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16668 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16669 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16670
16671 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16672 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16673 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16674 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16675
16676 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16677 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16678 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16679 "ike23".
16680
16681 The available primes are:
16682 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16683 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16684 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16685
16686 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16687 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16688
16689 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16690 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16691 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16692 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16693 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16694 userbase.
16695
16696 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16697 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16698 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16699 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16700 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16701 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16702 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16703
16704
16705 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16706 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16707 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16708 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16709
16710 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16711 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16712 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16713 which tell the library to choose.
16714
16715 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16716
16717
16718 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16719 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16720 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16721 This option
16722 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16723 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16724 Certificate Authority.
16725
16726 .new
16727 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16728 .wen
16729
16730
16731 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16732 .cindex SSMTP
16733 .cindex SMTPS
16734 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16735 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16736 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16737 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16738
16739
16740
16741 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16742 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16743 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16744 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16745 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16746 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16747 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16748
16749 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16750
16751
16752 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16753 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16754 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16755 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16756 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16757 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16758 TLS session.
16759
16760
16761 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16762 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16763 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16764 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16765 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16766 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16767 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16768 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16769 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16770 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16771 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16772
16773
16774 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16775 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16776 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16777 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16778
16779
16780 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16781 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16782 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16783 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16784 word "system"
16785 or the absolute path to
16786 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16787 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16788
16789 The "system" value for the option will use a
16790 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16791 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16792 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16793 must be specified.
16794
16795 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16796 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16797
16798 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16799 explicitly
16800 either by file or directory
16801 are added to those given by the system default location.
16802
16803 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16804 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16805 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16806 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16807 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16808 use the explicit directory version.
16809
16810 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16811
16812 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16813 being unset.
16814
16815
16816 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16817 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16818 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16819 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16820 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16821 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16822 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16823 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16824
16825 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16826 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16827 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16828 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16829 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16830 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16831 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16832
16833 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16834 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16835 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16836 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16837 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16838 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16839 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16840 certificate"&.
16841
16842 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16843 certificates.
16844
16845
16846 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16847 .cindex "trusted groups"
16848 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16849 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16850 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16851 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16852 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16853 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16854 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16855 are trusted.
16856
16857 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16858 .cindex "trusted users"
16859 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16860 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16861 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16862 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16863 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16864 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16865 Exim user are trusted.
16866
16867 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16868 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16869 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16870 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16871 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16872 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16873 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16874 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16875 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16876 &%-F%& option.
16877
16878 .option unknown_username main string unset
16879 See &%unknown_login%&.
16880
16881 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16882 .cindex "trusted users"
16883 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16884 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16885 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16886 .cindex "envelope sender"
16887 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16888 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16889 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16890 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16891 is used) is ignored.
16892
16893 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16894 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16895 .code
16896 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16897 .endd
16898 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16899 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16900 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16901 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16902 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16903 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16904 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16905 followed by a hyphen
16906 by a setting like this:
16907 .code
16908 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16909 .endd
16910 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16911 restriction, you can use
16912 .code
16913 untrusted_set_sender = *
16914 .endd
16915 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16916 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16917 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16918 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16919 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16920 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16921 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16922 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16923
16924 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16925 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16926 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16927 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16928 sender address.
16929
16930
16931 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16932 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16933 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16934 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16935 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16936 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16937 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16938 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16939 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16940 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16941 .code
16942 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16943 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16944 .endd
16945 The pattern can be seen by running
16946 .code
16947 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16948 .endd
16949 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16950 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16951 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16952 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16953 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16954 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16955
16956
16957 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16958 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16959
16960
16961 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16962 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16963 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16964 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16965 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16966 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16967 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16968 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16969
16970
16971 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16972 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16973 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16974 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16975 .ecindex IIDconfima
16976 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16977
16978
16979
16980
16981 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16983
16984 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16985 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16986 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16987 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16988 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16989
16990 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16991 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16992 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16993 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16994 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16995
16996
16997
16998 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16999 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17000 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17001 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17002 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17003 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17004 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17005
17006 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17007 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17008 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17009 routers, and the eventual transport.
17010
17011 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17012 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17013 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17014 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17015 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17016
17017 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17018 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17019 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17020 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17021 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17022
17023 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17024 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17025 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17026 .code
17027 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17028 .endd
17029 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17030 .code
17031 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17032 .endd
17033 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17034 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17035
17036 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17037 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17038 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17039 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17040 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17041 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17042 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17043
17044
17045
17046 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17047 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17048 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17049 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17050 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17051 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17052 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17053 routing.
17054
17055
17056
17057 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17058 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17059 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17060 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17061 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17062 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17063 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17064 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17065 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17066 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17067 you could put:
17068 .code
17069 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17070 .endd
17071 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17072 and
17073 .code
17074 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17075 .endd
17076 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17077 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17078 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17079 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17080
17081
17082 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17083 .cindex "case of local parts"
17084 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17085 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17086 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17087 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17088 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17089 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17090 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17091 more details.
17092
17093 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17094 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17095 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17096 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17097 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17098 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17099 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17100 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17101 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17102
17103 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17104 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17105 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17106 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17107
17108
17109
17110 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17111 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17112 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17113 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17114 .vindex "&$home$&"
17115 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17116 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17117 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17118 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17119 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17120 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17121 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17122 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17123 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17124 the router is skipped.
17125
17126 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17127 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17128 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17129 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17130 setting to achieve this. For example:
17131 .code
17132 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17133 .endd
17134 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17135 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17136 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17137
17138
17139
17140 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17141 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17142 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17143 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17144 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17145 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17146 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17147 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17148
17149 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17150 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17151
17152 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17153 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17154
17155 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17156 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17157 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17158 .code
17159 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17160 .endd
17161 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17162 .code
17163 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17164 .endd
17165
17166 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17167 .code
17168 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17169 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17170 condition = foobar
17171 .endd
17172
17173 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17174 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17175 be specified using &%condition%&.
17176
17177 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17178 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17179 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17180 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17181 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17182 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17183 Router rules processing behavior.
17184
17185 This is best illustrated in an example:
17186 .code
17187 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17188 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17189
17190 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17191 true {yes} {no}}
17192
17193 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17194 {yes} {no}}
17195 .endd
17196 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17197 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17198 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17199 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17200 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17201 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17202 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17203 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17204
17205 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17206 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17207 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17208 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17209 string characters.
17210
17211 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17212 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17213 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17214 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17215 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17216
17217
17218 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17219 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17220 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17221 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17222 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17223 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17224 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17225 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17226 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17227 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17228 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17229 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17230 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17231 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17232
17233
17234
17235 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17236 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17237 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17238 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17239 transport option of the same name.
17240
17241 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17242 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17243 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17244 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17245 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17246 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17247 the dnssec request bit set.
17248 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17249
17250 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17251 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17252 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17253 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17254 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17255 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17256 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17257 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17258 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17259
17260
17261 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17262 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17263 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17264 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17265 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17266 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17267 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17268 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17269
17270
17271
17272 .option driver routers string unset
17273 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17274 to be used.
17275
17276
17277 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17278 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17279 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17280 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17281 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17282 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17283 Not effective on redirect routers.
17284
17285
17286
17287 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17288 .cindex "envelope sender"
17289 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17290 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17291 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17292 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17293 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17294 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17295 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17296
17297 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17298 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17299 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17300 setting.
17301
17302 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17303 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17304 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17305 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17306
17307 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17308 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17309 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17310 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17311 settings:
17312 .code
17313 errors_to =
17314 errors_to = ""
17315 .endd
17316 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17317 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17318 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17319 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17320 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17321
17322 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17323 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17324 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17325 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17326 setting &%return_path%&.
17327
17328 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17329 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17330 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17331
17332
17333
17334 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17335 .cindex "address" "testing"
17336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17337 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17338 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17339 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17340 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17341 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17342 on for the system alias file.
17343 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17344 are evaluated.
17345
17346 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17347 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17348 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17349
17350
17351
17352 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17353 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17354 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17355 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17356
17357
17358
17359 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17360 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17361 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17362
17363
17364
17365 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17366 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17367 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17368
17369
17370
17371 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17372 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17373 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17374 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17375 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17376 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17377 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17378 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17379 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17380
17381 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17382 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17383 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17384 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17385 transport for further details.
17386
17387
17388 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17389 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17390 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17391 .cindex "transport" "local"
17392 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17393 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17394 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17395 process.
17396 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17397 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17398 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17399 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17400 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17401
17402
17403
17404 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17405 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17406 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17407 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17408 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17409 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17410 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17411 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17412 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17413 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17414 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17415 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17416 &"see"& the added header lines.
17417
17418 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17419 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17420 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17421 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17422
17423 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17424 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17425
17426 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17427 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17428
17429 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17430 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17431 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17432 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17433 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17434 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17435 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17436 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17437 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17438 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17439
17440
17441
17442 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17443 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17444 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17445 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17446 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17447 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17448 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17449 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17450 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17451 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17452 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17453 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17454 &"see"& the original header lines.
17455
17456 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17457 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17458 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17459 errors.
17460
17461 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17462 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17463
17464 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17465 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17466
17467 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17468 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17469 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17470 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17471
17472 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17473 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17474 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17475
17476
17477
17478 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17479 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17480 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17481 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17482 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17483 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17484 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17485 like
17486 .code
17487 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17488 .endd
17489 by setting
17490 .code
17491 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17492 .endd
17493 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17494 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17495 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17496 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17497 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17498 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17499
17500 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17501 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17502 .code
17503 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17504 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17505 .endd
17506 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17507 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17508
17509 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17510 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17511 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17512 domain that is being routed.
17513
17514 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17515 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17516 checked.
17517
17518 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17519 .cindex "additional groups"
17520 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17521 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17522 .cindex "transport" "local"
17523 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17524 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17525 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17526 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17527 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17528
17529
17530
17531 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17532 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17533 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17534 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17535 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17536 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17537 evaluated.
17538
17539 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17540 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17541 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17542 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17543 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17544 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17545 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17546 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17547 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17548
17549 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17550 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17551 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17552 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17553 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17554 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17555 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17556 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17557 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17558 the relevant transport.
17559
17560 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17561 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17562 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17563 callout.
17564
17565 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17566 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17567 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17568 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17569 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17570 .code
17571 real_localuser:
17572 driver = accept
17573 local_part_prefix = real-
17574 check_local_user
17575 transport = local_delivery
17576 .endd
17577 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17578 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17579 .code
17580 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17581 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17582 .endd
17583
17584 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17585 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17586 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17587 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17588
17589
17590 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17591 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17592
17593
17594
17595 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17596 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17597 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17598 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17599 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17600 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17601 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17602 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17603 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17604 &%username-foo%&.
17605
17606
17607 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17608 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17609
17610
17611
17612 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17613 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17614 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17615 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17616 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17617 are evaluated, and
17618 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17619 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17620 example:
17621 .code
17622 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17623 .endd
17624 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17625 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17626 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17627 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17628 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17629 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17630 each virtual domain:
17631 .code
17632 postmaster:
17633 driver = redirect
17634 local_parts = postmaster
17635 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17636 .endd
17637
17638
17639 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17640 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17641 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17642 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17643 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17644 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17645 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17646 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17647 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17648 redirect addresses.
17649
17650
17651
17652 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17653 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17654 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17655 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17656 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17657 delivery to be deferred.
17658
17659 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17660 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17661 .oindex "&%self%&"
17662 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17663 means of the setting
17664 .code
17665 self = pass
17666 .endd
17667 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17668 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17669 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17670
17671 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17672 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17673 controls what happens next.
17674
17675
17676 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17677 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17678 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17679 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17680 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17681 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17682 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17683 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17684
17685 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17686 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17687 applies to all of them.
17688
17689
17690
17691 .option pass_router routers string unset
17692 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17693 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17694 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17695 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17696 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17697 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17698 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17699 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17700 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17701 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17702
17703
17704
17705 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17706 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17707 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17708 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17709 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17710 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17711
17712 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17713 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17714 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17715 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17716
17717
17718
17719 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17720 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17721 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17722 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17723 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17724 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17725 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17726
17727 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17728 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17729 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17730 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17731
17732 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17733 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17734 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17735 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17736 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17737
17738 .cindex "NFS"
17739 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17740 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17741 unavailable.
17742
17743 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17744 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17745 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17746 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17747 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17748 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17749 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17750 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17751
17752 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17753 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17754 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17755 operates as follows:
17756
17757 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17758 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17759 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17760 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17761 used. For example:
17762 .code
17763 require_files = mail:/some/file
17764 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17765 .endd
17766 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17767 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17768
17769 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17770 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17771 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17772 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17773
17774 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17775 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17776 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17777 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17778 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17779
17780 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17781 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17782 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17783 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17784 check again in that process.
17785
17786 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17787 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17788 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17789 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17790 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17791 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17792 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17793 .code
17794 require_files = +/some/file
17795 .endd
17796 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17797 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17798 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17799
17800
17801
17802 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17803 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17804 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17805 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17806 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17807 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17808 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17809 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17810 latter kind.
17811
17812 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17813 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17814 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17815 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17816 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17817 same name.
17818
17819 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17820 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17821 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17822
17823
17824
17825 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17826 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17827 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17828 .vindex "&$home$&"
17829 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17830 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17831 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17832 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17833 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17834 cause the router to defer.
17835
17836 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17837 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17838 place.
17839 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17840 are evaluated.)
17841 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17842 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17843
17844 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17845 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17846 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17847 of these values that is set:
17848
17849 .ilist
17850 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17851 .next
17852 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17853 .next
17854 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17855 .next
17856 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17857 .endlist
17858
17859 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17860 router, but not for the transport.
17861
17862
17863
17864 .option self routers string freeze
17865 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17866 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17867 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17868 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17869 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17870 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17871 of remote hosts.
17872 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17873 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17874 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17875 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17876 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17877
17878 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17879 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17880 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17881 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17882 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17883 cases:
17884
17885 .vlist
17886 .vitem &%defer%&
17887 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17888
17889 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17890 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17891 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17892 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17893
17894 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17895 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17896 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17897 rewritten.
17898
17899 .vitem &%pass%&
17900 .oindex "&%more%&"
17901 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17902 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17903 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17904 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17905 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17906 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17907 combination
17908 .code
17909 self = pass
17910 no_more
17911 .endd
17912 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17913 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17914 be passed to the next router.
17915
17916 .vitem &%fail%&
17917 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17918
17919 .vitem &%send%&
17920 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17921 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17922 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17923 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17924 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17925 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17926 .endlist
17927
17928
17929
17930 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17931 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17932 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17933 address matches something on the list.
17934 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17935 are evaluated.
17936
17937 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17938 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17939 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17940 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17941 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17942 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17943 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17944 matters.
17945
17946
17947 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17948 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17949 .cindex "packet radio"
17950 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17951 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17952 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17953 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17954 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17955 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17956 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17957 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17958
17959 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17960 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17961 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17962 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17963 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17964 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17965 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17966 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17967 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17968 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17969 .code
17970 translate_ip_address = \
17971 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17972 {$value}fail}}
17973 .endd
17974 The file would contain lines like
17975 .code
17976 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17977 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17978 .endd
17979 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17980 are doing.
17981
17982
17983
17984 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17985 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17986 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17987 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17988 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17989 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17990 delivery is deferred.
17991
17992 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17993 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17994 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17995
17996
17997
17998 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17999 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18000 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18001 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18002 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18003 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18004 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18005 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18006 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18007 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18008 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18009 environment.
18010
18011
18012
18013
18014 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18015 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18016 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18017 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18018 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18019 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18020 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18021 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18022 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18023 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18024
18025 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18026 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18027 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18028 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18029 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18030
18031 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18032 environment.
18033
18034
18035
18036
18037 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18038 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18039 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18040 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18041 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18042 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18043 delivery to be deferred.
18044
18045 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18046 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18047 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18048 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18049 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18050 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18051
18052 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18053 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18054 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18055 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18056 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18057 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18058 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18059 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18060
18061 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18062 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18063 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18064 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18065 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18066 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18067 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18068 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18069 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18070 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18071
18072 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18073 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18074 subsequent routers.
18075
18076
18077 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18078 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18079 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18080 .cindex "transport" "local"
18081 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18082 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18083 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18084 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18085 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18086 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18087 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18088 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18089 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18090 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18091 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18092 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18093
18094
18095
18096 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18097 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18098 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18099
18100
18101 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18102 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18103 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18104 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18105 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18106 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18107 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18108 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18109 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18110 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18111
18112 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18113 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18114 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18115 user or group.
18116
18117
18118 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18119 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18120 addresses,
18121 delivering in cutthrough mode
18122 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18123 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18124 are evaluated.
18125 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18126
18127
18128 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18129 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18130 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18131 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18132 are evaluated.
18133 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18134 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18135 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18136
18137
18138
18139
18140
18141
18142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18144
18145 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18146 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18147 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18148 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18149 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18150 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18151 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18152 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18153 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18154 .code
18155 localusers:
18156 driver = accept
18157 domains = mydomain.example
18158 check_local_user
18159 transport = local_delivery
18160 .endd
18161 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18162 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18163 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18164 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18165
18166
18167
18168
18169
18170
18171 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18173
18174 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18175 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18176 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18177 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18178 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18179 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18180
18181 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18182 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18183 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18184 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18185 records.
18186
18187 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18188 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18189 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18190 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18191 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18192 generic option, the router declines.
18193
18194 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18195 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18196 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18197
18198 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18199 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18200 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18201 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18202 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18203 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18204
18205
18206 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18207 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18208 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18209 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18210 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18211 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18212
18213 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18214 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18215 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18216 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18217 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18218 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18219 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18220 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18221 case routing fails.
18222
18223
18224 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18225 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18226 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18227 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18228 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18229
18230 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18231 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18232
18233 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18234 .ilist
18235 The domain does not exist in DNS
18236 .next
18237 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18238 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18239 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18240 .next
18241 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18242 .next
18243 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18244 .next
18245 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18246 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18247 .next
18248 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18249 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18250 .next
18251 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18252 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18253 .next
18254 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18255 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18256 .endlist
18257
18258
18259
18260
18261 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18262 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18263 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18264
18265 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18266 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18267 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18268 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18269 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18270 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18271 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18272
18273
18274 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18275 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18276 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18277 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18278 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18279 required. For example,
18280 .code
18281 check_srv = smtp
18282 .endd
18283 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18284 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18285 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18286 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18287 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18288 normal way.
18289
18290 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18291 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18292 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18293 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18294 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18295 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18296
18297 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18298 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18299 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18300 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18301 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18302 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18303 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18304 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18305
18306 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18307 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18308
18309
18310
18311
18312 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18313 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18314 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18315 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18316 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18317 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18318 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18319 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18320 also being queued.
18321
18322
18323 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18324 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18325 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18326 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18327 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18328 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18329 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18330 setting:
18331 .code
18332 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18333 .endd
18334 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18335 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18336 the address record.
18337
18338
18339 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18340 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18341 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18342 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18343
18344
18345
18346
18347 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18348 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18349 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18350 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18351 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18352 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18353 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18354 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18355 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18356 &'resolv.conf'&.
18357
18358
18359
18360 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18361 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18362 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18363 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18364 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18365 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18366 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18367 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18368 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18369 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18370 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18371
18372 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18373 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18374 sense.
18375
18376 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18377 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18378 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18379 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18380 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18381 header rewriting.
18382
18383
18384 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18385 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18386 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18387 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18388 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18389 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18390 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18391 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18392
18393 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18394 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18395 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18396 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18397 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18398 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18399 without processing them independently,
18400 provided the following conditions are met:
18401
18402 .ilist
18403 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18404 &%headers_remove%&.
18405 .next
18406 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18407 the domain.
18408 .endlist
18409
18410
18411
18412
18413 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18414 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18415 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18416 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18417 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18418 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18419 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18420 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18421 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18422 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18423
18424 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18425 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18426 local wildcard.
18427
18428
18429
18430 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18431 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18432 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18433 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18434
18435
18436
18437
18438 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18439 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18440 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18441 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18442 if
18443 .code
18444 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18445 .endd
18446 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18447 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18448 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18449 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18450 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18451 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18452
18453
18454 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18455 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18456 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18457 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18458 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18459
18460 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18461 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18462 such as that implied by
18463 .code
18464 domains = @mx_any
18465 .endd
18466 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18467 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18468 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18469 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18470
18471
18472
18473
18474
18475
18476
18477
18478
18479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18481
18482 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18483 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18484 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18485 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18486 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18487 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18488 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18489 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18490 router handles the address
18491 .code
18492 root@[192.168.1.1]
18493 .endd
18494 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18495 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18496 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18497 .code
18498 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18499 .endd
18500 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18501 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18502
18503 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18504 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18505 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18506 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18507
18508 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18509 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18510 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18511 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18512
18513
18514
18515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18517
18518 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18519 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18520 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18521 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18522 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18523 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18524 must set
18525 .code
18526 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18527 .endd
18528 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18529
18530 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18531 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18532 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18533 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18534 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18535 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18536 must not be specified for it.
18537
18538 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18539 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18540 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18541 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18542 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18543 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18544 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18545
18546
18547 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18548 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18549 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18550 delivery to the address is deferred.
18551
18552
18553 .option port iplookup integer 0
18554 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18555 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18556 call.
18557
18558
18559 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18560 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18561 protocols is to be used.
18562
18563
18564 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18565 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18566 default value is:
18567 .code
18568 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18569 .endd
18570 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18571 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18572
18573
18574 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18575 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18576 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18577 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18578 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18579 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18580 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18581 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18582
18583
18584 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18585 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18586 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18587 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18588 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18589 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18590 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18591 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18592 following could be used:
18593 .code
18594 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18595 reroute = $local_part@$1
18596 .endd
18597
18598 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18599 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18600 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18601 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18602
18603
18604
18605
18606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18608
18609 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18610 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18611 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18612 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18613 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18614 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18615 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18616 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18617 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18618 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18619
18620 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18621 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18622 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18623 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18624 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18625 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18626 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18627
18628 .vindex "&$host$&"
18629 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18630 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18631 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18632 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18633 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18634 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18635 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18636 text string.
18637
18638 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18639 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18640 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18641 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18642 below, following the list of private options.
18643
18644
18645 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18646
18647 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18648 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18649
18650 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18651 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18652
18653 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18654 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18655 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18656 of the following values:
18657 .code
18658 decline
18659 defer
18660 fail
18661 freeze
18662 ignore
18663 pass
18664 .endd
18665 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18666 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18667 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18668 &%pass_router%&),
18669 .oindex "&%more%&"
18670 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18671 router only if &%more%& is true.
18672
18673 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18674 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18675 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18676 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18677
18678 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18679 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18680 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18681
18682
18683 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18684 .cindex "randomized host list"
18685 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18686 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18687 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18688 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18689 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18690 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18691 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18692 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18693
18694 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18695 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18696 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18697 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18698 .code
18699 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18700 .endd
18701 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18702 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18703 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18704 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18705 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18706
18707
18708 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18709 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18710 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18711 example:
18712 .code
18713 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18714 .endd
18715 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18716 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18717 deferred.
18718
18719
18720 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18721 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18722 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18723 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18724
18725
18726 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18727 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18728 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18729 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18730 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18731 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18732 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18733 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18734
18735 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18736 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18737 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18738 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18739 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18740 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18741 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18742 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18743
18744
18745
18746
18747 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18748 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18749 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18750 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18751 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18752 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18753 .display
18754 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18755 .endd
18756 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18757 no options:
18758 .code
18759 route_list = \
18760 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18761 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18762 .endd
18763 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18764 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18765 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18766 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18767 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18768 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18769 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18770 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18771 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18772 in a &%route_list%&).
18773
18774 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18775 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18776 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18777 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18778
18779
18780
18781 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18782 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18783 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18784 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18785 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18786 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18787 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18788 like this:
18789 .code
18790 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18791 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18792 .endd
18793 This data can be accessed by setting
18794 .code
18795 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18796 .endd
18797 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18798 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18799 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18800 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18801 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18802
18803
18804
18805
18806 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18807 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18808 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18809 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18810 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18811 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18812 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18813
18814 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18815 variables are set during its expansion:
18816
18817 .ilist
18818 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18819 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18820 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18821 .code
18822 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18823 .endd
18824 .next
18825 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18826 .next
18827 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18828
18829 .next
18830 .vindex "&$value$&"
18831 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18832 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18833 .code
18834 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18835 .endd
18836 .endlist
18837
18838 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18839 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18840
18841
18842
18843 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18844 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18845 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18846 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18847 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18848 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18849
18850 .ilist
18851 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18852 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18853 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18854 .code
18855 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18856 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18857 .endd
18858 .next
18859 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18860 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18861 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18862 number follows. For example:
18863 .code
18864 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18865 .endd
18866 .endlist
18867
18868 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18869 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18870 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18871 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18872 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18873 transport.
18874
18875 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18876 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18877 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18878 records in the DNS. For example:
18879 .code
18880 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18881 .endd
18882 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18883 example:
18884 .code
18885 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18886 .endd
18887 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18888 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18889 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18890 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18891 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18892 happens is controlled by the
18893 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18894 &%self%& option of the router.
18895
18896 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18897 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18898 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18899 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18900 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18901 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18902 defined by MX preferences.
18903
18904 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18905 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18906 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18907
18908 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18909 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18910 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18911 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18912
18913 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18914 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18915 router.
18916
18917 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18918 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18919 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18920
18921 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18922 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18923
18924
18925
18926 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18927 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18928 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18929 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18930 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18931 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18932 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18933
18934 .ilist
18935 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18936 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18937 .next
18938 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18939 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18940 .next
18941 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18942 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18943 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18944 .next
18945 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18946 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18947 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18948 .endlist
18949
18950 For example:
18951 .code
18952 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18953 domain2 host4:host5
18954 .endd
18955 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18956 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18957 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18958 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18959 call.
18960
18961 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18962 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18963 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18964 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18965 function called.
18966
18967
18968
18969 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18970 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18971
18972 .vindex "&$host$&"
18973 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18974 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18975
18976
18977
18978 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18979 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18980 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18981
18982 .ilist
18983 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18984 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18985 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18986 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18987 .code
18988 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18989 .endd
18990 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18991 your first router something like this:
18992 .code
18993 smart_route:
18994 driver = manualroute
18995 domains = !+local_domains
18996 transport = remote_smtp
18997 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18998 .endd
18999 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19000 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19001 they are tried in order
19002 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19003 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19004 .code
19005 smart_route:
19006 driver = manualroute
19007 transport = remote_smtp
19008 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19009 .endd
19010 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19011 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19012 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19013 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19014 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19015 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19016 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19017 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19018
19019 .next
19020 .cindex "mail hub example"
19021 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19022 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19023 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19024 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19025 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19026 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19027 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19028 lookup is easier to manage.
19029
19030 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19031 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19032 example:
19033 .code
19034 hub_route:
19035 driver = manualroute
19036 transport = remote_smtp
19037 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19038 .endd
19039 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19040 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19041 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19042 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19043 domain can be used to find the host:
19044 .code
19045 through_firewall:
19046 driver = manualroute
19047 transport = remote_smtp
19048 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19049 .endd
19050 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19051 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19052 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19053 next router.
19054
19055 .next
19056 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19057 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19058 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19059 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19060 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19061 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19062 .code
19063 save_in_file:
19064 driver = manualroute
19065 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19066 route_list = saved.domain.example
19067 .endd
19068 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19069 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19070 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19071 .code
19072 save_in_file:
19073 driver = manualroute
19074 route_list = \
19075 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19076 *.saved.domain2.example \
19077 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19078 batch_pipe
19079 .endd
19080 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19081 .vindex "&$host$&"
19082 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19083 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19084 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19085 the address if the lookup fails.
19086
19087 .next
19088 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19089 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19090 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19091 one way it can be done:
19092 .code
19093 # Transport
19094 uucp:
19095 driver = pipe
19096 user = nobody
19097 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19098 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19099 return_fail_output = true
19100
19101 # Router
19102 uucphost:
19103 transport = uucp
19104 driver = manualroute
19105 route_data = \
19106 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19107 .endd
19108 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19109 .code
19110 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19111 .endd
19112 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19113 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19114 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19115 .endlist
19116 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19117 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19118
19119
19120
19121
19122
19123
19124
19125
19126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19128
19129 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19130 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19131 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19132 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19133 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19134 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19135 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19136 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19137 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19138 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19139 options:
19140 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19141
19142 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19143 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19144 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19145 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19146 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19147
19148
19149 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19150 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19151 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19152 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19153 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19154 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19155
19156
19157 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19158 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19159 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19160 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19161 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19162 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19163 not set, a value for the gid also.
19164
19165 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19166 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19167 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19168 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19169 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19170 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19171 gid.
19172
19173
19174 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19175 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19176 before running the command.
19177
19178
19179 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19180 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19181 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19182 timeout.
19183
19184
19185 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19186 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19187 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19188 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19189 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19190
19191 .ilist
19192 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19193 below).
19194 .next
19195 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19196 &%no_more%& is set.
19197 .next
19198 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19199 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19200 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19201 included in the SMTP response.
19202 .next
19203 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19204 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19205 included in any SMTP response.
19206 .next
19207 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19208 .next
19209 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19210 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19211 .next
19212 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19213 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19214 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19215 .endlist
19216
19217 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19218 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19219 the page):
19220 .code
19221 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19222 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19223 .endd
19224 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19225 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19226 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19227 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19228
19229 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19230 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19231 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19232 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19233 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19234
19235 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19236 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19237 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19238 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19239 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19240
19241 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19242 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19243 variable. For example, this return line
19244 .code
19245 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19246 .endd
19247 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19248 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19249 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19250 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19251
19252
19253
19254
19255 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19257
19258 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19259 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19260 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19261 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19262 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19263 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19264 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19265 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19266 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19267 redirected in several different ways:
19268
19269 .ilist
19270 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19271 independently.
19272 .next
19273 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19274 .next
19275 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19276 .next
19277 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19278 .next
19279 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19280 .next
19281 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19282 .next
19283 It can be discarded.
19284 .endlist
19285
19286 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19287 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19288 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19289 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19290
19291 If success DSNs have been requested
19292 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19293 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19294 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19295
19296
19297
19298 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19299 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19300 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19301 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19302 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19303 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19304 .code
19305 system_aliases:
19306 driver = redirect
19307 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19308 .endd
19309 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19310 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19311 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19312 cause delivery to be deferred.
19313
19314 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19315 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19316 .code
19317 userforward:
19318 driver = redirect
19319 check_local_user
19320 file = $home/.forward
19321 no_verify
19322 .endd
19323 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19324 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19325 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19326 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19327 comments.
19328
19329
19330
19331 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19332 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19333 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19334 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19335
19336 .ilist
19337 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19338 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19339 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19340 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19341 .next
19342 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19343 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19344 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19345 saves some resources.
19346 .endlist
19347
19348
19349
19350
19351
19352
19353 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19354 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19355 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19356 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19357 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19358
19359 .ilist
19360 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19361 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19362 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19363 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19364 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19365 document is intended for use by end users.
19366 .next
19367 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19368 described in the next section.
19369 .endlist
19370
19371 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19372 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19373 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19374 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19375 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19376
19377
19378
19379 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19380 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19381 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19382 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19383 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19384 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19385 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19386 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19387 commas or newlines.
19388 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19389 quotes.
19390
19391 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19392 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19393 next newline character is ignored.
19394
19395 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19396 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19397 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19398 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19399 removed.
19400
19401 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19402 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19403 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19404 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19405 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19406 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19407 setting:
19408 .code
19409 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19410 .endd
19411
19412
19413 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19414 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19415 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19416 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19417 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19418 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19419 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19420 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19421 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19422 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19423 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19424
19425 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19426 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19427 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19428 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19429 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19430 .code
19431 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19432 .endd
19433 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19434 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19435 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19436 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19437 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19438 synonymously.
19439
19440 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19441 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19442 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19443 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19444 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19445
19446 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19447 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19448 contains:
19449 .code
19450 Sam.Reman: spqr
19451 .endd
19452 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19453 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19454 this forward file:
19455 .code
19456 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19457 .endd
19458 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19459 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19460 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19461 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19462 should really contain
19463 .code
19464 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19465 .endd
19466 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19467 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19468 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19469
19470
19471
19472 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19473 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19474 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19475
19476 .ilist
19477 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19478 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19479 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19480 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19481 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19482 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19483 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19484
19485 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19486 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19487 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19488 in double quotes, for example:
19489 .code
19490 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19491 .endd
19492 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19493 quote just the command. An item such as
19494 .code
19495 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19496 .endd
19497 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19498
19499 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19500 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19501 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19502 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19503 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19504 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19505 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19506 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19507 an &%accept%& router.
19508
19509 .next
19510 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19511 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19512 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19513 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19514 .code
19515 /home/world/minbari
19516 .endd
19517 is treated as a file name, but
19518 .code
19519 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19520 .endd
19521 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19522 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19523 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19524 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19525
19526 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19527 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19528
19529 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19530 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19531 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19532 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19533
19534 .next
19535 .cindex "included address list"
19536 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19537 If an item is of the form
19538 .code
19539 :include:<path name>
19540 .endd
19541 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19542 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19543 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19544 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19545 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19546 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19547 .code
19548 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19549 .endd
19550 It must be given as
19551 .code
19552 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19553 .endd
19554 .next
19555 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19556 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19557 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19558 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19559 .cindex "black hole"
19560 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19561 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19562 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19563 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19564
19565 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19566 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19567 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19568 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19569 &_/dev/null_&.
19570
19571 .next
19572 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19573 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19574 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19575 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19576 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19577 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19578 redirection items of the form
19579 .code
19580 :defer:
19581 :fail:
19582 .endd
19583 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19584 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19585 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19586 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19587 .code
19588 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19589 .endd
19590 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19591 of a
19592 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19593 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19594 default.
19595 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19596 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19597 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19598
19599 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19600 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19601 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19602 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19603 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19604 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19605 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19606 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19607 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19608 ignored.
19609
19610 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19611 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19612 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19613 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19614
19615 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19616 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19617 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19618 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19619 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19620
19621 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19622 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19623 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19624 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19625 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19626 rules still apply.
19627
19628 .next
19629 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19630 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19631 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19632 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19633 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19634 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19635 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19636 .endlist
19637
19638
19639 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19640 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19641 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19642 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19643 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19644 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19645 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19646 aliasing scheme of the type
19647 .code
19648 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19649 localpart1: pipe
19650 localpart2: pipe
19651 .endd
19652 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19653 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19654 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19655 such as
19656 .code
19657 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19658 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19659 .endd
19660 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19661 the pipes are distinct.
19662
19663
19664
19665 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19666 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19667 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19668 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19669 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19670 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19671 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19672 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19673 can be used to avoid this.
19674
19675
19676 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19677 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19678 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19679 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19680 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19681 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19682 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19683
19684
19685
19686 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19687
19688 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19689 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19690
19691
19692 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19693 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19694 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19695
19696
19697 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19698 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19699 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19700 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19701
19702
19703 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19704 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19705 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19706 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19707 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19708 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19709 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19710
19711 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19712 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19713
19714
19715 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19716 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19717 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19718 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19719 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19720
19721
19722
19723 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19724 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19725 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19726 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19727 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19728 let ordinary users do.
19729
19730
19731
19732 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19733 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19734 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19735 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19736 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19737 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19738
19739 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19740 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19741 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19742 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19743 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19744 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19745 .code
19746 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19747 .endd
19748 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19749 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19750 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19751 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19752 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19753 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19754 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19755 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19756
19757
19758 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19759 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19760 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19761 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19762 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19763 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19764 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19765 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19766
19767
19768
19769 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19770 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19771 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19772 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19773 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19774 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19775
19776
19777 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19778 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19779 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19780 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19781 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19782 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19783
19784 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19785 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19786 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19787 .code
19788 data = #Exim filter\n\
19789 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19790 .endd
19791 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19792 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19793 choice into a newline.
19794
19795
19796 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19797 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19798 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19799 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19800 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19801
19802
19803 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19804 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19805 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19806 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19807 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19808 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19809 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19810 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19811
19812 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19813 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19814 runs a check on the containing directory,
19815 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19816 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19817 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19818 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19819 not, the router declines.
19820
19821
19822 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19823 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19824 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19825 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19826 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19827 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19828 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19829
19830
19831 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19832 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19833 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19834 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19835 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19836
19837
19838 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19839 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19840 redirection list.
19841
19842
19843 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19844 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19845 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19846
19847
19848
19849
19850 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19851 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19852 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19853 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19854 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19855 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19856 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19857 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19858 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19859
19860
19861 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19862 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19863 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19864 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19865 functions.
19866
19867 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19868 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19869 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19870 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19871
19872 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19873 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19874 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19875 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19876 &_.forward_& files).
19877
19878
19879 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19880 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19881 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19882
19883
19884 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19885 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19886 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19887 of the embedded Perl support.
19888
19889
19890 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19891 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19892 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19893
19894
19895 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19896 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19897 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19898
19899
19900 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19901 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19902 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19903 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19904 &%one_time%& is set.
19905
19906
19907 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19908 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19909 to make use of &%run%& items.
19910
19911
19912 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19913 If this option is true, items of the form
19914 .code
19915 :include:<path name>
19916 .endd
19917 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19918
19919
19920 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19921 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19922 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19923 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19924 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19925
19926
19927 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19928 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19929 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19930
19931
19932 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19933 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19934 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19935 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19936 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19937
19938
19939
19940
19941 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19942 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19943 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19944 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19945 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19946 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19947 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19948
19949
19950 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19951 .cindex "EACCES"
19952 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19953 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19954 file did not exist.
19955
19956
19957 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19958 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19959 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19960 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19961 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19962
19963 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19964 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19965 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19966 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19967 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19968 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19969 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19970 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19971
19972
19973
19974 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19975 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19976 redirection list must start with this directory.
19977
19978
19979 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19980 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19981 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19982
19983
19984 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19985 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19986 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19987 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19988 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19989 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19990 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19991 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19992 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19993 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19994 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19995 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19996 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19997 before they subscribed.
19998
19999 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20000 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20001 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20002 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20003 attempt.
20004
20005 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20006 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20007 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20008 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20009
20010 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20011 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20012 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20013
20014 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20015 &%one_time%&.
20016
20017 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20018 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20019 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20020 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20021 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20022 expansion.
20023
20024
20025 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20026 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20027 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20028 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20029 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20030 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20031 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20032 See &%check_owner%& above.
20033
20034
20035 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20036 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20037 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20038 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20039
20040
20041 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20042 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20043 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20044 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20045 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20046 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20047 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20048
20049
20050 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20051 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20052 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20053 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20054 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20055 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20056 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20057 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20058
20059 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20060 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20061 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20062 addresses.
20063
20064 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20065 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20066 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20067 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20068 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20069 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20070 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20071 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20072 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20073 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20074
20075
20076 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20077 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20078 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20079 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20080 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20081 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20082
20083
20084 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20085 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20086 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20087 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20088 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20089 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20090
20091
20092 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20093 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20094 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20095 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20096 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20097
20098
20099 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20100 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20101 :subaddress part of an address.
20102
20103 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20104 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20105 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20106 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20107
20108
20109 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20110 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20111 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20112 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20113 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20114 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20115 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20116
20117
20118
20119 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20120 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20121 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20122 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20123 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20124 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20125 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20126 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20127 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20128 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20129 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20130 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20131 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20132 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20133 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20134 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20135
20136 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20137 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20138 the following routers.
20139
20140 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20141 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20142 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20143 so it is passed to the following routers.
20144
20145 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20146 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20147 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20148 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20149
20150 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20151 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20152 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20153 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20154 .code
20155 userforward:
20156 driver = redirect
20157 allow_filter
20158 check_local_user
20159 file = $home/.forward
20160 file_transport = address_file
20161 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20162 reply_transport = address_reply
20163 no_verify
20164 skip_syntax_errors
20165 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20166 syntax_errors_text = \
20167 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20168 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20169 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20170 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20171 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20172 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20173 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20174 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20175 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20176 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20177 .endd
20178 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20179 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20180 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20181 .code
20182 real_localuser:
20183 driver = accept
20184 check_local_user
20185 local_part_prefix = real-
20186 transport = local_delivery
20187 .endd
20188 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20189 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20190 .code
20191 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20192 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20193 .endd
20194
20195
20196 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20197 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20198
20199
20200 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20201 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20202 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20203 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20204
20205
20206
20207
20208
20209
20210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20212
20213 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20214 "Environment for local transports"
20215 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20216 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20217 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20218 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20219 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20220 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20221 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20222
20223 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20224 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20225 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20226 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20227
20228 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20229 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20230 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20231 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20232 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20233
20234
20235
20236 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20237 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20238 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20239 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20240 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20241 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20242 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20243 time.
20244
20245 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20246 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20247 .code
20248 my_transport:
20249 driver = pipe
20250 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20251 .endd
20252 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20253 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20254 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20255 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20256
20257
20258
20259
20260 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20261 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20262 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20263 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20264 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20265 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20266 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20267 group (set by the transport). For example:
20268 .code
20269 # Routers ...
20270 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20271 local_users:
20272 driver = accept
20273 check_local_user
20274 transport = group_delivery
20275
20276 # Transports ...
20277 # This transport overrides the group
20278 group_delivery:
20279 driver = appendfile
20280 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20281 group = mail
20282 .endd
20283 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20284 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20285 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20286 set.
20287
20288 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20289 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20290 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20291 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20292 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20293 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20294
20295 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20296 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20297 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20298 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20299 original gid is also used.
20300
20301 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20302 following that is set is used:
20303
20304 .ilist
20305 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20306 .next
20307 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20308 .next
20309 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20310 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20311 .next
20312 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20313 .next
20314 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20315 the uid is the creator's uid;
20316 .next
20317 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20318 .endlist
20319
20320 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20321 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20322 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20323 The first of the following that is set is used:
20324
20325 .ilist
20326 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20327 .next
20328 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20329 .next
20330 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20331 .next
20332 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20333 .next
20334 The Exim uid.
20335 .endlist
20336
20337 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20338 &%never_users%& list.
20339
20340
20341
20342
20343
20344 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20345 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20346 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20347 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20348 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20349 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20350 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20351 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20352 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20353 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20354
20355 .ilist
20356 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20357 .next
20358 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20359 .next
20360 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20361 .next
20362 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20363 .endlist
20364
20365 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20366
20367 .ilist
20368 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20369 .next
20370 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20371 .endlist
20372
20373
20374 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20375 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20376 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20377
20378
20379
20380 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20381 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20382 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20383 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20384 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20385 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20386 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20387 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20388 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20389 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20390 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20391 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20392 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20393 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20394
20395
20396
20397
20398
20399
20400
20401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20403
20404 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20405 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20406 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20407 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20408 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20409
20410
20411 .option body_only transports boolean false
20412 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20413 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20414 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20415 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20416 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20417 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20418 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20419 automatically suppress them.
20420
20421
20422 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20423 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20424 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20425 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20426 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20427 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20428
20429
20430 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20431 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20432 deliveries by the transport or for any
20433 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20434 what you are doing.
20435
20436
20437 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20438 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20439 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20440 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20441 transport is run.
20442 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20443 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20444 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20445 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20446 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20447 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20448 one.
20449 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20450 transport and the router that called it.
20451
20452 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20453 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20454 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20455 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20456 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20457 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20458 safely be resent to other recipients.
20459
20460
20461 .option driver transports string unset
20462 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20463 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20464
20465
20466 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20467 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20468 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20469 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20470 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20471 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20472 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20473 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20474 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20475 resent to other recipients.
20476
20477
20478 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20479 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20480 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20481 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20482 &%user%& (see below).
20483
20484
20485 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20486 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20487 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20488 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20489 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20490 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20491 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20492 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20493 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20494 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20495 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20496
20497 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20498 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20499
20500
20501 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20502 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20503 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20504 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20505 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20506 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20507 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20508 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20509
20510
20511 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20512 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20513 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20514 This option specifies a list of header names,
20515 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20516 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20517 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20518 routers.
20519 Each list item is separately expanded.
20520 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20521 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20522 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20523
20524 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20525 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20526
20527 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20528 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20529 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20530
20531
20532
20533 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20534 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20535 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20536 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20537 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20538 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20539 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20540 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20541 example,
20542 .code
20543 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20544 x@y w@z
20545 .endd
20546 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20547 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20548 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20549 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20550 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20551 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20552 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20553 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20554 change envelope recipients at this time.
20555
20556
20557 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20558 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20559 .vindex "&$home$&"
20560 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20561 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20562 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20563 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20564 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20565 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20566 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20567 deferred.
20568
20569
20570 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20571 .cindex "additional groups"
20572 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20573 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20574 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20575 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20576 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20577
20578
20579 .new
20580 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20581 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20582 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20583 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20584 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20585 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20586 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20587 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20588
20589 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20590 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20591 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20592 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20593 Obviously there is scope for
20594 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20595 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20596
20597 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20598 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20599 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20600 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20601 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20602 .wen
20603
20604
20605 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20606 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20607 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20608 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20609 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20610 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20611 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20612 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20613 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20614 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20615 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20616 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20617 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20618 delivered.
20619
20620
20621
20622 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20623 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20624 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20625 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20626 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20627 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20628 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20629 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20630 that contains
20631 .code
20632 local_part_prefix = *-
20633 .endd
20634 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20635 is delivered with
20636 .code
20637 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20638 .endd
20639 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20640 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20641 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20642 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20643 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20644
20645
20646 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20647 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20648 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20649 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20650 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20651 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20652 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20653 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20654 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20655
20656 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20657 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20658 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20659 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20660
20661 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20662 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20663 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20664
20665
20666 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20667 .cindex "envelope sender"
20668 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20669 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20670 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20671 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20672 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20673 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20674 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20675 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20676 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20677
20678 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20679 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20680
20681 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20682 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20683 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20684 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20685 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20686 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20687 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20688
20689 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20690 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20691 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20692 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20693 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20694
20695
20696
20697 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20698 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20699 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20700 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20701 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20702 have easy access to it.
20703
20704 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20705 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20706 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20707 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20708 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20709 recipients.
20710
20711
20712 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20713 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20714
20715
20716 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20717 .cindex "shadow transport"
20718 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20719 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20720 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20721
20722 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20723 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20724 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20725 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20726 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20727 cause a log line to be written.
20728
20729 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20730 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20731 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20732 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20733 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20734 of the form
20735 .code
20736 ST=<shadow transport name>
20737 .endd
20738 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20739 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20740 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20741 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20742 headers that some sites insist on.
20743
20744
20745 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20746 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20747 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20748 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20749 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20750 individual users or via a system filter.
20751 .new
20752 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20753 .wen
20754
20755 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20756 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20757 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20758 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20759 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20760
20761 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20762 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20763 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20764 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20765 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20766 &(pipe)& transports.
20767
20768 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20769 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20770 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20771 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20772 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20773
20774 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20775 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20776 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20777 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20778
20779 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20780 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20781 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20782 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20783 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20784 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20785
20786 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20787 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20788 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20789 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20790 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20791 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20792 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20793 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20794
20795 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20796 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20797 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20798 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20799 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20800 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20801 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20802 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20803 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20804 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20805
20806 .vindex "&$host$&"
20807 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20808 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20809 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20810 which the message is being sent. For example:
20811 .code
20812 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20813 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20814 .endd
20815
20816 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20817 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20818 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20819 .ilist
20820 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20821 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20822 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20823 example:
20824 .code
20825 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20826 .endd
20827 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20828 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20829 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20830 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20831 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20832 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20833 .next
20834 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20835 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20836 arguments. Consider this example:
20837 .code
20838 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20839 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20840 .endd
20841 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20842 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20843 .code
20844 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20845 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20846 .endd
20847 .endlist
20848
20849 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20850 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20851 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20852 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20853 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20854 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20855 bounced from a transport filter.
20856
20857 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20858 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20859 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20860
20861
20862 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20863 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20864 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20865 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20866 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20867 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20868 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20869 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20870 becomes a temporary error.
20871
20872
20873 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20874 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20875 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20876 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20877 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20878 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20879 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20880 option is not set.
20881
20882 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20883 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20884 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20885
20886 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20887 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20888 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20889 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20890 retry data.
20891 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20892 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20893 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20894
20895
20896
20897
20898
20899
20900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20901 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20902
20903 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20904 "Address batching"
20905 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20906 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20907 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20908 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20909 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20910 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20911 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20912
20913 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20914 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20915 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20916 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20917 local transport, for example:
20918
20919 .ilist
20920 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20921 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20922 recipients saves space.
20923 .next
20924 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20925 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20926 .next
20927 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20928 to a scanner program or
20929 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20930 acceptable.
20931 .endlist
20932
20933 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20934 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20935 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20936
20937 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20938 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20939 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20940 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20941 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20942 to certain conditions:
20943
20944 .ilist
20945 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20946 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20947 batching is possible.
20948 .next
20949 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20950 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20951 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20952 .next
20953 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20954 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20955 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20956 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20957 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20958 from taking place.
20959 .next
20960 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20961 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20962 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20963 be the same.
20964 .endlist
20965
20966 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20967 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20968 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20969 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20970 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20971 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20972 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20973 .code
20974 check_string = "."
20975 escape_string = ".."
20976 .endd
20977 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20978 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20979 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20980
20981 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20982 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20983 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20984 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20985 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20986 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20987
20988 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20989 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20990 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20991 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20992 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20993 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20994 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20995 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20996 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20997
20998
20999
21000
21001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21003
21004 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21005 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21006 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21007 .cindex "directory creation"
21008 .cindex "creating directories"
21009 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21010 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21011 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21012 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21013 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21014 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21015 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21016 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21017 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21018 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21019
21020 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21021 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21022 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21023 included.
21024
21025 .cindex "quota" "system"
21026 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21027 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21028 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21029
21030 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21031 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21032 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21033 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21034
21035 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21036 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21037 private options.
21038
21039 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21040 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21041 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21042 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21043 option).
21044
21045
21046
21047 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21048 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21049 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21050 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21051 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21052
21053 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21054 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21055 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21056 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21057 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21058 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21059 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21060 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21061 operation. There are two cases:
21062
21063 .ilist
21064 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21065 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21066 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21067 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21068 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21069 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21070 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21071 .next
21072 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21073 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21074 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21075 .endlist
21076
21077
21078 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21079 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21080 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21081 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21082 form:
21083 .code
21084 save folder23
21085 .endd
21086 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21087 .code
21088 require "fileinto";
21089 fileinto "folder23";
21090 .endd
21091 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21092 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21093 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21094 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21095 way of handling this requirement:
21096 .code
21097 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21098 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21099 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21100 {$address_file} \
21101 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21102 }} \
21103 }
21104 .endd
21105 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21106 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21107 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21108
21109 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21110 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21111 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21112 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21113 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21114 path to the transport.
21115
21116 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21117 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21118
21119
21120
21121
21122 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21123 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21124
21125
21126
21127 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21128 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21129 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21130 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21131 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21132 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21133 delivery is deferred.
21134
21135
21136 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21137 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21138 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21139 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21140 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21141 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21142 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21143 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21144
21145
21146 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21147 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21148 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21149 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21150 file.
21151
21152
21153 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21154 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21155
21156
21157 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21158 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21159 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21160 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21161 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21162
21163
21164 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21165 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21166 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21167 process is running.
21168
21169
21170 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21171 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21172 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21173 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21174 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21175 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21176 contains is significant.
21177
21178 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21179 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21180 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21181 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21182 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21183
21184 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21185 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21186 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21187 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21188 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21189 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21190 .code
21191 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21192 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21193 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21194 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21195 .endd
21196 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21197 .cindex "directory creation"
21198 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21199 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21200 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21201
21202 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21203 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21204 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21205 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21206 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21207
21208
21209
21210 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21211 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21212 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21213 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21214 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21215 beneath.
21216
21217 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21218 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21219 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21220 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21221 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21222 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21223 &%file_must_exist%&.
21224
21225
21226 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21227 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21228 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21229 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21230
21231 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21232 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21233 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21234 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21235 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21236
21237
21238 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21239 .cindex "base62"
21240 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21241 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21242 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21243 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21244 .code
21245 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21246 .endd
21247 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21248 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21249 option.
21250
21251
21252 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21253 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21254 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21255
21256
21257 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21258 See &%check_string%& above.
21259
21260
21261 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21262 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21263 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21264 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21265 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21266 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21267 &%file%&.
21268
21269 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21270 .cindex "locking files"
21271 .cindex "lock files"
21272 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21273 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21274
21275 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21276 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21277 examples:
21278 .code
21279 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21280 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21281 file = $home/inbox
21282 .endd
21283 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21284 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21285 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21286 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21287 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21288 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21289
21290
21291
21292 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21293 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21294 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21295 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21296 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21297 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21298 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21299 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21300 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21301 this added to it:
21302 .code
21303 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21304 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21305 .endd
21306 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21307 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21308 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21309 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21310 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21311 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21312 delivery is deferred.
21313
21314
21315 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21316 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21317 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21318 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21319
21320
21321 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21322 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21323 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21324 .cindex "locking files"
21325 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21326 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21327 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21328 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21329 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21330 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21331 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21332 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21333
21334 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21335 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21336 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21337 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21338
21339 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21340 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21341 retries is
21342 .code
21343 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21344 .endd
21345 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21346 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21347 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21348
21349 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21350 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21351 .code
21352 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21353 .endd
21354
21355 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21356 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21357 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21358 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21359
21360
21361 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21362 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21363 for details of locking.
21364
21365
21366 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21367 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21368 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21369
21370
21371 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21372 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21373 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21374
21375
21376 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21377 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21378 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21379 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21380 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21381
21382
21383 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21384 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21385 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21386 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21387 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21388 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21389 external source that maintains the data.
21390
21391
21392 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21393 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21394 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21395 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21396 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21397 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21398 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21399 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21400
21401
21402
21403 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21404 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21405 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21406 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21407 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21408 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21409 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21410 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21411 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21412 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21413
21414
21415 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21416 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21417 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21418 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21419 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21420 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21421 calculation. The default value is:
21422 .code
21423 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21424 .endd
21425 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21426 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21427 &_Trash_&
21428 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21429 .code
21430 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21431 .endd
21432 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21433 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21434 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21435 directly into that directory.
21436
21437
21438 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21439 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21440 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21441
21442
21443 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21444 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21445 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21446
21447
21448 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21449 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21450 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21451 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21452 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21453 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21454 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21455 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21456
21457 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21458 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21459 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21460 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21461 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21462 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21463 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21464 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21465 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21466 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21467
21468
21469 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21470 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21471 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21472 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21473 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21474 below for further details.
21475
21476
21477 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21478 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21479 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21480
21481
21482 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21483 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21484 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21485
21486
21487 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21488 .cindex "locking files"
21489 .cindex "file" "locking"
21490 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21491 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21492 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21493 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21494 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21495 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21496 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21497
21498 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21499 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21500 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21501 combination:
21502 .code
21503 mbx_format = true
21504 message_prefix =
21505 message_suffix =
21506 .endd
21507 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21508 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21509 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21510 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21511 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21512 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21513 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21514 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21515
21516 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21517 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21518 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21519 append messages to it.
21520
21521
21522 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21523 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21524 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21525 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21526 in which case it is:
21527 .code
21528 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21529 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21530 .endd
21531 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21532 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21533
21534 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21535 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21536 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21537 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21538 setting
21539 .code
21540 message_suffix =
21541 .endd
21542 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21543 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21544
21545 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21546 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21547 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21548 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21549 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21550 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21551 value, and this option is ignored.
21552
21553
21554 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21555 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21556 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21557 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21558 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21559
21560
21561 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21562 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21563 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21564 on users about incoming mail.
21565
21566
21567 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21568 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21569 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21570 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21571 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21572 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21573 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21574 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21575 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21576
21577 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21578 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21579 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21580
21581 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21582 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21583 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21584 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21585 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21586 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21587
21588 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21589 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21590 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21591 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21592 be handled.
21593
21594 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21595
21596 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21597 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21598 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21599 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21600 system quota failures.
21601
21602 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21603 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21604 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21605 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21606 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21607 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21608 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21609 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21610 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21611 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21612
21613
21614 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21615 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21616 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21617 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21618 delivery directory.
21619
21620
21621 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21622 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21623 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21624 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21625 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21626 &"no quota"&.
21627
21628
21629 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21630 See &%quota%& above.
21631
21632
21633 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21634 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21635 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21636 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21637 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21638 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21639 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21640
21641 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21642 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21643 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21644 the file length to the file name. For example:
21645 .code
21646 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21647 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21648 .endd
21649 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21650 number of lines in the message.
21651
21652 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21653 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21654 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21655
21656 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21657
21658
21659 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21660 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21661 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21662 .code
21663 quota_warn_message = "\
21664 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21665 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21666 This message is automatically created \
21667 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21668 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21669 a warning threshold that is\n\
21670 set by the system administrator.\n"
21671 .endd
21672
21673
21674 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21675 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21676 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21677 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21678 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21679 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21680 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21681 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21682 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21683 sign. For example:
21684 .code
21685 quota = 10M
21686 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21687 .endd
21688 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21689 percent sign is ignored.
21690
21691 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21692 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21693 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21694 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21695 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21696 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21697 .code
21698 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21699 .endd
21700 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21701 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21702 option.
21703
21704 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21705 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21706 percentage.
21707
21708
21709 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21710 .cindex "envelope sender"
21711 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21712 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21713 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21714 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21715 for details of batch SMTP.
21716
21717
21718 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21719 .cindex "carriage return"
21720 .cindex "linefeed"
21721 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21722 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21723 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21724 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21725
21726 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21727 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21728 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21729 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21730 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21731 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21732
21733
21734 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21735 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21736 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21737 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21738 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21739 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21740
21741
21742 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21743 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21744 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21745 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21746 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21747
21748 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21749 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21750 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21751 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21752
21753 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21754 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21755 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21756 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21757 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21758 error.
21759
21760 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21761 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21762
21763
21764 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21765 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21766 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21767 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21768 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21769 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21770 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21771
21772 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21773 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21774 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21775 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21776 file corruption.
21777
21778 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21779 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21780 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21781
21782
21783 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21784 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21785 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21786 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21787 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21788 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21789 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21790 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21791 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21792
21793 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21794 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21795 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21796 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21797
21798
21799
21800
21801 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21802 .cindex "appending to a file"
21803 .cindex "file" "appending"
21804 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21805
21806 .ilist
21807 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21808 return is given.
21809
21810 .next
21811 .cindex "directory creation"
21812 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21813 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21814 &%directory_mode%& option.
21815
21816 .next
21817 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21818 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21819 transport.
21820
21821 .next
21822 .cindex "file" "locking"
21823 .cindex "locking files"
21824 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21825 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21826 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21827
21828 .olist
21829 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21830 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21831 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21832 .next
21833 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21834 .next
21835 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21836 Unlink the hitching post name.
21837 .next
21838 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21839 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21840 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21841 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21842 .next
21843 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21844 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21845 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21846 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21847 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21848 it before trying again.
21849 .endlist olist
21850
21851 .next
21852 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21853 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21854 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21855
21856 .next
21857 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21858 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21859 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21860 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21861 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21862 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21863 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21864 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21865 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21866 checked.
21867
21868 .next
21869 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21870 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21871 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21872 delivery is deferred.
21873
21874 .next
21875 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21876 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21877 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21878 permissions.
21879
21880 .next
21881 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21882 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21883 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21884
21885 .next
21886 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21887 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21888 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21889
21890 .next
21891 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21892 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21893 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21894 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21895 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21896 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21897 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21898 that prevents link following.
21899
21900 .next
21901 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21902 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21903 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21904 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21905 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21906
21907 .next
21908 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21909
21910 .next
21911 .cindex "file" "locking"
21912 .cindex "locking files"
21913 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21914 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21915 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21916 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21917 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21918 .code
21919 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21920 .endd
21921 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21922 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21923 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21924
21925 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21926 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21927 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21928
21929 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21930 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21931 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21932 delivery is deferred.
21933
21934 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21935 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21936 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21937 immediately. It retries up to
21938 .code
21939 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21940 .endd
21941 times (rounded up).
21942 .endlist
21943
21944 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21945 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21946
21947
21948 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21949 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21950 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21951 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21952 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21953 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21954 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21955 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21956 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21957 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21958
21959 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21960 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21961 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21962 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21963 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21964 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21965 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21966
21967 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21968 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21969 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21970 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21971
21972
21973 .cindex "maildir format"
21974 .cindex "mailstore format"
21975 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21976 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21977 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21978 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21979 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21980
21981 .cindex "directory creation"
21982 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21983 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21984 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21985 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21986 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21987 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21988 deferred.
21989
21990
21991
21992 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21993 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21994 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21995 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21996 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21997 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21998 &_new_& subdirectory.
21999
22000 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22001 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22002 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22003 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22004 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22005 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22006 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22007
22008 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22009 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22010 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22011 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22012 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22013 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22014 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22015 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22016
22017 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22018 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22019 folders. Consider this example:
22020 .code
22021 maildir_format = true
22022 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22023 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22024 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22025 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22026 .endd
22027 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22028 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22029 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22030 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22031 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22032 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22033
22034 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22035 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22036 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22037 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22038 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22039
22040 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22041 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22042 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22043
22044 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22045 .cindex "maildir++"
22046 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22047 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22048 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22049 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22050 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22051 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22052 amount of space used.
22053
22054 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22055 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22056 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22057 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22058 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22059 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22060
22061
22062
22063
22064 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22065 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22066 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22067 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22068 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22069 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22070
22071
22072 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22073 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22074 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22075 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22076 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22077 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22078 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22079 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22080 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22081 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22082 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22083 backwards compatibility).
22084
22085 For one common implementation, you might set:
22086 .code
22087 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22088 .endd
22089 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22090
22091 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22092 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22093 &[stat()]& each message file.
22094
22095
22096 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22097 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22098 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22099 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22100 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22101 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22102 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22103 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22104 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22105
22106 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22107 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22108 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22109 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22110 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22111 need to know the quota.
22112
22113 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22114 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22115
22116 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22117 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22118 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22119 details.
22120
22121
22122 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22123 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22124 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22125 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22126 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22127 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22128 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22129 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22130
22131 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22132 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22133 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22134 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22135 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22136 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22137
22138 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22139 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22140 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22141 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22142 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22143 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22144
22145 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22146 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22147 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22148 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22149
22150
22151 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22152 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22153 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22154 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22155 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22156 .code
22157 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22158 .endd
22159 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22160 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22161 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22162 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22163 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22164
22165
22166
22167
22168
22169
22170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22171 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22172
22173 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22174 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22175 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22176 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22177 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22178 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22179 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22180 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22181
22182 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22183 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22184 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22185 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22186 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22187
22188
22189 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22190 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22191 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22192 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22193 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22194
22195 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22196 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22197 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22198 transport is run as a consequence of a
22199 &%mail%&
22200 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22201 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22202 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22203 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22204 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22205 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22206
22207 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22208 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22209 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22210 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22211
22212 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22213 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22214 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22215 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22216 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22217 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22218 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22219
22220 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22221 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22222 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22223 the transport defers.
22224 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22225 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22226
22227 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22228 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22229 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22230 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22231
22232 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22233 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22234 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22235 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22236 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22237 problems. They are just discarded.
22238
22239
22240
22241 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22242 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22243
22244 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22245 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22246 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22247
22248
22249 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22250 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22251 when the message is specified by the transport.
22252
22253
22254 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22255 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22256 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22257 string comes first.
22258
22259
22260 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22261 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22262 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22263
22264
22265 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22266 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22267 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22268
22269
22270 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22271 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22272 specified by the transport.
22273
22274
22275 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22276 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22277 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22278 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22279
22280
22281 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22282 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22283 the message is specified by the transport.
22284
22285
22286 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22287 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22288 used.
22289
22290
22291 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22292 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22293 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22294 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22295 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22296
22297
22298
22299 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22300 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22301 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22302 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22303
22304 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22305 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22306 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22307 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22308 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22309 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22310 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22311 infinity.
22312
22313 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22314 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22315 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22316 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22317 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22318
22319 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22320 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22321 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22322 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22323 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22324 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22325
22326
22327 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22328 See &%once%& above.
22329
22330
22331 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22332 See &%once%& above.
22333 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22334
22335
22336 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22337 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22338 specified by the transport.
22339
22340
22341 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22342 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22343 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22344 configuration option.
22345
22346
22347 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22348 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22349 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22350 automatic responses. For example:
22351 .code
22352 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22353 .endd
22354 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22355 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22356 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22357 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22358 small.
22359
22360
22361
22362 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22363 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22364 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22365 the text comes first.
22366
22367
22368 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22369 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22370 when the message is specified by the transport.
22371 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22372 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22373
22374
22375
22376
22377 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22379
22380 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22381 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22382 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22383 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22384 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22385 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22386 specified command
22387 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22388 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22389 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22390 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22391 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22392 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22393 .code
22394 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22395 .endd
22396 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22397 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22398 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22399 as follows:
22400
22401 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22402 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22403
22404
22405 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22406 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22407 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22408 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22409 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22410
22411
22412 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22413 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22414 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22415 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22416 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22417 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22418 LMTP protocol.
22419
22420 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22421 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22422 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22423 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22424 in its response to the LHLO command.
22425
22426 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22427 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22428 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22429 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22430
22431
22432 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22433 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22434 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22435 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22436 LMTP transport:
22437 .code
22438 lmtp:
22439 driver = lmtp
22440 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22441 batch_max = 20
22442 user = exim
22443 .endd
22444 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22445 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22446
22447
22448
22449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22451
22452 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22453 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22454 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22455 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22456 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22457 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22458 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22459 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22460 following ways:
22461
22462 .ilist
22463 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22464 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22465 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22466 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22467 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22468 .next
22469 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22470 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22471 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22472 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22473 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22474 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22475 that are routed to the transport.
22476 .next
22477 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22478 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22479 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22480 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22481 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22482 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22483 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22484 .endlist
22485
22486
22487 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22488 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22489 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22490
22491 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22492 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22493 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22494 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22495 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22496 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22497 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22498
22499
22500 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22501 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22502 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22503 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22504 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22505 .new
22506 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22507 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22508 .wen
22509
22510
22511
22512
22513 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22514 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22515 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22516 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22517 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22518 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22519 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22520 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22521 &"local delivery failed"&.
22522
22523 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22524 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22525 will be sent as normal.
22526
22527 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22528 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22529 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22530 apply in this case.
22531
22532 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22533 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22534 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22535 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22536
22537 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22538 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22539 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22540 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22541 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22542 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22543 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22544 &%temp_errors%&.
22545
22546
22547
22548 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22549 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22550 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22551 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22552 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22553 run.
22554
22555 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22556 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22557 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22558 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22559
22560 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22561 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22562 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22563 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22564 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22565 .code
22566 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22567 .endd
22568 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22569 arguments. You have to write
22570 .code
22571 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22572 .endd
22573 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22574 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22575 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22576 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22577 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22578 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22579 example:
22580 .code
22581 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22582 .endd
22583
22584 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22585 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22586 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22587 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22588 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22589 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22590 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22591 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22592 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22593 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22594
22595 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22596 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22597 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22598 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22599 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22600 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22601 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22602 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22603
22604 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22605 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22606 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22607 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22608 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22609 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22610 control what is done with it.
22611
22612 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22613 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22614 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22615 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22616 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22617 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22618 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22619 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22620 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22621 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22622 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22623
22624
22625
22626 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22627 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22628 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22629 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22630 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22631 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22632 environment.
22633 .display
22634 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22635 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22636 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22637 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22638 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22639 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22640 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22641 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22642 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22643 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22644 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22645 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22646 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22647 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22648 &`USER `& see below
22649 .endd
22650 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22651 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22652 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22653 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22654 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22655 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22656 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22657
22658 .cindex "HOST"
22659 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22660 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22661 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22662 the router.
22663
22664 .cindex "HOME"
22665 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22666 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22667 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22668 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22669
22670
22671 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22672 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22673
22674
22675
22676 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22677 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22678 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22679 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22680 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22681 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22682 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22683 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22684 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22685 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22686 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22687 example, if
22688 .code
22689 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22690 .endd
22691 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22692 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22693 &%use_shell%& is set.
22694
22695
22696 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22697 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22698
22699
22700 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22701 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22702 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22703
22704
22705 .option check_string pipe string unset
22706 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22707 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22708 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22709 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22710 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22711 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22712 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22713 ignored.
22714
22715
22716 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22717 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22718 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22719 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22720 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22721 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22722 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22723
22724
22725 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22726 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22727 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22728 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22729 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22730 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22731 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22732
22733
22734 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22735 See &%check_string%& above.
22736
22737
22738 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22739 .cindex "exec failure"
22740 .cindex "failure of exec"
22741 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22742 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22743 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22744 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22745 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22746
22747
22748 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22749 .cindex "signal exit"
22750 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22751 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22752 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22753 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22754
22755
22756 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22757 .cindex "force command"
22758 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22759 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22760 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22761 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22762 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22763 command. For example:
22764 .code
22765 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22766 force_command
22767 .endd
22768
22769 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22770 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22771 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22772
22773
22774 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22775 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22776 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22777 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22778 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22779 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22780
22781 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22782 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22783
22784
22785 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22786 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22787 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22788 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22789 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22790 written to the main log.
22791
22792
22793 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22794 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22795 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22796 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22797 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22798 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22799 be set.
22800
22801
22802 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22803 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22804 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22805 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22806 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22807
22808
22809 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22810 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22811 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22812 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22813 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22814 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22815 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22816 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22817
22818
22819 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22820 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22821 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22822 .code
22823 message_prefix = \
22824 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22825 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22826 .endd
22827 .cindex "Cyrus"
22828 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22829 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22830 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22831 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22832 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22833 setting
22834 .code
22835 message_prefix =
22836 .endd
22837 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22838 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22839
22840
22841 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22842 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22843 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22844 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22845 .code
22846 message_suffix =
22847 .endd
22848 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22849 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22850
22851
22852 .option path pipe string "see below"
22853 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22854 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22855 .code
22856 /bin:/usr/bin
22857 .endd
22858 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22859 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22860 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22861
22862
22863 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22864 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22865 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22866 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22867 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22868 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22869 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22870 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22871 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22872
22873
22874 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22875 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22876 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22877 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22878 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22879 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22880 accept the message is used.
22881
22882
22883 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22884 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22885 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22886 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22887 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22888 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22889
22890
22891 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22892 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22893 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22894 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22895 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22896 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22897 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22898
22899
22900
22901 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22902 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22903 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22904 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22905 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22906 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22907 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22908 of them may be set.
22909
22910
22911
22912 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22913 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22914 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22915 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22916 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22917 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22918 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22919 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22920 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22921 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22922 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22923 and 73, respectively.
22924
22925
22926 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22927 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22928 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22929 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22930 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22931 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22932 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22933
22934 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22935 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22936 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22937 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22938 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22939 delivery to be deferred.
22940
22941 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22942 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22943
22944
22945 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22946 .cindex "envelope sender"
22947 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22948 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22949 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22950 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22951 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22952
22953 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22954 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22955 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22956 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22957 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22958 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22959 class database.
22960
22961
22962 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22963 .cindex "carriage return"
22964 .cindex "linefeed"
22965 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22966 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22967 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22968 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22969
22970 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22971 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22972 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22973 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22974 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22975
22976
22977 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22978 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22979 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22980 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22981 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22982 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22983 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22984 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22985 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22986 its &%-c%& option.
22987
22988
22989
22990 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22991 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22992 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22993 .cindex "external local delivery"
22994 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22995 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22996 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22997 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22998 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22999 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23000 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23001 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23002 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23003 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23004 .code
23005 # transport
23006 procmail_pipe:
23007 driver = pipe
23008 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23009 return_path_add
23010 delivery_date_add
23011 envelope_to_add
23012 check_string = "From "
23013 escape_string = ">From "
23014 umask = 077
23015 user = $local_part
23016 group = mail
23017
23018 # router
23019 procmail:
23020 driver = accept
23021 check_local_user
23022 transport = procmail_pipe
23023 .endd
23024 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23025 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23026 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23027 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23028 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23029 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23030
23031 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23032 .code
23033 IFS=" "
23034 .endd
23035 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23036 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23037
23038 .cindex "Cyrus"
23039 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23040 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23041 .code
23042 # transport
23043 local_delivery_cyrus:
23044 driver = pipe
23045 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23046 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23047 user = cyrus
23048 group = mail
23049 return_output
23050 log_output
23051 message_prefix =
23052 message_suffix =
23053
23054 # router
23055 local_user_cyrus:
23056 driver = accept
23057 check_local_user
23058 local_part_suffix = .*
23059 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23060 .endd
23061 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23062 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23063 sender.
23064 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23065 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23066
23067
23068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23070
23071 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23072 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23073 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23074 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23075 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23076 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23077 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23078 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23079
23080
23081 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23082 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23083 two ways:
23084
23085 .ilist
23086 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23087 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23088 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23089 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23090 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23091 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23092 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23093 .next
23094 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23095 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23096 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23097 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23098 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23099 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23100 process.
23101 .endlist
23102
23103
23104 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23105 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23106 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23107
23108
23109
23110 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23111 .vindex "&$host$&"
23112 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23113 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23114 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23115 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23116 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23117 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23118 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23119 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23120
23121
23122 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23123 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23124 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23125 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23126 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23127 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23128 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23129 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23130 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23131 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23132 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23133 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23134 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23135 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23136
23137 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23138 and will be removed in a future release.
23139
23140
23141 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23142 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23143 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23144
23145
23146 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23147 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23148 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23149 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23150 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23151 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23152 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23153 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23154
23155 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23156 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23157 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23158 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23159 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23160 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23161 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23162 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23163 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23164
23165
23166 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23167 .cindex "Cyrus"
23168 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23169 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23170 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23171 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23172 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23173 ignored.
23174
23175 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23176 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23177 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23178 particular connection.
23179
23180 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23181 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23182 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23183 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23184
23185 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23186 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23187 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23188 .code
23189 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23190 .endd
23191 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23192 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23193
23194 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23195 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23196 value.
23197
23198
23199 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23200 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23201 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23202 authenticated as a client.
23203
23204
23205 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23206 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23207 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23208 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23209
23210
23211 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23212 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23213 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23214 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23215 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23216 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23217 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23218
23219
23220 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23221 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23222 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23223 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23224 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23225 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23226 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23227 option.
23228
23229
23230 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23231 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23232 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23233 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23234
23235
23236 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23237 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23238 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23239 cutoff times.
23240
23241 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23242 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23243 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23244 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23245 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23246 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23247
23248 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23249 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23250 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23251 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23252 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23253 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23254 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23255 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23256 to them.
23257
23258
23259 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23260 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23261 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23262 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23263 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23264
23265
23266 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23267 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23268 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23269 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23270 details.
23271
23272
23273 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23274 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23275 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23276 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23277 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23278 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23279 the dnssec request bit set.
23280 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23281
23282
23283
23284 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23285 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23286 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23287 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23288 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23289 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23290 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23291 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23292 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23293
23294
23295
23296 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23297 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23298 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23299 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23300 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23301 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23302 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23303
23304 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23305 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23306 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23307 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23308 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23309
23310
23311 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23312 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23313 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23314 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23315 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23316 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23317 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23318 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23319
23320 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23321 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23322 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23323 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23324 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23325 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23326
23327 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23328 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23329 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23330 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23331 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23332
23333 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23334 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23335 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23336 copy of the message is sent.
23337
23338 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23339 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23340 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23341 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23342 fails"& facility.
23343
23344
23345 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23346 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23347 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23348 zero.
23349
23350 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23351 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23352 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23353 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23354 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23355 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23356
23357 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23358 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23359 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23360 implementations of TLS.
23361
23362 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23363 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23364 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23365 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23366 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23367 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23368 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23369 option is:
23370 .code
23371 $primary_hostname
23372 .endd
23373 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23374 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23375 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23376 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23377 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23378 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23379 interface address, you could use this:
23380 .code
23381 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23382 {$primary_hostname}}
23383 .endd
23384 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23385 callouts.
23386
23387 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23388 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23389 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23390 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23391 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23392 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23393
23394 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23395 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23396 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23397 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23398
23399 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23400 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23401 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23402 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23403 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23404 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23405 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23406
23407 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23408 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23409 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23410 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23411 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23412 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23413 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23414 address are used.
23415
23416 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23417 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23418
23419
23420 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23421 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23422 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23423 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23424 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23425 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23426 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23427 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23428 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23429 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23430
23431
23432 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23433 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23434 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23435 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23436
23437
23438 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23439 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23440 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23441 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23442
23443 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23444 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23445 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23446 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23447 to any host that matches this list.
23448
23449
23450 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23451 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23452 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23453 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23454 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23455 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23456 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23457 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23458
23459
23460 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23461 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23462 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23463 why it exists.
23464
23465
23466
23467 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23468 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23469 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23470 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23471 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23472 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23473 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23474 explanation of when this might be needed.
23475
23476
23477 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23478 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23479 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23480 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23481 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23482
23483
23484 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23485 .cindex "randomized host list"
23486 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23487 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23488 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23489 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23490 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23491 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23492 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23493 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23494
23495 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23496 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23497 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23498 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23499 .code
23500 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23501 .endd
23502 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23503 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23504 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23505
23506 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23507 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23508 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23509 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23510 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23511 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23512 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23513 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23514 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23515
23516
23517 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23518 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23519 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23520 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23521 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23522
23523 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23524 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23525 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23526 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23527 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23528
23529 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23530 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23531 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23532 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23533 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23534 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23535
23536 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23537 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23538 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23539 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23540 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23541 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23542 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23543
23544 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23545 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23546 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23547 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23548 for multi-recipient messages.
23549 The option can usually be left as default.
23550
23551 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23552 .cindex "bind IP address"
23553 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23554 .vindex "&$host$&"
23555 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23556 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23557 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23558 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23559 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23560 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23561 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23562 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23563 unknown.
23564
23565 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23566 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23567 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23568 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23569 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23570 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23571 .code
23572 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23573 .endd
23574 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23575 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23576 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23577 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23578
23579
23580 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23581 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23582 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23583 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23584 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23585 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23586 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23587 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23588 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23589 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23590 unreachable hosts.
23591
23592
23593 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23594 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23595 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23596 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23597 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23598
23599 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23600 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23601 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23602 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23603 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23604 permits this.
23605
23606
23607 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23608 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23609 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23610 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23611 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23612 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23613 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23614 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23615
23616 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23617 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23618 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23619
23620 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23621 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23622 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23623 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23624 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23625 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23626 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23627 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23628
23629 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23630 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23631 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23632 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23633 is deferred.
23634
23635
23636
23637 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23638 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23639 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23640 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23641 .vindex "&$port$&"
23642 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23643 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23644 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23645 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23646 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23647
23648 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23649 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23650 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23651 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23652
23653
23654 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23655 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23656 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23657 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23658 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23659 addresses is not affected.
23660
23661 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23662 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23663 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23664 Exim to use only the host name.
23665 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23666
23667
23668 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23669 .cindex "serializing connections"
23670 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23671 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23672 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23673 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23674 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23675 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23676 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23677
23678 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23679 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23680 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23681 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23682 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23683 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23684
23685 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23686 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23687 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23688 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23689 are used for ETRN serialization.
23690
23691 .new
23692 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23693 .wen
23694
23695
23696 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23697 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23698 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23699 .cindex "size" "of message"
23700 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23701 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23702 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23703 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23704 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23705 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23706 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23707 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23708
23709 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23710 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23711
23712
23713 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23714 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23715 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23716 .vindex "&$host$&"
23717 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23718 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23719 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23720 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23721 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23722 details of TLS.
23723
23724 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23725 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23726 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23727 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23728 client.
23729
23730
23731 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23732 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23733 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23734 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23735 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23736
23737
23738 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23739 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23740 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23741 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23742 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23743 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23744 will fail.
23745
23746 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23747
23748
23749 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23750 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23751 .vindex "&$host$&"
23752 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23753 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23754 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23755 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23756 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23757 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23758 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23759 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23760
23761
23762 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23763 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23764 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23765 .vindex "&$host$&"
23766 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23767 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23768 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23769 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23770 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23771 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23772 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23773 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23774 ciphers is a preference order.
23775
23776
23777
23778 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23779 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23780 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23781 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23782 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23783 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23784 certificate and private key for the session.
23785
23786 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23787
23788 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23789 TLS extensions.
23790
23791
23792
23793
23794 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23795 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23796 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23797 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23798 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23799 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23800 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23801 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23802 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23803 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23804 in clear.
23805
23806
23807 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23808 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23809 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23810 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23811 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23812 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23813 Note that unless the host is in this list
23814 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23815 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23816 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23817 certificate verification succeeds.
23818
23819
23820 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23821 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23822 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23823 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23824 while verifying the server certificate,
23825 checks will be included on the host name
23826 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23827 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23828 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23829
23830 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23831
23832
23833 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23834 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23835 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23836 .vindex "&$host$&"
23837 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23838 The value of this option must be either the
23839 word "system"
23840 or the absolute path to
23841 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23842 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23843
23844 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23845 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23846 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23847 must be specified.
23848
23849 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23850 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23851
23852 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23853 explicitly
23854 either by file or directory
23855 are added to those given by the system default location.
23856
23857 The values of &$host$& and
23858 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23859 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23860
23861 For back-compatibility,
23862 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23863 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23864 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23865
23866
23867 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23868 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23869 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23870 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23871 certificate verification must succeed.
23872 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23873 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23874 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23875
23876
23877
23878
23879 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23880 "SECTvalhosmax"
23881 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23882 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23883 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23884 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23885 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23886
23887
23888 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23889 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23890 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23891 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23892 retrying.
23893
23894 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23895 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23896 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23897
23898 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23899 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23900 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23901 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23902 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23903
23904 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23905 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23906 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23907 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23908 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23909 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23910 see below for an exception).
23911
23912 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23913 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23914 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23915 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23916 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23917
23918 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23919 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23920 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23921 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23922 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23923 reached their retry times.
23924
23925 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23926 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23927 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23928 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23929 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23930 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23931 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23932 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23933 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23934 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23935 reached.
23936
23937 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23938 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23939 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23940 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23941 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23942 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23943
23944 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23945 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23946 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23947 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23948 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23949 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23950
23951
23952
23953
23954
23955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23957
23958 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23959 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23960 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23961 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23962 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23963 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23964
23965 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23966 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23967 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23968 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23969 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23970 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23971 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23972
23973 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23974 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23975 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23976 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23977
23978
23979 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23980 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23981 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23982 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23983
23984 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23985 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23986 facility; you do not have to use it.
23987
23988 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23989 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23990 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23991 address to which it applies.
23992
23993 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23994 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23995 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23996 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23997 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23998 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23999 rules.
24000
24001 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24002 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24003 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24004 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24005
24006
24007 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24008 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24009 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24010 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24011 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24012 discouraged.
24013
24014 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24015 illustrated by these examples:
24016
24017 .ilist
24018 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24019 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24020 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24021 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24022 .next
24023 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24024 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24025 .endlist
24026
24027
24028
24029 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24030 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24031 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24032 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24033 message's processing.
24034
24035 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24036 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24037 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24038 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24039 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24040 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24041 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24042 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24043 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24044
24045 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24046 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24047 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24048 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24049 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24050 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24051 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24052 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24053 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24054 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24055
24056 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24057 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24058 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24059 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24060 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24061 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24062
24063 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24064 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24065 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24066
24067 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24068 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24069 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24070 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24071 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24072 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24073 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24074 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24075 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24076
24077 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24078 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24079 transport time.
24080
24081
24082
24083
24084 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24085 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24086 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24087 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24088 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24089 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24090 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24091 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24092 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24093 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24094 .code
24095 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24096 .endd
24097 might produce the output
24098 .code
24099 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24100 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24101 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24102 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24103 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24104 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24105 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24106 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24107 .endd
24108 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24109 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24110 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24111 set for a particular transport.
24112
24113
24114 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24115 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24116 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24117 rules in the form
24118 .display
24119 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24120 .endd
24121 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24122 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24123 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24124 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24125
24126 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24127 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24128 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24129 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24130 ignored.
24131
24132 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24133 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24134 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24135
24136 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24137 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24138 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24139 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24140 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24141 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24142 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24143
24144 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24145 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24146 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24147 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24148 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24149 .code
24150 *@* ${lookup ...
24151 .endd
24152 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24153 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24154
24155
24156 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24157 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24158 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24159 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24160 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24161 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24162 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24163 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24164 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24165
24166 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24167 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24168 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24169
24170 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24171 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24172 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24173 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24174 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24175 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24176 of pattern they are set as follows:
24177
24178 .ilist
24179 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24180 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24181 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24182 pattern
24183 .code
24184 *queen@*.fict.example
24185 .endd
24186 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24187 .code
24188 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24189 $1 = hearts-
24190 $2 = wonderland
24191 .endd
24192 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24193 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24194
24195 .next
24196 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24197 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24198 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24199 rewriting rule of the form
24200 .display
24201 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24202 .endd
24203 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24204 .code
24205 $1 = foo
24206 $2 = bar
24207 $3 = baz.example
24208 .endd
24209 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24210 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24211 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24212 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24213 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24214 .endlist
24215
24216
24217 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24218 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24219 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24220 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24221 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24222 .code
24223 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24224 .endd
24225 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24226 &'From:'& headers.
24227
24228 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24229 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24230 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24231 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24232 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24233 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24234 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24235 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24236 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24237 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24238 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24239 entry written to the panic log.
24240
24241
24242
24243 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24244 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24245
24246 .ilist
24247 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24248 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24249 .next
24250 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24251 .next
24252 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24253 .endlist
24254
24255 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24256 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24257
24258
24259
24260 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24261 "SECID154"
24262 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24263 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24264 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24265 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24266 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24267 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24268 .display
24269 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24270 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24271 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24272 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24273 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24274 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24275 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24276 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24277 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24278 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24279 .endd
24280 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24281 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24282 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24283
24284 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24285 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24286
24287
24288 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24289 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24290 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24291 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24292 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24293 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24294 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24295 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24296 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24297
24298 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24299 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24300 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24301 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24302 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24303 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24304 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24305 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24306
24307
24308 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24309 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24310 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24311 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24312
24313 .ilist
24314 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24315 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24316 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24317 .next
24318 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24319 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24320 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24321 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24322 .next
24323 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24324 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24325 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24326 .next
24327 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24328 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24329 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24330 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24331 .code
24332 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24333 .endd
24334 into
24335 .code
24336 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24337 .endd
24338 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24339 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24340 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24341 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24342 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24343 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24344 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24345 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24346 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24347
24348 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24349 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24350 .endlist
24351
24352
24353 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24354 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24355 .code
24356 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24357 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24358 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24359 .endd
24360 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24361 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24362 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24363 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24364 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24365 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24366 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24367 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24368
24369 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24370 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24371 .code
24372 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24373 .endd
24374 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24375 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24376
24377 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24378 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24379 messages that originate outside the local host:
24380 .code
24381 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24382 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24383 .endd
24384 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24385 space.
24386
24387 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24388 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24389 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24390 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24391 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24392 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24393 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24394 components. For example, the rule
24395 .code
24396 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24397 .endd
24398 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24399 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24400 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24401 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24402 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24403 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24404 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24405 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24406
24407
24408
24409
24410
24411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24413
24414 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24415 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24416 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24417 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24418 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24419 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24420 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24421 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24422 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24423 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24424 address, domain and error.
24425
24426 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24427 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24428 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24429 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24430 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24431 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24432 log selector is set, the message
24433 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24434 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24435 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24436 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24437
24438 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24439 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24440 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24441 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24442 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24443 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24444 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24445 domain are maintained independently.
24446
24447 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24448 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24449 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24450 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24451 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24452 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24453 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24454 the local address is reached.
24455
24456 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24457 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24458 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24459 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24460 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24461
24462 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24463 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24464 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24465 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24466 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24467 messages that it should now be retaining.
24468
24469
24470
24471 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24472 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24473 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24474 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24475 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24476 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24477 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24478 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24479 message's sender, respectively.
24480
24481
24482 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24483 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24484 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24485 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24486 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24487 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24488 example,
24489 .code
24490 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24491 .endd
24492 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24493 whereas
24494 .code
24495 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24496 .endd
24497 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24498 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24499 part.
24500
24501 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24502 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24503 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24504 expressions work in address lists.
24505 .display
24506 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24507 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24508 .endd
24509
24510
24511 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24512 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24513 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24514 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24515 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24516 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24517 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24518 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24519 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24520
24521 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24522 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24523 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24524 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24525 local transports).
24526
24527 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24528 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24529 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24530 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24531 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24532 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24533 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24534 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24535 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24536 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24537 commands.
24538
24539
24540
24541 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24542 "SECID160"
24543 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24544 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24545 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24546 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24547 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24548 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24549 .code
24550 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24551 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24552 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24553 .endd
24554 and the retry rules are
24555 .code
24556 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24557 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24558 .endd
24559 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24560 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24561 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24562 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24563 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24564 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24565
24566 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24567 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24568 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24569 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24570
24571 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24572 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24573 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24574 .code
24575 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24576 .endd
24577 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24578 textual form of the IP address.
24579
24580 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24581 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24582 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24583 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24584
24585 .vlist
24586 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24587 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24588 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24589
24590 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24591 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24592 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24593
24594 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24595 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24596
24597 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24598 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24599 .endlist
24600
24601 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24602 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24603 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24604 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24605 retry rule of this form:
24606 .code
24607 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24608 .endd
24609 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24610 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24611
24612 .vlist
24613 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24614 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24615 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24616 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24617
24618 .vitem &%lookup%&
24619 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24620 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24621 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24622 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24623 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24624
24625 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24626 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24627
24628 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24629 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24630
24631 .vitem &%refused%&
24632 A connection was refused.
24633
24634 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24635 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24636
24637 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24638 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24639
24640 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24641 A connection attempt timed out.
24642
24643 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24644 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24645 obtained from an MX record.
24646
24647 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24648 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24649 obtained from an MX record.
24650
24651 .vitem &%timeout%&
24652 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24653
24654 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24655 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24656 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24657 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24658
24659 .vitem &%quota%&
24660 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24661 transport.
24662
24663 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24664 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24665 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24666 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24667 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24668 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24669 for four days.
24670 .endlist
24671
24672 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24673 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24674 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24675 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24676 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24677 heuristic rules:
24678
24679 .ilist
24680 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24681 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24682 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24683 .next
24684 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24685 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24686 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24687 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24688 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24689 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24690 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24691 .next
24692 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24693 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24694 .endlist
24695
24696 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24697 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24698 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24699 error).
24700
24701
24702
24703 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24704 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24705 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24706 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24707 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24708 form:
24709 .display
24710 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24711 .endd
24712 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24713 .code
24714 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24715 .endd
24716 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24717 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24718 For example:
24719 .code
24720 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24721 .endd
24722 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24723 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24724 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24725 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24726 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24727
24728 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24729 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24730 .code
24731 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24732 .endd
24733 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24734 list is never matched.
24735
24736
24737
24738
24739
24740 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24741 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24742 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24743 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24744 .display
24745 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24746 .endd
24747 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24748 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24749 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24750 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24751 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24752
24753 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24754 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24755 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24756 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24757 The available algorithms are:
24758
24759 .ilist
24760 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24761 the interval.
24762 .next
24763 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24764 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24765 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24766 .next
24767 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24768 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24769 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24770 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24771 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24772 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24773 queue processing times.
24774 .endlist
24775
24776 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24777 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24778 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24779 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24780 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24781 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24782 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24783 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24784 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24785 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24786 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24787 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24788
24789 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24790 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24791 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24792 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24793 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24794 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24795 time.
24796
24797 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24798 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24799 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24800 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24801 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24802 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24803 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24804 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24805 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24806 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24807 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24808 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24809
24810 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24811 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24812 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24813 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24814 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24815 deliveries that have been deferred.
24816
24817
24818 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24819 Here are some example retry rules:
24820 .code
24821 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24822 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24823 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24824 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24825 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24826 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24827 .endd
24828 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24829 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24830 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24831 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24832 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24833 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24834 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24835 days.
24836
24837 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24838 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24839 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24840 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24841 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24842
24843 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24844 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24845 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24846 were not obtained from an MX record.
24847
24848 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24849 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24850 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24851 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24852 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24853
24854
24855
24856 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24857 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24858 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24859 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24860 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24861 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24862 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24863 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24864 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24865 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24866 failing for the first time.
24867
24868 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24869 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24870 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24871 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24872
24873 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24874 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24875 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24876
24877
24878
24879
24880 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24881 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24882 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24883 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24884 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24885 default retry rule:
24886 .code
24887 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24888 .endd
24889 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24890 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24891 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24892
24893 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24894 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24895 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24896 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24897 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24898
24899 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24900 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24901 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24902
24903 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24904 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24905 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24906 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24907 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24908 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24909 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24910 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24911
24912 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24913 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24914 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24915 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24916 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24917 notice.
24918
24919 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24920 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24921 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24922 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24923 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24924 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24925 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24926 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24927 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24928 true.
24929
24930 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24931 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24932 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24933 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24934 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24935 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24936 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24937 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24938 reached.
24939
24940 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24941 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24942 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24943 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24944 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24945 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24946 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24947 time out the address.
24948
24949 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24950 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24951 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24952 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24953 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24954 considered immediately.
24955 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24956 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24957
24958
24959
24960
24961
24962
24963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24965
24966 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24967 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24968 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24969 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24970 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24971 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24972 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24973 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24974 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24975 other.
24976
24977 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24978 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24979
24980 .ilist
24981 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24982 the client's EHLO command.
24983 .next
24984 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24985 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24986 .next
24987 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24988 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24989 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24990 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24991 with the AUTH command.
24992 .next
24993 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24994 .next
24995 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24996 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24997 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24998 connection.
24999 .next
25000 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25001 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25002 unauthenticated connection.
25003 .endlist
25004
25005 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25006 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25007 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25008 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25009 .display
25010 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25011 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25012 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25013 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25014 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25015 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25016 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25017 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25018 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25019 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25020 &`250 HELP`&
25021 .endd
25022 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25023 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25024 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25025 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25026 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25027 included by setting
25028 .code
25029 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25030 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25031 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25032 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25033 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25034 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25035 AUTH_SPA=yes
25036 AUTH_TLS=yes
25037 .endd
25038 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25039 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25040 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25041 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25042 work via a socket interface.
25043 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25044 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25045 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25046 supporting setting a server keytab.
25047 The sixth can be configured to support
25048 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25049 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25050 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25051 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25052 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25053
25054 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25055 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25056 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25057 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25058 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25059 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25060 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25061
25062 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25063 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25064 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25065 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25066 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25067 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25068 .code
25069 cram:
25070 driver = cram_md5
25071 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25072 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25073 client_name = ph10
25074 client_secret = secret2
25075 .endd
25076 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25077 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25078
25079 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25080 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25081 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25082 in Exim.
25083
25084 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25085 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25086 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25087 authenticating data.
25088
25089 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25090 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25091 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25092 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25093 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25094 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25095 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25096 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25097 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25098 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25099 choose to honour.
25100
25101 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25102 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25103 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25104 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25105
25106
25107
25108 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25109 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25110 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25111
25112 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25113 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25114 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25115 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25116 encrypted by a setting such as:
25117 .code
25118 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25119 .endd
25120
25121
25122 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25123 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25124 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25125 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25126
25127
25128 .option driver authenticators string unset
25129 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25130 authenticators is to be used.
25131
25132
25133 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25134 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25135 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25136 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25137 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25138 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25139
25140
25141 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25142 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25143 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25144 mechanism is not advertised.
25145 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25146 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25147 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25148
25149
25150 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25151 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25152 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25153 for details.
25154
25155 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25156 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25157
25158 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25159 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25160 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25161 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25162 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25163 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25164 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25165 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25166 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25167 the error text.
25168
25169
25170 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25171 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25172 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25173 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25174 out the values of variables.
25175 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25176 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25177
25178
25179 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25180 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25181 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25182 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25183 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25184 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25185 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25186 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25187 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25188
25189
25190 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25191 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25192 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25193 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25194 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25195 remembered for later use.
25196 How it is used is described in the following section.
25197
25198
25199
25200
25201
25202 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25203 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25204 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25205 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25206 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25207 message:
25208
25209 .ilist
25210 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25211 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25212 .next
25213 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25214 .next
25215 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25216 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25217 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25218 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25219 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25220 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25221 given for the MAIL command.
25222 .next
25223 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25224 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25225 authenticated.
25226 .next
25227 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25228 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25229 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25230 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25231 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25232 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25233 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25234 message.
25235 .endlist
25236
25237
25238 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25239 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25240 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25241 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25242
25243 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25244 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25245 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25246 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25247 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25248 ACL is run.
25249
25250
25251
25252 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25253 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25254 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25255 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25256 conditions:
25257
25258 .ilist
25259 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25260 .next
25261 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25262 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25263 .endlist
25264
25265 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25266 the mechanisms are advertised.
25267
25268 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25269 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25270 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25271 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25272 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25273 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25274 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25275 .code
25276 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25277 .endd
25278 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25279
25280 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25281 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25282 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25283 such as:
25284 .code
25285 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25286 .endd
25287 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25288 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25289 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25290
25291 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25292 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25293 command. This is the case if
25294
25295 .ilist
25296 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25297 .next
25298 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25299 .next
25300 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25301 server authenticators.
25302 .endlist
25303
25304
25305 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25306 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25307 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25308
25309 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25310 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25311 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25312 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25313 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25314 rejected with a 504 error.
25315
25316 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25317 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25318 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25319 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25320 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25321 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25322 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25323 no successful authentication.
25324
25325
25326
25327
25328 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25329 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25330 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25331 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25332 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25333 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25334 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25335 script:
25336 .code
25337 use MIME::Base64;
25338 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25339 .endd
25340 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25341 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25342 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25343 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25344 command line to run this script on such data might be
25345 .code
25346 encode '\0user\0password'
25347 .endd
25348 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25349 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25350 whose code value is zero.
25351
25352 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25353 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25354 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25355 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25356
25357 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25358 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25359 example, a command such as
25360 .code
25361 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25362 .endd
25363 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25364
25365 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25366 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25367 .code
25368 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25369 .endd
25370 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25371 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25372 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25373 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25374
25375
25376
25377 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25378 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25379 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25380 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25381 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25382 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25383
25384 .ilist
25385 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25386 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25387 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25388 of the authenticator.
25389 .next
25390 .vindex "&$host$&"
25391 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25392 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25393 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25394 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25395 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25396 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25397 delivery to be deferred.
25398 .next
25399 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25400 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25401 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25402 usual way.
25403 .next
25404 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25405 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25406 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25407 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25408 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25409 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25410 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25411 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25412 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25413 .endlist
25414
25415 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25416 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25417 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25418 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25419 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25420 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25421 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25422 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25423 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25424 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25425 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25426 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25427 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25428
25429
25430
25431
25432
25433
25434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25436
25437 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25438 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25439 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25440 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25441 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25442 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25443 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25444 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25445 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25446 connections as you do for login accounts.
25447
25448 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25449 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25450 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25451
25452 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25453 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25454 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25455
25456 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25457 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25458 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25459 given.
25460
25461 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25462 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25463 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25464 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25465 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25466 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25467 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25468
25469 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25470 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25471 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25472 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25473 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25474 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25475 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25476
25477 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25478 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25479 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25480 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25481
25482 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25483 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25484 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25485
25486 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25487 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25488 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25489 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25490 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25491 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25492 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25493 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25494 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25495 string as the error text
25496
25497 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25498 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25499 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25500
25501
25502
25503 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25504 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25505 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25506 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25507 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25508 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25509 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25510 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25511
25512 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25513 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25514 configured as follows:
25515 .code
25516 fixed_plain:
25517 driver = plaintext
25518 public_name = PLAIN
25519 server_prompts = :
25520 server_condition = \
25521 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25522 server_set_id = $auth2
25523 .endd
25524 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25525 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25526 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25527 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25528
25529 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25530 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25531 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25532 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25533 .code
25534 250-AUTH PLAIN
25535 .endd
25536 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25537 .code
25538 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25539 .endd
25540 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25541 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25542 .code
25543 AUTH PLAIN
25544 .endd
25545 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25546 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25547
25548 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25549 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25550 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25551 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25552 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25553
25554 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25555 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25556 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25557
25558 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25559 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25560 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25561 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25562 This is an incorrect example:
25563 .code
25564 server_condition = \
25565 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25566 .endd
25567 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25568 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25569 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25570 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25571 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25572 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25573 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25574 .code
25575 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25576 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25577 .endd
25578 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25579 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25580 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25581 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25582 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25583
25584
25585 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25586 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25587 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25588 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25589 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25590 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25591 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25592 .code
25593 fixed_login:
25594 driver = plaintext
25595 public_name = LOGIN
25596 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25597 server_condition = \
25598 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25599 server_set_id = $auth1
25600 .endd
25601 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25602 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25603 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25604 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25605
25606 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25607 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25608 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25609 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25610 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25611 .code
25612 login:
25613 driver = plaintext
25614 public_name = LOGIN
25615 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25616 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25617 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25618 ldapauth{\
25619 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25620 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25621 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25622 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25623 .endd
25624 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25625 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25626 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25627 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25628 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25629 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25630 uninterpreted string.
25631
25632
25633 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25634 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25635 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25636 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25637 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25638 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25639
25640
25641
25642
25643 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25644 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25645 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25646
25647 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25648 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25649 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25650 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25651 usual.
25652
25653 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25654 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25655 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25656 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25657 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25658 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25659 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25660 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25661 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25662 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25663 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25664 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25665
25666 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25667 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25668
25669 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25670 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25671 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25672 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25673 the string.
25674
25675 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25676 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25677 .code
25678 fixed_plain:
25679 driver = plaintext
25680 public_name = PLAIN
25681 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25682 .endd
25683 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25684 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25685 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25686 .code
25687 fixed_login:
25688 driver = plaintext
25689 public_name = LOGIN
25690 client_send = : username : mysecret
25691 .endd
25692 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25693 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25694 prompts.
25695 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25696 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25697
25698
25699
25700
25701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25703
25704 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25705 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25706 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25707 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25708 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25709 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25710 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25711 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25712 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25713 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25714 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25715 available in plain text at either end.
25716
25717
25718 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25719 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25720 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25721 authenticator as a server:
25722
25723 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25724 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25725 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25726 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25727 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25728 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25729 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25730 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25731 returned to the client.
25732
25733 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25734 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25735 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25736 numeric variables for other things.
25737
25738 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25739 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25740 user name, authentication fails.
25741 .code
25742 fixed_cram:
25743 driver = cram_md5
25744 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25745 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25746 server_set_id = $auth1
25747 .endd
25748 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25749 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25750 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25751 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25752 .code
25753 lookup_cram:
25754 driver = cram_md5
25755 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25756 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25757 {$value}fail}
25758 server_set_id = $auth1
25759 .endd
25760 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25761 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25762
25763 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25764 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25765 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25766 realm, with:
25767 .code
25768 cyrusless_crammd5:
25769 driver = cram_md5
25770 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25771 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25772 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25773 server_set_id = $auth1
25774 .endd
25775
25776 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25777 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25778 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25779
25780
25781
25782 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25783 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25784 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25785
25786
25787 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25788 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25789 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25790
25791
25792 .vindex "&$host$&"
25793 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25794 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25795 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25796 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25797 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25798 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25799 send the message to the current server.
25800
25801 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25802 strings, is:
25803 .code
25804 fixed_cram:
25805 driver = cram_md5
25806 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25807 client_name = ph10
25808 client_secret = secret
25809 .endd
25810 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25811 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25812
25813
25814
25815 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25817
25818 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25819 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25820 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25821 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25822 .cindex "Kerberos"
25823 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25824 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25825
25826 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25827 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25828 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25829 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25830 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25831
25832 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25833 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25834 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25835 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25836
25837 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25838 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25839 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25840 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25841 depending on the driver you are using.
25842
25843 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25844 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25845 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25846 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25847 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25848 implementation.
25849
25850 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25851 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25852 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25853 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25854 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25855 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25856 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25857 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25858
25859
25860 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25861 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25862 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25863 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25864 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25865 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25866 things.
25867
25868
25869 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25870 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25871 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25872 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25873
25874
25875 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25876 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25877 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25878 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25879 example:
25880 .code
25881 sasl:
25882 driver = cyrus_sasl
25883 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25884 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25885 server_set_id = $auth1
25886 .endd
25887
25888 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25889 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25890
25891
25892 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25893 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25894
25895
25896 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25897 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25898 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25899 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25900 .code
25901 sasl_cram_md5:
25902 driver = cyrus_sasl
25903 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25904 server_set_id = $auth1
25905
25906 sasl_plain:
25907 driver = cyrus_sasl
25908 public_name = PLAIN
25909 server_set_id = $auth2
25910 .endd
25911 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25912 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25913 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25914 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25915 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25916
25917
25918
25919
25920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25922 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25923 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25924 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25925 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25926 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25927 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25928 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25929 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25930 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25931
25932 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25933
25934 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25935 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25936 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25937 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25938 .code
25939 dovecot_plain:
25940 driver = dovecot
25941 public_name = PLAIN
25942 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25943 server_set_id = $auth1
25944
25945 dovecot_ntlm:
25946 driver = dovecot
25947 public_name = NTLM
25948 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25949 server_set_id = $auth1
25950 .endd
25951 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25952 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25953 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25954 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25955 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25956 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25957 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25958 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25959
25960
25961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25963 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25964 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25965 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25966 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25967 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25968 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25969 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25970 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25971 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25972 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25973 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25974 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25975 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25976 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25977 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25978 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25979 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25980 without code changes in Exim.
25981
25982
25983 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25984 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25985 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25986 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25987 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25988 context.
25989
25990 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25991 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25992 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25993
25994 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25995 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25996 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25997
25998 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25999 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26000 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26001
26002
26003 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26004 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26005 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26006 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26007
26008
26009 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26010 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26011 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26012 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26013 example:
26014 .code
26015 sasl:
26016 driver = gsasl
26017 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26018 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26019 server_set_id = $auth1
26020 .endd
26021
26022
26023 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26024 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26025 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26026 the password itself.
26027
26028 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26029 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26030 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26031 if available, else the empty string.
26032 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26033 else the empty string.
26034
26035 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26036
26037 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26038 option to be simply "true".
26039
26040
26041 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26042 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26043 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26044
26045
26046 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26047 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26048 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26049 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26050
26051
26052 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26053 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26054 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26055 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26056
26057
26058 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26059 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26060 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26061
26062
26063 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26064 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26065 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26066 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26067
26068 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26069 meanings for these variables:
26070
26071 .ilist
26072 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26073 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26074 .next
26075 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26076 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26077 .next
26078 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26079 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26080 .endlist
26081
26082 On a per-mechanism basis:
26083
26084 .ilist
26085 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26086 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26087 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26088 .next
26089 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26090 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26091 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26092 .next
26093 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26094 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26095 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26096 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26097 .endlist
26098
26099 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26100 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26101 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26102
26103
26104 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26105 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26106 .code
26107 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26108 driver = gsasl
26109 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26110 server_realm = imap.example.org
26111 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26112 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26113 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26114 server_condition = yes
26115 .endd
26116
26117
26118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26120
26121 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26122 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26123 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26124 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26125 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26126 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26127 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26128 reliably.
26129
26130 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26131 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26132 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26133 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26134
26135 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26136 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26137 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26138 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26139
26140 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26141 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26142 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26143 from the keytab.
26144
26145
26146 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26147 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26148 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26149 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26150
26151 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26152 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26153 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26154 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26155
26156 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26157 .ilist
26158 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26159 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26160 .next
26161 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26162 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26163 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26164 GSS Display Name.
26165 .endlist
26166
26167
26168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26170
26171 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26172 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26173 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26174 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26175 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26176 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26177 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26178 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26179 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26180 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26181 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26182 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26183 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26184 follows:
26185
26186 .ilist
26187 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26188 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26189 .next
26190 The server sends back a challenge.
26191 .next
26192 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26193 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26194 .endlist
26195
26196 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26197
26198
26199
26200 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26201 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26202 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26203
26204 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26205 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26206 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26207 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26208 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26209 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26210 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26211 for other things. For example:
26212 .code
26213 spa:
26214 driver = spa
26215 public_name = NTLM
26216 server_password = \
26217 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26218 .endd
26219 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26220 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26221
26222
26223
26224
26225
26226 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26227 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26228 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26229
26230
26231
26232 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26233 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26234
26235
26236 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26237 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26238
26239
26240 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26241 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26242 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26243 &'msn.com'&:
26244 .code
26245 msn:
26246 driver = spa
26247 public_name = MSN
26248 client_username = msn/msn_username
26249 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26250 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26251 .endd
26252 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26253 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26254
26255
26256
26257
26258
26259 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26261
26262 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26263 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26264 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26265 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26266 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26267 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26268 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26269 authentication based on client certificates.
26270
26271 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26272 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26273 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26274 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26275 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26276 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26277
26278 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26279 for which it must have been requested via the
26280 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26281 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26282
26283 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26284 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26285 and can authenticate the connection.
26286 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26287
26288 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26289
26290
26291 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26292 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26293
26294 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26295 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26296 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26297 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26298 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26299 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26300
26301 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26302 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26303 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26304
26305 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26306
26307
26308 Example:
26309 .code
26310 tls:
26311 driver = tls
26312 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26313 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26314 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26315 {!= {0} \
26316 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26317 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26318 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26319 } } } }
26320 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26321 .endd
26322 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26323 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26324
26325
26326 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26327 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26328 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26329
26330
26331
26332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26334
26335 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26336 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26337 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26338 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26339 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26340 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26341 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26342 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26343 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26344 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26345 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26346 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26347 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26348 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26349 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26350 certificates are used.
26351
26352 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26353 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26354 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26355 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26356 between them is encrypted.
26357
26358 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26359 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26360 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26361 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26362 encryption state.
26363
26364 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26365 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26366 in order to get TLS to work.
26367
26368
26369
26370 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26371 "SECID284"
26372 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26373 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26374 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26375 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26376 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26377 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26378 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26379 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26380 allocated for this purpose.
26381
26382 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26383 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26384 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26385 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26386 .code
26387 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26388 .endd
26389 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26390 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26391 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26392 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26393 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26394 defined elsewhere.
26395
26396 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26397 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26398
26399
26400
26401
26402
26403
26404 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26405 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26406 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26407 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26408 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26409 .code
26410 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26411 .endd
26412 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26413 .code
26414 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26415 .endd
26416 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26417 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26418
26419 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26420
26421 .ilist
26422 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26423 cannot be the path of a directory
26424 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26425 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26426 .next
26427 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26428 .next
26429 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26430 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26431 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26432 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26433 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26434 .next
26435 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26436 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26437 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26438 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26439 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26440 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26441 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26442 option).
26443 .next
26444 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26445 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26446 .next
26447 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26448 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26449 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26450 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26451 .next
26452 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26453 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26454 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26455 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26456 .endlist
26457
26458
26459 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26460 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26461 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26462 but not the chosen filename.
26463 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26464 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26465
26466 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26467 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26468 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26469 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26470 of bits requested.
26471 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26472 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26473 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26474 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26475 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26476 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26477 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26478
26479 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26480 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26481 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26482 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26483 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26484
26485 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26486 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26487 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26488 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26489 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26490 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26491
26492 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26493 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26494 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26495
26496 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26497 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26498 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26499 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26500 .code
26501 # ls
26502 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26503 # rm -f new-params
26504 # touch new-params
26505 # chown exim:exim new-params
26506 # chmod 0600 new-params
26507 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26508 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26509 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26510 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26511 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26512 # chmod 0400 new-params
26513 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26514 .endd
26515 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26516 stalling is removed.
26517
26518 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26519 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26520 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26521 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26522 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26523 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26524 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26525 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26526 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26527 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26528 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26529
26530 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26531 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26532 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26533 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26534
26535 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26536 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26537 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26538 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26539 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26540
26541
26542 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26543 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26544 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26545 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26546 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26547 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26548 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26549 directly to this function call.
26550 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26551 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26552 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26553 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26554
26555 .ilist
26556 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26557 .next
26558 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26559 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26560 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26561 SSL v3 algorithms.
26562 .next
26563 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26564 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26565 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26566 algorithms.
26567 .endlist
26568
26569 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26570 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26571 .ilist
26572 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26573 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26574 stated.
26575 .next
26576 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26577 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26578 .next
26579 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26580 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26581 .endlist
26582
26583 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26584 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26585 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26586 not be moved to the end of the list.
26587 .endlist
26588
26589 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26590 string:
26591 .code
26592 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26593 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26594 .endd
26595
26596 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26597 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26598 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26599 choice of clients used:
26600 .code
26601 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26602 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26603 {DEFAULT}\
26604 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26605 .endd
26606
26607
26608
26609 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26610 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26611 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26612 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26613 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26614 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26615 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26616 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26617 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26618 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26619 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26620 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26621
26622 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26623 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26624
26625 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26626 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26627 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26628 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26629 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26630 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26631
26632 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26633 "Priority strings". This is online as
26634 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26635 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26636 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26637 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26638 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26639
26640 For example:
26641 .code
26642 # Disable older versions of protocols
26643 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26644 .endd
26645
26646 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26647 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26648 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26649
26650 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26651 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26652 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26653 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26654 used:
26655 .code
26656 # GnuTLS variant
26657 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26658 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26659 {SECURE128}}
26660 .endd
26661
26662
26663 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26664 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26665 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26666 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26667 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26668 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26669 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26670 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26671
26672 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26673 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26674 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26675 with the error
26676 .code
26677 554 Security failure
26678 .endd
26679 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26680 rejected with a 554 error code.
26681
26682 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26683 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26684 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26685 without some further configuration at the server end.
26686
26687 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26688 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26689 .code
26690 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26691 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26692 .endd
26693 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26694 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26695 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26696 that goes with it. These files need to be
26697 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26698 always be given as full path names.
26699 The key must not be password-protected.
26700 They can be the same file if both the
26701 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26702 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26703 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26704 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26705 the server's certificate.
26706
26707 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26708 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26709 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26710
26711 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26712 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26713 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26714 transport.
26715
26716 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26717 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26718 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26719 .code
26720 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26721 .endd
26722 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26723 with the parameters contained in the file.
26724 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26725 available:
26726 .code
26727 tls_dhparam = none
26728 .endd
26729 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26730 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26731 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26732 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26733
26734 See the command
26735 .code
26736 openssl dhparam
26737 .endd
26738 for a way of generating file data.
26739
26740 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26741 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26742 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26743 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26744 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26745
26746 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26747 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26748 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26749 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26750 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26751 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26752 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26753 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26754 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26755
26756 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26757 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26758 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26759 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26760 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26761 documentation for more details.
26762
26763 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26764 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26765
26766
26767 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26768 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26769 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26770 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26771 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26772 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26773 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26774 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26775 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26776 expected certificates.
26777 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26778 an explicit file or,
26779 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26780 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26781
26782 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26783 directory is used
26784 (OpenSSL only),
26785 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26786 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26787 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26788 .code
26789 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26790 .endd
26791 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26792
26793 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26794 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26795 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26796 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26797 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26798 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26799 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26800 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26801 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26802 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26803
26804 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26805 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26806 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26807 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26808
26809 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26810 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26811 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26812 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26813 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26814 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26815
26816
26817 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26818 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26819 .cindex "revocation list"
26820 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26821 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26822 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26823 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26824 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26825 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26826 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26827 CRL in PEM format.
26828 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26829 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26830
26831 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26832 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26833 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26834 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26835 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26836 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26837
26838 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26839 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26840 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26841 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26842
26843 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26844 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26845 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26846 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26847 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26848 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26849 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26850 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26851
26852 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26853 .new
26854 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26855 .wen
26856 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26857
26858 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26859 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26860 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26861 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26862 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26863
26864 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26865 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26866 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26867 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26868 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26869 next connection.
26870
26871 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26872 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26873 ignored.
26874
26875 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26876 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26877 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26878 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26879 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26880 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26881
26882 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26883 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26884
26885 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26886
26887 .code
26888 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26889 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26890 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26891
26892 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26893 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26894 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26895 .endd
26896
26897
26898
26899
26900 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26901 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26902 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26903 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26904 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26905 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26906 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26907 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26908 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26909
26910 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26911 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26912 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26913 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26914 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26915
26916 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26917 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26918 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26919 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26920 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26921 usual way.
26922
26923 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26924 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26925 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26926 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26927 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26928 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26929 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26930 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26931 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26932 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26933 unencrypted.
26934
26935 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26936 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26937 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26938 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26939
26940 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26941 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26942 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26943 a file or,
26944 depending on library version, a directory,
26945 must name a file or,
26946 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26947 The client verifies the server's certificate
26948 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26949 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26950 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26951 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26952
26953 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26954 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26955 or need not succeed respectively.
26956
26957 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26958 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26959 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26960 value is empty.
26961 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26962 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26963 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26964 otherwise.
26965
26966 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26967 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26968 for OCSP to be relevant.
26969
26970 If
26971 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26972 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26973 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26974 alternative hosts, if any.
26975
26976 &*Note*&:
26977 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26978 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26979 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26980 client.
26981
26982 .vindex "&$host$&"
26983 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26984 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26985 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26986 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26987 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26988
26989 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26990 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26991 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26992 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26993 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26994 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26995 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26996 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26997 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26998 outgoing connection.
26999
27000
27001
27002 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27003 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27004 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27005 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27006 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27007 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27008 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27009 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27010 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27011 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27012 for this session.
27013
27014 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27015 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27016 address.
27017
27018 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27019 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27020 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27021 be of limited use in that environment.
27022
27023 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27024 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27025 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27026 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27027 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27028
27029 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27030 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27031 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27032 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27033 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27034
27035 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27036 received from a client.
27037 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27038
27039 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27040 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27041 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27042
27043 .ilist
27044 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27045 &%tls_certificate%&
27046 .next
27047 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27048 &%tls_crl%&
27049 .next
27050 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27051 &%tls_privatekey%&
27052 .next
27053 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27054 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27055 .next
27056 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27057 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27058 .endlist
27059
27060 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27061 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27062 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27063 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27064
27065 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27066 are re-expanded.
27067
27068 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27069 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27070 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27071 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27072
27073 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27074 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27075 built, then you have SNI support).
27076
27077
27078
27079 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27080 "SECTmulmessam"
27081 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27082 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27083 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27084 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27085 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27086 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27087 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27088 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27089 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27090 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27091 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27092
27093 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27094 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27095 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27096 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27097 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27098 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27099 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27100 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27101 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27102
27103 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27104 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27105 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27106 information is recorded.
27107
27108 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27109 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27110 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27111
27112
27113
27114
27115 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27116 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27117 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27118 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27119 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27120 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27121 to Apache, currently at
27122 .display
27123 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27124 .endd
27125 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27126 links to further files.
27127 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27128 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27129 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27130 .display
27131 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27132 .endd
27133
27134
27135 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27136 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27137 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27138 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27139 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27140 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27141 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27142 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27143 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27144 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27145 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27146 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27147 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27148
27149 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27150 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27151 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27152 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27153
27154
27155
27156 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27157 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27158 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27159 with OpenSSL, like this:
27160 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27161 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27162 .code
27163 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27164 -days 9999 -nodes
27165 .endd
27166 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27167 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27168 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27169 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27170 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27171 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27172 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27173
27174 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27175 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27176 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27177 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27178 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27179 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27180 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27181 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27182 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27183 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27184 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27185 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27186 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27187 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27188 be a sensible resolution).
27189
27190 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27191 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27192 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27193
27194 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27195 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27196 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27197 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27198 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27199 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27200
27201 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27202 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27203 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27204 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27205 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27206 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27207
27208
27209
27210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27212
27213 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27214 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27215 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27216 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27217 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27218 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27219 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27220 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27221 one very small ACL:
27222 .code
27223 begin acl
27224 small_acl:
27225 accept hosts = one.host.only
27226 .endd
27227 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27228 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27229
27230 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27231 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27232 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27233 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27234 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27235 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27236 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27237 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27238
27239
27240 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27241 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27242 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27243 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27244 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27245
27246
27247
27248 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27249 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27250 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27251 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27252 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27253 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27254 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27255 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27256 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27257 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27258 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27259 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27260 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27261 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27262 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27263 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27264 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27265 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27266 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27267 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27268
27269 .table2 140pt
27270 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27271 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27272 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27273 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27274 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27275 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27276 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27277 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27278 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27279 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27280 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27281 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27282 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27283 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27284 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27285 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27286 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27287 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27288 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27289 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27290 .endtable
27291
27292 For example, if you set
27293 .code
27294 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27295 .endd
27296 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27297 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27298 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27299 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27300 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27301 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27302 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27303
27304
27305 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27306 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27307 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27308 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27309 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27310 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27311 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27312 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27313 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27314 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27315 in any of these ACLs.
27316
27317 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27318 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27319 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27320 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27321 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27322 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27323 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27324 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27325 .code
27326 control = suppress_local_fixups
27327 .endd
27328 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27329 run, it is too late.
27330
27331 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27332 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27333
27334 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27335 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27336 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27337
27338
27339 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27340 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27341 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27342 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27343 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27344 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27345 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27346 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27347 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27348
27349
27350 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27351 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27352 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27353 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27354 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27355 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27356 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27357 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27358 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27359
27360 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27361 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27362 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27363 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27364 an EHLO response.
27365
27366
27367 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27368 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27369 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27370 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27371 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27372 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27373 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27374 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27375 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27376 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27377
27378 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27379 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27380 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27381 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27382 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27383 associated with the DATA command.
27384
27385 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27386 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27387 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27388 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27389 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27390 your resources.
27391
27392 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27393 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27394 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27395 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27396
27397 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27398 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27399 enabled (which is the default).
27400
27401 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27402 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27403 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27404
27405 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27406
27407 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27408
27409
27410 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27411 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27412 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27413
27414 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27415
27416
27417 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27418 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27419 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27420 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27421 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27422 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27423 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27424 has been accepted.
27425
27426 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27427 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27428 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27429 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27430 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27431 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27432 for some or all recipients.
27433
27434 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27435 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27436 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27437 .new
27438 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27439 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27440 is &"yes"&.
27441 .wen
27442 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27443 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27444 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27445
27446 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27447 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27448
27449 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27450 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27451 the feature was not requested by the client.
27452
27453 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27454 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27455 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27456 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27457 does not in fact control any access.
27458 For this reason, it may only accept
27459 or warn as its final result.
27460
27461 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27462 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27463 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27464 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27465
27466 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27467 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27468
27469 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27470 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27471 response to QUIT.
27472
27473 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27474 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27475 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27476 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27477 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27478
27479
27480 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27481 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27482 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27483 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27484 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27485 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27486 situation even worse.
27487
27488 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27489 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27490 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27491 and &%warn%&.
27492
27493 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27494 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27495 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27496 connection. The possible values are:
27497 .table2
27498 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27499 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27500 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27501 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27502 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27503 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27504 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27505 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27506 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27507 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27508 .endtable
27509 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27510 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27511 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27512 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27513 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27514 used.
27515
27516
27517 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27518 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27519 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27520 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27521 .code
27522 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27523 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27524 .endd
27525 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27526 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27527 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27528 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27529 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27530
27531 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27532 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27533 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27534
27535 .ilist
27536 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27537 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27538 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27539 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27540 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27541 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27542 .code
27543 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27544 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27545 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27546 .endd
27547 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27548 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27549 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27550 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27551 .next
27552 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27553 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27554 matches the string.
27555 .next
27556 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27557 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27558 want to have something like
27559 .code
27560 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27561 .endd
27562 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27563 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27564 .endlist
27565
27566
27567
27568
27569 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27570 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27571 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27572 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27573 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27574 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27575 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27576 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27577 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27578
27579 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27580 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27581 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27582
27583
27584 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27585 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27586 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27587 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27588
27589 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27590 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27591 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27592 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27593 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27594 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27595 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27596
27597
27598 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27599 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27600 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27601
27602
27603
27604 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27605 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27606 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27607 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27608 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27609 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27610
27611 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27612 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27613 used to accept or reject anything.
27614
27615 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27616 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27617 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27618 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27619
27620 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27621 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27622 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27623 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27624 configuration file.
27625
27626
27627
27628
27629 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27630 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27631 .vindex &$domain$&
27632 .vindex &$local_part$&
27633 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27634 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27635 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27636 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27637 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27638 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27639 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27640 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27641 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27642
27643 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27644 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27645 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27646 how it is used.
27647
27648 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27649 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27650 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27651 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27652 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27653 received).
27654
27655 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27656 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27657 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27658 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27659 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27660 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27661 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27662 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27663
27664
27665
27666
27667
27668 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27669 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27670 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27671 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27672 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27673 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27674 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27675 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27676 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27677 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27678 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27679 unencrypted connections.
27680 .code
27681 acl_check_auth:
27682 accept encrypted = *
27683 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27684 {CRAM-MD5}}
27685 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27686 .endd
27687 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27688 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27689 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27690 option to do this.)
27691
27692
27693
27694 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27695 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27696 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27697 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27698 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27699 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27700 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27701
27702 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27703 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27704 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27705 example:
27706 .code
27707 deny dnslists = list1.example
27708 dnslists = list2.example
27709 .endd
27710 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27711 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27712 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27713 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27714 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27715
27716
27717 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27718 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27719
27720 .ilist
27721 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27722 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27723 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27724 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27725 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27726 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27727 check a RCPT command:
27728 .code
27729 accept domains = +local_domains
27730 endpass
27731 verify = recipient
27732 .endd
27733 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27734 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27735 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27736 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27737 &%endpass%&.
27738
27739 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27740 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27741 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27742 configuration.
27743
27744 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27745 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27746 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27747 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27748 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27749 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27750 .display
27751 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27752 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27753 .endd
27754 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27755 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27756 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27757
27758 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27759 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27760 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27761 of &%endpass%&.
27762
27763
27764 .next
27765 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27766 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27767 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27768 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27769 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27770 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27771 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27772
27773
27774 .next
27775 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27776 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27777 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27778 example,
27779 .code
27780 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27781 .endd
27782 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27783
27784
27785 .next
27786 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27787 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27788 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27789 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27790 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27791 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27792 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27793 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27794 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27795
27796 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27797 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27798 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27799
27800
27801 .next
27802 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27803 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27804 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27805 .code
27806 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27807 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27808 .endd
27809 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27810 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27811
27812 .next
27813 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27814 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27815 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27816 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27817 .code
27818 require message = Sender did not verify
27819 verify = sender
27820 .endd
27821 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27822 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27823 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27824 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27825
27826 .next
27827 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27828 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27829 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27830 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27831 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27832 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27833 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27834
27835 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27836 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27837 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27838 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27839 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27840
27841 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27842 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27843 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27844 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27845 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27846 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27847 onwards.
27848
27849
27850 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27851 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27852 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27853 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27854 .code
27855 warn !verify = sender
27856 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27857 .endd
27858 .endlist
27859
27860 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27861
27862 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27863 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27864 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27865 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27866 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27867
27868
27869
27870 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27871 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27872 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27873 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27874 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27875 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27876 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27877 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27878 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27879 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27880 .ilist
27881 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27882 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27883 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27884 on the same SMTP connection.
27885 .next
27886 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27887 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27888 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27889 .endlist
27890
27891 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27892 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27893 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27894 .code
27895 accept hosts = whatever
27896 set acl_m4 = some value
27897 accept authenticated = *
27898 set acl_c_auth = yes
27899 .endd
27900 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27901 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27902 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27903
27904 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27905 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27906 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27907 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27908 error is generated.
27909
27910 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27911 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27912
27913
27914 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27915 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27916 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27917 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27918 .code
27919 deny domains = *.dom.example
27920 !verify = recipient
27921 .endd
27922 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27923 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27924 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27925 two statements are equivalent:
27926 .code
27927 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27928 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27929 .endd
27930 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27931 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27932
27933 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27934 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27935 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27936 .code
27937 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27938 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27939 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27940 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27941 .endd
27942 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27943 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27944 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27945 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27946 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27947 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27948 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27949
27950 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27951 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27952 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27953 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27954 message is handled.
27955
27956 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27957 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27958 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27959 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27960 .code
27961 require message = Can't verify sender
27962 verify = sender
27963 message = Can't verify recipient
27964 verify = recipient
27965 message = This message cannot be used
27966 .endd
27967 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27968 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27969 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27970 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27971 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27972 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27973
27974 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27975 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27976 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27977 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27978 .code
27979 deny hosts = ...
27980 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27981 message = Invalid sender from client host
27982 .endd
27983 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27984 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27985
27986
27987
27988 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27989 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27990 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27991
27992 .vlist
27993 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27994 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27995 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27996 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27997
27998 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27999 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28000 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28001 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28002 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28003 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28004 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28005 write rather ugly lines like this:
28006 .display
28007 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28008 .endd
28009 Instead, all you need is
28010 .display
28011 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28012 .endd
28013
28014 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28015 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28016 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28017 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28018 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28019 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28020 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28021 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28022
28023 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28024 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28025 in several different ways. For example:
28026
28027 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28028 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28029 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28030 . ==== way.
28031
28032 .ilist
28033 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28034 .code
28035 accept ...some conditions
28036 control = queue_only
28037 .endd
28038 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28039 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28040
28041 .next
28042 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28043 .code
28044 accept ...some conditions...
28045 control = queue_only
28046 ...some more conditions...
28047 .endd
28048 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28049 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28050 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28051 to be relevant.
28052
28053 .next
28054 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28055 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28056 example:
28057 .code
28058 warn ...some conditions...
28059 control = freeze
28060 accept ...
28061 .endd
28062 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28063 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28064 log entry.
28065
28066 .next
28067 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28068 &%require%& verb. For example:
28069 .code
28070 require control = no_multiline_responses
28071 .endd
28072 .endlist
28073
28074 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28075 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28076 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28077 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28078 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28079 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28080 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28081 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28082 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28083
28084 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28085 example:
28086 .code
28087 deny ...some conditions...
28088 delay = 30s
28089 .endd
28090 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28091 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28092 .code
28093 deny delay = 30s
28094 ...some conditions...
28095 .endd
28096 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28097 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28098 .code
28099 warn ...some conditions...
28100 delay = 2m
28101 control = freeze
28102 accept ...
28103 .endd
28104
28105 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28106 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28107 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28108 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28109 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28110 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28111 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28112
28113
28114 .vitem &*endpass*&
28115 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28116 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28117 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28118 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28119 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28120 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28121 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28122
28123
28124 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28125 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28126 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28127 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28128 .code
28129 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28130 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28131 .endd
28132 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28133 example:
28134 .display
28135 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28136 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28137 .endd
28138 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28139 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28140 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28141 message.
28142
28143 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28144 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28145 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28146 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28147 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28148 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28149 ignored.
28150
28151 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28152 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28153 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28154 error message.
28155
28156 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28157 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28158 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28159 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28160 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28161 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28162
28163 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28164 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28165 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28166 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28167 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28168 logging rejections.
28169
28170
28171 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28172 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28173 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28174 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28175 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28176 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28177 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28178 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28179 .display
28180 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28181 &` log_reject_target =`&
28182 .endd
28183 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28184 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28185 current ACL.
28186
28187
28188 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28189 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28190 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28191 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28192 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28193 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28194 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28195 ACLs. For example:
28196 .display
28197 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28198 &` control = freeze`&
28199 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28200 .endd
28201 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28202 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28203 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28204 example:
28205 .code
28206 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28207 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28208 .endd
28209
28210
28211 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28212 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28213 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28214 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28215 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28216 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28217 &%accept%& for details.)
28218
28219 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28220 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28221 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28222 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28223 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28224 .code
28225 require message = Host not recognized
28226 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28227 .endd
28228 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28229 processed.)
28230
28231 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28232 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28233 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28234 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28235 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28236 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28237 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28238 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28239 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28240 EHLO options.
28241
28242 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28243 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28244 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28245 .code
28246 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28247 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28248 .endd
28249 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28250 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28251 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28252 2&'xx'&.
28253
28254 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28255 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28256
28257 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28258 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28259 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28260 response.
28261
28262 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28263 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28264 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28265
28266 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28267 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28268 However, the original message is available in the variable
28269 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28270 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28271 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28272 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28273
28274 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28275 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28276 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28277 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28278 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28279 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28280 effect.
28281
28282
28283 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28284 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28285 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28286 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28287
28288
28289 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28290 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28291 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28292 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28293
28294
28295 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28296 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28297 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28298 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28299 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28300 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28301 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28302 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28303 when:
28304 .code
28305 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28306 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28307 .endd
28308 .endlist
28309
28310
28311
28312
28313 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28314 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28315 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28316
28317 .vlist
28318 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28319 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28320 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28321 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28322 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28323 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28324 not work without it. For example:
28325 .code
28326 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28327 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28328 .endd
28329 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28330 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28331 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28332 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28333 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28334
28335
28336 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28337 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28338 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28339 .cindex "case of local parts"
28340 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28341 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28342 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28343 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28344 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28345 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28346 is encountered.
28347
28348 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28349 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28350 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28351 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28352 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28353
28354 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28355 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28356 spam score:
28357 .code
28358 warn control = caseful_local_part
28359 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28360 $acl_m4 + \
28361 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28362 }
28363 control = caselower_local_part
28364 .endd
28365 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28366 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28367
28368
28369 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28370 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28371 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28372 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28373
28374 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28375 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28376 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28377 is used for all recipients of the message,
28378 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28379 and data is copied from one to the other.
28380
28381 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28382 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28383 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28384 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28385 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28386 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28387
28388 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28389 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28390 Note also that headers cannot be
28391 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28392 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28393
28394 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28395 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28396 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28397 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28398
28399 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28400 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28401 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28402 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28403 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28404 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28405
28406 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28407 (possibly faked)
28408 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28409
28410
28411 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28412 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28413 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28414 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28415 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28416 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28417 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28418 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28419 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28420 contexts):
28421 .code
28422 control = debug
28423 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28424 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28425 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28426 .endd
28427
28428
28429 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28430 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28431 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28432 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28433 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28434
28435
28436 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28437 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28438 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28439 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28440 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28441 strings or to numeric value.
28442 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28443 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28444 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28445
28446 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28447 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28448 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28449 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28450 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28451
28452
28453 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28454 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28455 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28456 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28457 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28458 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28459 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28460 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28461
28462 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28463 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28464 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28465 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28466 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28467 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28468 work with.
28469
28470
28471 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28472 .cindex "fake defer"
28473 .cindex "defer, fake"
28474 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28475 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28476 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28477 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28478 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28479
28480 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28481 .cindex "fake rejection"
28482 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28483 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28484 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28485 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28486 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28487 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28488 the same SMTP connection.
28489
28490 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28491 message is supplied, the following is used:
28492 .code
28493 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28494 550-kept for evaluation.
28495 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28496 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28497 .endd
28498 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28499
28500 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28501 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28502 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28503 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28504 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28505 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28506 SMTP connection.
28507
28508 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28509 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28510 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28511 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28512
28513 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28514 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28515 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28516 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28517 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28518 disables such output flushing.
28519
28520 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28521 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28522 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28523 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28524 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28525 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28526
28527 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28528 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28529 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28530 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28531 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28532 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28533 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28534 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28535 to be useful in production.
28536
28537 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28538 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28539 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28540 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28541 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28542
28543 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28544 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28545 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28546 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28547 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28548 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28549
28550 .ilist
28551 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28552 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28553 verification failed"&) is sent.
28554 .next
28555 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28556 line is output.
28557 .endlist
28558
28559 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28560 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28561
28562 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28563 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28564 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28565 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28566 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28567 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28568 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28569
28570 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28571 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28572 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28573 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28574 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28575 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28576 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28577 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28578 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28579 same SMTP connection.
28580
28581 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28582 .cindex "message" "submission"
28583 .cindex "submission mode"
28584 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28585 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28586 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28587 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28588 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28589 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28590 late (the message has already been created).
28591
28592 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28593 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28594 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28595 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28596 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28597
28598 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28599 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28600 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28601 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28602 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28603
28604 .ilist
28605 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28606 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28607 .next
28608 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28609 .next
28610 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28611 .endlist ilist
28612
28613 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28614 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28615 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28616 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28617 data is read.
28618
28619 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28620 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28621 .endlist vlist
28622
28623
28624 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28625 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28626
28627 .ilist
28628 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28629 .next
28630 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28631 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28632 .next
28633 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28634 .next
28635 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28636 .endlist
28637
28638
28639
28640 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28641 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28642 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28643 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28644 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28645 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28646 .code
28647 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28648 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28649 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28650 .endd
28651 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28652 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28653 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28654 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28655 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28656 RCPT ACL).
28657
28658 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28659 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28660
28661 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28662 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28663 contains one or more newlines that
28664 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28665 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28666 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28667
28668 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28669 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28670 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28671 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28672 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28673 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28674 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28675 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28676 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28677 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28678 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28679
28680 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28681 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28682 of message headers
28683 until they are added to the
28684 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28685 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28686 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28687 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28688 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28689 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28690 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28691
28692 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28693
28694 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28695 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28696 .display
28697 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28698 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28699
28700 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28701 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28702 .endd
28703 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28704 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28705 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28706 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28707 honoured.
28708
28709 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28710 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28711 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28712 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28713 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28714 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28715 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28716 specifications.
28717
28718 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28719 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28720 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28721 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28722 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28723
28724 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28725 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28726 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28727 to be a header name first.) For example:
28728 .code
28729 warn add_header = \
28730 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28731 .endd
28732 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28733 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28734 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28735 up in reverse order.
28736
28737 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28738 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28739 system filter or in a router or transport.
28740
28741
28742
28743 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28744 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28745 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28746 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28747 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28748 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28749 .code
28750 warn message = Remove internal headers
28751 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28752 .endd
28753 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28754 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28755 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28756 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28757 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28758 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28759
28760 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28761 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28762
28763 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28764 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28765 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28766 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28767 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28768 .code
28769 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28770 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28771 warn message = Remove internal headers
28772 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28773 .endd
28774 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28775 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28776 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28777 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28778 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28779 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28780 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28781 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28782 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28783 would have been removed.
28784
28785 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28786 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28787 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28788 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28789 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28790 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28791 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28792 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28793 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28794
28795 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28796 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28797 .display
28798 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28799 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28800
28801 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28802 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28803 .endd
28804 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28805 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28806 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28807 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28808 are honoured.
28809
28810 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28811 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28812 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28813
28814
28815
28816
28817 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28818 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28819 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28820 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28821 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28822 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28823
28824 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28825 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28826 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28827 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28828 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28829 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28830 The conditions are as follows:
28831
28832
28833 .vlist
28834 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28835 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28836 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28837 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28838 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28839 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28840 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28841 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28842 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28843 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28844 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28845 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28846
28847 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28848 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28849 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28850 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28851 The name and values are expanded separately.
28852 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28853 will act as argument separators.
28854
28855 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28856 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28857 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28858 conditions are tested.
28859
28860 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28861 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28862 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28863 for different local users or different local domains.
28864
28865 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28866 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28867 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28868 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28869 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28870 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28871 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28872 .code
28873 authenticated = *
28874 .endd
28875
28876 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28877 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28878 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28879 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28880 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28881 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28882 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28883 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28884 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28885 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28886 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28887 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28888 negative.
28889
28890 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28891 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28892 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28893 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28894 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28895 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28896 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28897 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28898
28899 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28900 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28901 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28902 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28903 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28904
28905 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28906 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28907 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28908 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28909 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28910 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28911 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28912 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28913 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28914 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28915
28916 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28917 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28918 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28919 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28920 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28921 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28922 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28923 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28924 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28925 &%domains%& test.
28926
28927 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28928 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28929
28930
28931 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28932 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28933 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28934 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28935 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28936 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28937 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28938 .code
28939 encrypted = *
28940 .endd
28941
28942
28943 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28944 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28945 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28946 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28947 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28948 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28949 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28950 .code
28951 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28952 .endd
28953 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28954 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28955 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28956
28957 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28958 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28959 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28960 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28961 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28962 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28963
28964 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28965 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28966 .code
28967 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28968 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28969 .endd
28970 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28971 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28972 statement can then check the IP address.
28973
28974 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28975 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28976 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28977 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28978 .code
28979 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28980 message = $host_data
28981 .endd
28982 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28983
28984 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28985 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28986 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28987 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28988 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28989 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28990 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28991 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28992 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28993 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28994
28995 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28996 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28997 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28998 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28999 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29000 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29001 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29002
29003 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29004 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29005 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29006 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29007 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29008 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29009 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29010 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29011
29012 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29013 .cindex "rate limiting"
29014 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29015 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29016
29017 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29018 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29019 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29020 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29021 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29022 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29023
29024 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29025 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29026 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29027 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29028 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29029 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29030 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29031
29032 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29033 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29034 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29035 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29036 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29037 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29038 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29039 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29040 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29041 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29042 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29043 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29044 influence the sender checking.
29045
29046 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29047 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29048
29049 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29050 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29051 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29052 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29053 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29054 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29055 .code
29056 senders = :
29057 .endd
29058 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29059 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29060
29061 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29062 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29063 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29064 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29065 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29066 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29067
29068 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29069 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29070 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29071 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29072 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29073 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29074 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29075 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29076 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29077 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29078
29079 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29080 .cindex "CSA verification"
29081 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29082 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29083 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29084
29085 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29086 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29087 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29088 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29089 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29090 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29091 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29092 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29093 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29094 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29095
29096 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29097 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29098 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29099
29100 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29101 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29102 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29103 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29104 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29105 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29106 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29107 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29108 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29109 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29110 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29111 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29112 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29113 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29114 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29115
29116 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29117 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29118 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29119 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29120 .code
29121 deny senders = :
29122 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29123 !verify = header_sender
29124 .endd
29125
29126 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29127 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29128 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29129 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29130 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29131 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29132 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29133 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29134 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29135 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29136 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29137 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29138 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29139 appropriate.
29140
29141 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29142 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29143 .code
29144 To: @
29145 .endd
29146 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29147 common as they used to be.
29148
29149 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29150 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29151 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29152 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29153 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29154 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29155 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29156 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29157 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29158 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29159 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29160 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29161 independently of this condition.
29162
29163 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29164 option), this condition is always true.
29165
29166
29167 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29168 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29169 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29170 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29171 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29172 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29173 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29174 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29175 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29176
29177 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29178 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29179
29180
29181 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29182 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29183 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29184 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29185 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29186 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29187 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29188 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29189 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29190 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29191 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29192 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29193 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29194 value for the child address.
29195
29196 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29197 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29198 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29199 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29200 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29201 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29202 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29203 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29204 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29205 original IP address.
29206
29207 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29208 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29209
29210 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29211 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29212
29213 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29214 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29215 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29216 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29217 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29218 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29219 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29220 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29221 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29222
29223 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29224 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29225 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29226 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29227 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29228 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29229 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29230
29231 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29232 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29233 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29234
29235 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29236 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29237 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29238 verified as a sender.
29239 .endlist
29240
29241
29242
29243 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29244 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29245 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29246 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29247 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29248 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29249 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29250 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29251 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29252 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29253 .code
29254 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29255 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29256 .endd
29257 the following records are looked up:
29258 .code
29259 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29260 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29261 .endd
29262 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29263 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29264 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29265 use two separate conditions:
29266 .code
29267 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29268 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29269 .endd
29270 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29271 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29272 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29273 processed.
29274
29275 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29276 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29277 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29278 following special items in the list:
29279 .display
29280 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29281 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29282 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29283 .endd
29284 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29285 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29286 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29287 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29288 .code
29289 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29290 .endd
29291 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29292 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29293 .code
29294 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29295 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29296 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29297 .endd
29298 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29299 .cindex DNS TTL
29300 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29301 .new
29302 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29303 .wen
29304 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29305 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29306 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29307 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29308
29309
29310
29311 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29312 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29313 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29314 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29315 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29316 .code
29317 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29318 .endd
29319 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29320 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29321 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29322 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29323
29324
29325
29326
29327 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29328 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29329 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29330 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29331 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29332 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29333 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29334 .code
29335 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29336 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29337 .endd
29338 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29339 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29340 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29341 up by this example is
29342 .code
29343 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29344 .endd
29345 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29346 addresses. For example:
29347 .code
29348 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29349 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29350 .endd
29351 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29352 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29353
29354
29355
29356
29357 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29358 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29359 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29360 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29361 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29362 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29363 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29364 either to double the separators like this:
29365 .code
29366 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29367 .endd
29368 or to change the separator character, like this:
29369 .code
29370 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29371 .endd
29372 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29373 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29374 occurs. Consider this condition:
29375 .code
29376 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29377 .endd
29378 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29379 .code
29380 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29381 a.domain.black.list.tld
29382 .endd
29383 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29384 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29385 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29386 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29387 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29388 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29389 error for a previous item.
29390
29391 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29392 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29393 .code
29394 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29395 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29396 .endd
29397 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29398 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29399 .code
29400 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29401 $sender_address_domain \
29402 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29403 see $dnslist_text.
29404 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29405 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29406 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29407 .endd
29408 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29409 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29410 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29411 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29412 .code
29413 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29414 .endd
29415 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29416 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29417
29418 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29419 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29420
29421
29422
29423
29424 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29425 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29426 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29427 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29428 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29429 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29430 .display
29431 127.1.0.1 RBL
29432 127.1.0.2 DUL
29433 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29434 127.1.0.4 RSS
29435 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29436 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29437 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29438 .endd
29439 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29440 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29441 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29442
29443
29444 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29445 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29446 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29447 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29448 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29449 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29450 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29451 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29452 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29453 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29454 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29455 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29456 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29457 cases, for example:
29458 .code
29459 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29460 .endd
29461 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29462 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29463 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29464 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29465 .code
29466 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29467 .endd
29468 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29469 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29470
29471 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29472 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29473 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29474 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29475 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29476 information.
29477
29478 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29479 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29480 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29481 .code
29482 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29483 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29484 at $dnslist_domain
29485 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29486 .endd
29487
29488
29489
29490 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29491 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29492 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29493 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29494 For example,
29495 .code
29496 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29497 .endd
29498 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29499 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29500 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29501 describes how multiple records are handled.
29502
29503 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29504 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29505 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29506 .code
29507 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29508 .endd
29509 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29510 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29511 first. For example:
29512 .code
29513 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29514 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29515 .endd
29516
29517 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29518 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29519 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29520 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29521 tested. For example:
29522 .code
29523 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29524 .endd
29525 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29526 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29527 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29528 .code
29529 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29530 .endd
29531 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29532 an odd number.
29533
29534
29535
29536 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29537 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29538 condition. Whereas
29539 .code
29540 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29541 .endd
29542 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29543 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29544 .code
29545 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29546 .endd
29547 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29548 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29549 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29550 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29551
29552 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29553 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29554
29555 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29556 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29557 .code
29558 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29559 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29560 .endd
29561 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29562 Consider this example:
29563 .code
29564 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29565 list.dsbl.org : \
29566 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29567 relays.ordb.org
29568 .endd
29569 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29570 .code
29571 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29572 list.dsbl.org
29573 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29574 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29575 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29576 .endd
29577 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29578
29579
29580
29581
29582 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29583 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29584 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29585 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29586 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29587 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29588 .code
29589 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29590 .endd
29591 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29592 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29593 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29594 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29595 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29596 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29597
29598 .ilist
29599 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29600 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29601 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29602 .next
29603 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29604 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29605 changed to:
29606 .code
29607 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29608 .endd
29609 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29610 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29611 .code
29612 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29613 .endd
29614 for the condition to be true.
29615 .endlist
29616
29617 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29618 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29619 .ilist
29620 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29621 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29622 .code
29623 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29624 .endd
29625 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29626 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29627 .next
29628 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29629 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29630 .code
29631 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29632 .endd
29633 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29634 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29635 .code
29636 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29637 .endd
29638 for the condition to be false.
29639 .endlist
29640 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29641 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29642
29643
29644
29645
29646 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29647 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29648 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29649 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29650 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29651 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29652 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29653 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29654 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29655 lists.
29656
29657 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29658 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29659 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29660 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29661 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29662 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29663 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29664 .code
29665 reject message = \
29666 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29667 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29668 dnslists = \
29669 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29670 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29671 .endd
29672 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29673 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29674 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29675 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29676 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29677 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29678
29679 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29680 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29681 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29682 .code
29683 reject dnslists = \
29684 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29685 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29686 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29687 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29688 .endd
29689 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29690 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29691 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29692
29693
29694
29695 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29696 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29697 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29698 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29699 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29700 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29701 .code
29702 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29703 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29704 .endd
29705 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29706 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29707 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29708 .code
29709 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29710 .endd
29711 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29712 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29713
29714 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29715 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29716 .code
29717 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29718 dnslists = some.list.example
29719 .endd
29720
29721 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29722 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29723 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29724 .code
29725 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29726 .endd
29727
29728 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29729 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29730 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29731 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29732 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29733 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29734 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29735 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29736 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29737 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29738 .display
29739 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29740 .endd
29741 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29742 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29743
29744 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29745 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29746 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29747 of &'p'&.
29748
29749 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29750 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29751 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29752 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29753 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29754 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29755 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29756 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29757 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29758
29759 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29760 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29761 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29762 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29763
29764 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29765 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29766 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29767 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29768 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29769 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29770 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29771 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29772 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29773 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29774
29775 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29776 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29777 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29778 ACL.
29779
29780 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29781 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29782 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29783 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29784 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29785 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29786
29787 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29788 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29789 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29790 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29791 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29792 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29793 the &%count=%& option.
29794
29795
29796 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29797 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29798 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29799 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29800 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29801
29802 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29803 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29804 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29805 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29806
29807 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29808 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29809 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29810 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29811 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29812 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29813 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29814
29815 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29816 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29817 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29818 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29819 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29820 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29821 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29822
29823 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29824 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29825 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29826 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29827 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29828
29829 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29830 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29831 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29832 multiple different commands.
29833
29834 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29835 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29836 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29837 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29838 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29839
29840 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29841
29842
29843 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29844 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29845 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29846 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29847 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29848
29849 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29850 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29851
29852 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29853 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29854 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29855 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29856 new rate.
29857 .code
29858 acl_check_connect:
29859 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29860 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29861 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29862 # ...
29863 acl_check_mail:
29864 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29865 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29866 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29867 .endd
29868
29869 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29870 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29871 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29872 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29873 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29874 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29875 checks.
29876
29877 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29878 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29879 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29880 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29881 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29882
29883
29884 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29885 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29886 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29887 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29888 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29889 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29890 rest of the ACL.
29891
29892 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29893 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29894 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29895 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29896 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29897 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29898 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29899 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29900 from getting any email through.
29901
29902 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29903 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29904 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29905 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29906 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29907 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29908 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29909 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29910 .code
29911 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29912 .endd
29913
29914
29915 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29916 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29917 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29918 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29919 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29920 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29921 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29922 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29923 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29924
29925 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29926 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29927 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29928 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29929 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29930 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29931
29932 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29933 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29934 rate.
29935
29936 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29937 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29938 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29939 required increases with larger limits.
29940
29941 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29942 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29943 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29944 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29945 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29946 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29947 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29948 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29949 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29950 as intended.
29951
29952
29953 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29954 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29955 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29956 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29957 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29958 message. For example:
29959 .code
29960 # Log all senders' rates
29961 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29962 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29963
29964 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29965 # at the decimal point.
29966 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29967 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29968 $sender_rate_limit }s
29969
29970 # Keep authenticated users under control
29971 deny authenticated = *
29972 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29973
29974 # System-wide rate limit
29975 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29976 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29977
29978 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29979 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29980 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29981 messages per $sender_rate_period
29982 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29983 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29984 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29985 .endd
29986 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29987 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29988 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29989 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29990 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29991 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29992 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29993
29994
29995
29996 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29997 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29998 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29999 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30000 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30001 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30002 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30003 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30004 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30005 .code
30006 verify = sender/callout
30007 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30008 .endd
30009 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30010 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30011 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30012 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30013 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30014 The available options are as follows:
30015
30016 .ilist
30017 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30018 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30019 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30020 .next
30021 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30022 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30023 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30024 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30025 .next
30026 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30027 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30028 .next
30029 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30030 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30031 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30032 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30033 .endlist
30034
30035 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30036 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30037 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30038 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30039 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30040 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30041 coding like this:
30042 .code
30043 warn !verify = sender
30044 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30045 .endd
30046 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30047 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30048 verification failure.
30049
30050 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30051 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30052
30053 .ilist
30054 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30055 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30056 .next
30057 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30058 .next
30059 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30060 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30061 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30062 .next
30063 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30064 .next
30065 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30066 .endlist
30067
30068 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30069 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30070
30071
30072
30073
30074 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30075 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30076 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30077 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30078 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30079 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30080 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30081 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30082 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30083 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30084 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30085 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30086 sender's domain.
30087
30088 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30089 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30090 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30091 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30092 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30093 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30094
30095 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30096 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30097 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30098 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30099 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30100
30101 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30102 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30103 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30104 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30105 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30106 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30107 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30108 supplies a host list.
30109 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30110
30111 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30112 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30113 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30114 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30115 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30116 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30117 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30118
30119 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30120 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30121 following SMTP commands are sent:
30122 .display
30123 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30124 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30125 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30126 &`QUIT`&
30127 .endd
30128 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30129 set to &"lmtp"&.
30130
30131 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30132 settings.
30133
30134 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30135 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30136 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30137 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30138 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30139 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30140
30141 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30142 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30143 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30144 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30145 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30146
30147 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30148 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30149 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30150 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30151 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30152
30153
30154
30155
30156 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30157 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30158 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30159 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30160 .code
30161 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30162 .endd
30163 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30164 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30165 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30166
30167
30168 .vlist
30169 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30170 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30171 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30172 For example:
30173 .code
30174 verify = sender/callout=5s
30175 .endd
30176 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30177 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30178 the &%connect%& parameter.
30179
30180
30181 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30182 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30183 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30184 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30185 .code
30186 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30187 .endd
30188 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30189
30190 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30191 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30192 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30193 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30194 updated in this circumstance.
30195
30196 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30197 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30198 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30199 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30200 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30201 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30202
30203
30204 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30205 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30206 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30207 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30208 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30209 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30210 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30211 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30212 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30213 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30214 .code
30215 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30216 .endd
30217 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30218
30219
30220 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30221 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30222 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30223 For example:
30224 .code
30225 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30226 .endd
30227 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30228 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30229 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30230 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30231 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30232
30233
30234 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30235 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30236 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30237 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30238
30239 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30240 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30241 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30242 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30243 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30244 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30245 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30246 made, until the cache record expires.
30247
30248 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30249 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30250 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30251 For example:
30252 .code
30253 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30254 .endd
30255 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30256 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30257 .code
30258 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30259 .endd
30260 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30261 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30262 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30263 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30264
30265
30266 .vitem &*random*&
30267 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30268 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30269 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30270 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30271 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30272 .code
30273 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30274 .endd
30275 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30276 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30277 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30278 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30279 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30280
30281 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30282 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30283 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30284 .code
30285 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30286 .endd
30287 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30288 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30289 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30290 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30291 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30292
30293 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30294 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30295 .code
30296 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30297 .endd
30298 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30299 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30300 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30301 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30302 usefulness of callout caching.
30303 .endlist
30304
30305 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30306 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30307 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30308 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30309 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30310 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30311 these circumstances.
30312
30313 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30314 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30315 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30316 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30317 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30318 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30319 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30320
30321 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30322 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30323 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30324 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30325
30326
30327
30328
30329 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30330 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30331 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30332 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30333 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30334 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30335 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30336 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30337 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30338 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30339
30340 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30341 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30342 is not available.
30343
30344 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30345 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30346 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30347
30348 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30349 commands up to and including
30350 .code
30351 MAIL FROM:<>
30352 .endd
30353 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30354 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30355 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30356 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30357 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30358 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30359 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30360
30361 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30362 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30363 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30364 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30365 will eventually be noticed.
30366
30367 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30368 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30369 behaviour will be the same.
30370
30371
30372
30373 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30374 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30375 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30376 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30377 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30378 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30379 you might see:
30380 .code
30381 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30382 250 OK
30383 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30384 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30385 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30386 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30387 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30388 550 Sender verification failed
30389 .endd
30390 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30391 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30392 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30393 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30394 example:
30395 .code
30396 verify = sender/no_details
30397 .endd
30398
30399 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30400 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30401 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30402 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30403 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30404 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30405 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30406
30407 .ilist
30408 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30409 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30410 verification also fails.
30411 .next
30412 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30413 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30414 .endlist
30415
30416 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30417 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30418 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30419 .code
30420 A.Wol: aw123
30421 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30422 .endd
30423 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30424 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30425 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30426 verification to succeed.
30427
30428 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30429 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30430 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30431 option. For example:
30432 .code
30433 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30434 .endd
30435 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30436 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30437
30438 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30439 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30440 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30441 address and a report is output for each of them.
30442
30443
30444
30445 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30446 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30447 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30448 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30449 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30450 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30451 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30452 .code
30453 verify = csa
30454 .endd
30455 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30456 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30457 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30458 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30459 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30460 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30461
30462 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30463 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30464 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30465 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30466
30467 .ilist
30468 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30469 .next
30470 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30471 .next
30472 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30473 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30474 .next
30475 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30476 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30477 .endlist
30478
30479 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30480 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30481 .code
30482 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30483 .endd
30484 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30485 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30486 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30487 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30488 meaningful to say:
30489 .code
30490 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30491 .endd
30492 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30493 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30494 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30495
30496 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30497 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30498 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30499 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30500 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30501 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30502 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30503 of legitimate HELO domains.
30504
30505 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30506 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30507 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30508 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30509 lookup such as:
30510 .code
30511 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30512 .endd
30513 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30514 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30515 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30516
30517
30518
30519
30520 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30521 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30522 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30523 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30524 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30525 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30526 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30527 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30528
30529 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30530 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30531 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30532 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30533 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30534 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30535 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30536
30537 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30538 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30539 like this:
30540 .code
30541 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30542 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30543 }{$value}}
30544 .endd
30545 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30546 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30547 use this:
30548 .code
30549 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30550 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30551 senders = :
30552 recipients = +batv_senders
30553
30554 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30555 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30556 senders = :
30557 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30558 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30559 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30560 .endd
30561 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30562 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30563 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30564 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30565 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30566
30567 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30568 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30569 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30570 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30571 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30572 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30573 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30574
30575 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30576 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30577 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30578 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30579 .code
30580 batv_redirect:
30581 driver = redirect
30582 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30583 .endd
30584 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30585 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30586 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30587 local addresses.
30588
30589 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30590 can be used:
30591 .code
30592 external_smtp_batv:
30593 driver = smtp
30594 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30595 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30596 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30597 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30598 {$value}fail}}}
30599 .endd
30600 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30601
30602
30603
30604 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30605 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30606 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30607 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30608 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30609 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30610 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30611 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30612 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30613 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30614
30615 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30616 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30617 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30618 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30619 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30620 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30621 . ///
30622 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30623 . ///
30624 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30625 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30626 system to arbitrary domains.
30627
30628
30629 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30630 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30631 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30632 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30633
30634 .ilist
30635 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30636 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30637 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30638 .next
30639 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30640 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30641 .next
30642 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30643 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30644 .endlist
30645
30646
30647 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30648 .code
30649 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30650 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30651 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30652 .endd
30653 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30654 command:
30655 .code
30656 acl_check_rcpt:
30657 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30658 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30659 .endd
30660 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30661 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30662 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30663 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30664 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30665 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30666 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30667
30668
30669
30670 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30671 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30672 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30673 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30674 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30675
30676 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30677 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30678 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30679 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30680 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30681 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30682 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30683 .ecindex IIDacl
30684
30685
30686
30687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30689
30690 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30691 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30692 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30693 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30694 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30695 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30696 specification.
30697
30698 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30699 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30700 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30701 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30702 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30703
30704 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30705 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30706 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30707
30708 .ilist
30709 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30710 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30711 .next
30712 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30713 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30714 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30715 .next
30716 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30717 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30718 .next
30719 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30720 conditions.
30721 .next
30722 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30723 .endlist
30724
30725 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30726 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30727 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30728
30729 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30730 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30731 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30732 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30733 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30734 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30735
30736 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30737 temporarily created in a file called:
30738 .display
30739 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30740 .endd
30741 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30742 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30743 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30744 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30745 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30746 .code
30747 control = no_mbox_unspool
30748 .endd
30749 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30750 same directory by default.
30751
30752
30753
30754 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30755 .cindex "virus scanning"
30756 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30757 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30758 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30759 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30760 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30761 in memory and thus are much faster.
30762
30763 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30764 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30765
30766 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30767 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30768 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30769 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30770 .display
30771 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30772 .endd
30773 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30774 .code
30775 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30776 .endd
30777 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30778 before use.
30779 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30780 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30781
30782 .vlist
30783 .vitem &%avast%&
30784 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30785 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30786 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30787 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30788 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30789 This scanner type takes one option,
30790 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30791 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30792 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30793 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30794 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30795 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30796 For example:
30797 .code
30798 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30799 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30800 .endd
30801 If you omit the argument, the default path
30802 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30803 is used.
30804 If you use a remote host,
30805 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30806 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30807 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30808 .code
30809 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30810 FLAGS
30811 SENSITIVITY
30812 PACK
30813 .endd
30814
30815
30816 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30817 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30818 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30819 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30820 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30821 example:
30822 .code
30823 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30824 .endd
30825
30826
30827 .vitem &%clamd%&
30828 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30829 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30830 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30831 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30832 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30833
30834 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30835 a UNIX socket specification,
30836 a TCP socket specification,
30837 or a (global) option.
30838
30839 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30840 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30841 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30842 and the second a port number,
30843 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30844 These per-server options are supported:
30845 .code
30846 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30847 .endd
30848
30849 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30850 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30851
30852 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30853
30854 Examples:
30855 .code
30856 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30857 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30858 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30859 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30860 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30861 .endd
30862 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30863 &`local`&
30864 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30865 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30866 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30867 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30868 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30869 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30870
30871 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30872 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30873 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30874 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30875 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30876 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30877 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30878 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30879 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30880 .code
30881 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30882 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30883 (Connection refused)
30884 .endd
30885
30886 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30887 contributing the code for this scanner.
30888
30889 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30890 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30891 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30892 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30893 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30894
30895 .olist
30896 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30897 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30898
30899 .next
30900 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30901 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30902 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30903 the &"trigger"& expression.
30904
30905 .next
30906 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30907 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30908 &"name"& expression.
30909 .endlist olist
30910
30911 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30912 .code
30913 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30914 .endd
30915 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30916 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30917 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30918 configuration setting:
30919 .code
30920 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30921 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30922 found in file:'(.+)'
30923 .endd
30924 .vitem &%drweb%&
30925 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30926 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30927 takes one option,
30928 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30929 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30930 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30931 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30932 For example:
30933 .code
30934 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30935 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30936 .endd
30937 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30938 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30939
30940 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30941 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30942 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30943 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30944 (or port-range).
30945 For example:
30946 .code
30947 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30948 .endd
30949 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30950
30951 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30952 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30953 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30954 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30955 .code
30956 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30957 .endd
30958 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30959 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30960
30961 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30962 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30963 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30964 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30965 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30966 For example:
30967 .code
30968 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30969 .endd
30970 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30971
30972 .vitem &%mksd%&
30973 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30974 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30975 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30976 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30977 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30978 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30979 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30980 .code
30981 av_scanner = mksd:2
30982 .endd
30983 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30984
30985 .vitem &%sock%&
30986 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30987 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30988 running on the local machine.
30989 There are four options:
30990 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30991 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30992 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30993 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30994 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30995 For example:
30996 .code
30997 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30998 .endd
30999 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31000 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31001 Both regular-expressions are required.
31002
31003 .vitem &%sophie%&
31004 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31005 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31006 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31007 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31008 client communication. For example:
31009 .code
31010 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31011 .endd
31012 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31013 the option.
31014 .endlist
31015
31016 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31017 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31018 ACL.
31019
31020 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31021 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31022 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31023 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31024 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31025 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31026 message.
31027
31028 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31029 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31030 The first element can then be one of
31031
31032 .ilist
31033 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31034 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31035 recommended usage.
31036 .next
31037 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31038 the condition fails immediately.
31039 .next
31040 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31041 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31042 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31043 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31044 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31045 .endlist
31046
31047 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31048 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31049 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31050
31051 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31052 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31053 For example:
31054 .code
31055 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31056 .endd
31057 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31058
31059 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31060 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31061 is set to record the actual address used.
31062
31063 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31064 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31065 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31066 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31067 logging data.
31068
31069 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31070 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31071 &%malware%& condition.
31072
31073 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31074 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31075
31076 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31077 .code
31078 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31079 demime = *
31080 malware = *
31081 .endd
31082 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31083 .code
31084 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31085 demime = *
31086 malware = */defer_ok
31087 .endd
31088 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31089 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31090 .code
31091 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31092 .endd
31093 in the main Exim configuration.
31094 .code
31095 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31096 set acl_m0 = sophie
31097 malware = *
31098
31099 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31100 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31101 malware = *
31102 .endd
31103
31104
31105 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31106 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31107 .cindex "spam scanning"
31108 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31109 .cindex "Rspamd"
31110 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31111 score and a report for the message.
31112 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31113
31114 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31115 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31116 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31117
31118 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31119 .code
31120 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31121 .endd
31122 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31123 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31124 nicely, however.
31125
31126 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31127 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31128 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31129 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31130 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31131 configuration as follows (example):
31132 .code
31133 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31134 .endd
31135
31136 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31137 on TCP port 11333)
31138 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31139 .code
31140 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31141 .endd
31142
31143 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31144 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31145 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31146 .code
31147 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31148 .endd
31149 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31150 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31151 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31152 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31153 .code
31154 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31155 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31156 192.168.2.12 783
31157 .endd
31158 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31159 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31160 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31161 condition defers.
31162
31163 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31164 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31165 and changeable in the usual way.
31166
31167 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31168 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31169 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31170 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31171
31172 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31173 are options.
31174 The supported options are:
31175 .code
31176 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31177 weight=<value> Selection bias
31178 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31179 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31180 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31181 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31182 .endd
31183
31184 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31185 higher values being tried first.
31186 The default priority is 1.
31187
31188 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31189 Within a priority set
31190 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31191 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31192
31193 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31194 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31195 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31196 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31197
31198 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31199 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31200
31201 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31202 The default value is two minutes.
31203
31204 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31205 a failed connect is made.
31206 The default is to not retry.
31207
31208 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31209 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31210 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31211 expansion.
31212
31213 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31214 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31215 is set to record the actual address used.
31216
31217 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31218 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31219 .code
31220 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31221 spam = joe
31222 .endd
31223 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31224 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31225 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31226 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31227 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31228 right-hand side.
31229
31230 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31231 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31232 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31233 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31234 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31235 are not set.
31236 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31237 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31238 after the first),
31239 or the use of PRDR,
31240 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31241 are needed to use this feature.
31242
31243 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31244 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31245 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31246
31247
31248 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31249 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31250 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31251 example:
31252 .code
31253 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31254 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31255 spam = nobody
31256 .endd
31257
31258 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31259 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31260 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31261 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31262
31263 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31264 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31265 variables.
31266 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31267 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31268 available for use at delivery time.
31269
31270 .vlist
31271 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31272 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31273 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31274
31275 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31276 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31277 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31278 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31279 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31280
31281 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31282 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31283 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31284 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31285 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31286 spam bar is 50 characters.
31287
31288 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31289 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31290 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31291 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31292
31293 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31294 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31295 spam score versus threshold.
31296 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31297
31298 .endlist
31299
31300 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31301 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31302 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31303
31304 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31305 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31306 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31307 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31308 spam condition, like this:
31309 .code
31310 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31311 spam = joe/defer_ok
31312 .endd
31313 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31314
31315 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31316 condition:
31317 .code
31318 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31319 warn spam = nobody:true
31320 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31321 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31322
31323 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31324 # is over threshold
31325 warn spam = nobody
31326 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31327
31328 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31329 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31330 spam = nobody:true
31331 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31332 .endd
31333
31334
31335
31336 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31337 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31338 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31339 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31340 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31341 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31342 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31343 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31344 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31345 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31346 cases.
31347
31348 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31349 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31350 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31351 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31352 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31353 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31354 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31355
31356 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31357 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31358 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31359 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31360 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31361
31362 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31363 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31364 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31365 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31366 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31367 syntax is:
31368 .display
31369 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31370 .endd
31371 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31372 the value can be:
31373
31374 .olist
31375 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31376 .next
31377 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31378 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31379 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31380 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31381 .next
31382 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31383 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31384 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31385 the full path and file name.
31386 .next
31387 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31388 filename, and the default path is then used.
31389 .endlist
31390 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31391 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31392 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31393 .code
31394 decode = $mime_filename
31395 .endd
31396 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31397 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31398 automatically unlinked.
31399
31400 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31401 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31402 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31403 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31404 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31405
31406 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31407 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31408 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31409
31410 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31411 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31412 available in the MIME ACL:
31413
31414 .vlist
31415 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31416 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31417 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31418 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31419 contains the empty string.
31420
31421 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31422 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31423 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31424 .code
31425 us-ascii
31426 gb2312 (Chinese)
31427 iso-8859-1
31428 .endd
31429 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31430 case-insensitively.
31431
31432 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31433 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31434 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31435 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31436 only used for display purposes.
31437
31438 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31439 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31440 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31441
31442 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31443 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31444 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31445
31446 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31447 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31448 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31449 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31450 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31451
31452 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31453 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31454 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31455 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31456
31457 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31458 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31459 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31460 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31461 .code
31462 text/plain
31463 text/html
31464 application/octet-stream
31465 image/jpeg
31466 audio/midi
31467 .endd
31468 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31469 empty string.
31470
31471 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31472 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31473 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31474 containing the decoded data.
31475 .endlist
31476
31477 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31478 .vlist
31479 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31480 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31481 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31482 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31483 RFC2047
31484 or RFC2231
31485 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31486 If no filename was
31487 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31488
31489 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31490 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31491 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31492 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31493
31494 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31495 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31496 follows:
31497
31498 .olist
31499 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31500
31501 .next
31502 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31503 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31504
31505 .next
31506 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31507 and the rest are attachments.
31508
31509 .next
31510 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31511 .endlist olist
31512
31513 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31514 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31515 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31516 .code
31517 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31518 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31519 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31520 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31521 .endd
31522 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31523 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31524 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31525 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31526 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31527
31528 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31529 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31530 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31531 decoding is fully recursive.
31532
31533 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31534 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31535 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31536 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31537 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31538 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31539 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31540 .endlist
31541
31542
31543
31544 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31545 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31546 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31547 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31548 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31549
31550 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31551 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31552 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31553 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31554 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31555
31556 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31557 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31558 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31559 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31560 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31561 32K characters are checked.
31562
31563 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31564 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31565 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31566 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31567 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31568 .code
31569 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31570 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31571 .endd
31572 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31573 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31574 matching regular expression.
31575 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31576 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31577
31578 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31579 CPU-intensive.
31580
31581
31582
31583
31584 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31585 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31586 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31587 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31588 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31589 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31590 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31591 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31592 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31593 use the &%demime%& condition.
31594
31595 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31596 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31597 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31598 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31599 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31600 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31601
31602 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31603 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31604 example:
31605 .code
31606 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31607 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31608 .endd
31609 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31610 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31611 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31612 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31613
31614 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31615 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31616 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31617
31618 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31619
31620 .vlist
31621 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31622 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31623 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31624 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31625 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31626 zero, no error occurred.
31627
31628 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31629 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31630 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31631 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31632 .endlist
31633
31634 .vlist
31635 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31636 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31637 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31638 extension it found.
31639 .endlist
31640
31641 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31642 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31643
31644 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31645 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31646 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31647 facility:
31648 .code
31649 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31650 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31651 demime = *
31652 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31653
31654 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31655 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31656 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31657 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31658
31659 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31660 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31661 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31662 demime = exe:doc
31663 control = freeze
31664 .endd
31665 .ecindex IIDcosca
31666
31667
31668
31669
31670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31672
31673 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31674 "Local scan function"
31675 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31676 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31677 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31678 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31679 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31680
31681 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31682 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31683 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31684 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31685 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31686
31687 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31688 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31689 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31690 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31691
31692 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31693 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31694 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31695 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31696
31697 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31698 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31699 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31700 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31701 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31702 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31703 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31704 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31705 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31706
31707
31708
31709 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31710 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31711 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31712 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31713 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31714 directory, so you might set
31715 .code
31716 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31717 .endd
31718 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31719 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31720 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31721 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31722 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31723 _src/local_scan.c_.
31724
31725 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31726 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31727 .code
31728 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31729 .endd
31730 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31731
31732
31733
31734
31735 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31736 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31737 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31738 .code
31739 #include "local_scan.h"
31740 .endd
31741 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31742 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31743 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31744 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31745 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31746 strings and pointers to character strings:
31747 .code
31748 #define CS (char *)
31749 #define CCS (const char *)
31750 #define CSS (char **)
31751 #define US (unsigned char *)
31752 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31753 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31754 .endd
31755 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31756 .code
31757 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31758 .endd
31759 The arguments are as follows:
31760
31761 .ilist
31762 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31763 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31764 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31765
31766 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31767 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31768 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31769 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31770 case this changes in some future version.
31771 .next
31772 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31773 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31774 .endlist
31775
31776 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31777
31778 .vlist
31779 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31780 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31781 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31782 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31783 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31784 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31785
31786 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31787 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31788 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31789
31790 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31791 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31792 queued without immediate delivery.
31793
31794 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31795 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31796 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31797 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31798 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31799 used.
31800
31801 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31802 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31803 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31804 problem"& is used.
31805
31806 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31807 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31808 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31809 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31810 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31811 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31812 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31813
31814 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31815 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31816 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31817 .endlist
31818
31819 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31820 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31821 &%-oe%& command line options.
31822
31823
31824
31825 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31826 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31827 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31828 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31829 want to do this, you must have the line
31830 .code
31831 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31832 .endd
31833 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31834 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31835 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31836 to define them.
31837
31838 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31839 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31840 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31841 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31842 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31843 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31844 .code
31845 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31846 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31847
31848 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31849 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31850 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31851 };
31852
31853 int local_scan_options_count =
31854 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31855 .endd
31856 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31857 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31858 .code
31859 begin local_scan
31860 my_integer = 99
31861 my_string = some string of text...
31862 .endd
31863 The available types of option data are as follows:
31864
31865 .vlist
31866 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31867 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31868 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31869 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31870 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31871 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31872 values.)
31873
31874 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31875 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31876 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31877 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31878
31879 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31880 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31881 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31882 Exim.
31883
31884 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31885 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31886 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31887 printed with the suffix K or M.
31888
31889 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31890 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31891 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31892 always output in octal.
31893
31894 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31895 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31896 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31897
31898 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31899 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31900 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31901 .endlist
31902
31903 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31904 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31905
31906
31907
31908 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31909 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31910 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31911 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31912 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31913 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31914 C variables are as follows:
31915
31916 .vlist
31917 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31918 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31919
31920 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31921 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31922
31923 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31924 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31925 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31926 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31927
31928 .ilist
31929 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31930 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31931 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31932
31933 .next
31934 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31935 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31936 of debugging bits.
31937 .endlist ilist
31938
31939 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31940 selected, you should use code like this:
31941 .code
31942 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31943 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31944 .endd
31945 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31946 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31947 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31948
31949 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31950 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31951 discussed below.
31952
31953 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31954 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31955
31956 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31957 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31958
31959 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31960 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31961 &%-bh%& command line option.
31962
31963 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31964 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31965 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31966
31967 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31968 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31969 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31970 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31971
31972 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31973 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31974 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31975
31976 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31977 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31978
31979 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31980 The number of accepted recipients.
31981
31982 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31983 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31984 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31985 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31986 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31987 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31988 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31989 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31990 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31991 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31992 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31993 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31994
31995 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31996 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31997
31998 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31999 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32000 locally-submitted messages.
32001
32002 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32003 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32004 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32005
32006 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32007 The name of the sending host, if known.
32008
32009 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32010 The port on the sending host.
32011
32012 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32013 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32014
32015 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32016 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32017
32018 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32019 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32020 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32021 .endlist
32022
32023
32024 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32025 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32026 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32027 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32028 their type to *.
32029
32030
32031 .vlist
32032 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32033 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32034
32035 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32036 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32037 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32038 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32039 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32040 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32041 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32042
32043 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32044 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32045 internal newlines.
32046
32047 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32048 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32049 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32050 .endlist
32051
32052
32053
32054 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32055 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32056
32057 .vlist
32058 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32059 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32060
32061 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32062 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32063 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32064 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32065
32066 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32067 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32068 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32069 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32070 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32071 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32072 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32073 is NULL for all recipients.
32074 .endlist
32075
32076
32077
32078 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32079 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32080 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32081 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32082 release:
32083
32084 .vlist
32085 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32086 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32087
32088 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32089 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32090 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32091 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32092
32093 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32094 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32095 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32096 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32097 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32098
32099 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32100
32101 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32102 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32103 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32104 return value is as follows:
32105
32106 .ilist
32107 >= 0
32108
32109 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32110 ending status.
32111
32112 .next
32113 < 0 and > &--256
32114
32115 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32116 signal number.
32117
32118 .next
32119 &--256
32120
32121 The process timed out.
32122 .next
32123 &--257
32124
32125 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32126 .endlist
32127
32128 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32129 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32130 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32131 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32132 forks a subprocess that is running
32133 .code
32134 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32135 .endd
32136 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32137 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32138 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32139 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32140
32141 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32142 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32143 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32144 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32145
32146
32147 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32148 *sender_authentication)*&
32149 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32150 that it runs is:
32151 .display
32152 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32153 .endd
32154 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32155
32156
32157 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32158 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32159 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32160 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32161 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32162 .code
32163 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32164 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32165 .endd
32166
32167 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32168 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32169 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32170 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32171 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32172 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32173 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32174 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32175
32176 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32177 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32178 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32179 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32180 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32181 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32182
32183 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32184 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32185 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32186 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32187
32188 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32189 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32190 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32191 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32192 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32193 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32194 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32195 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32196 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32197 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32198 .code
32199 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32200 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32201 .endd
32202 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32203 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32204
32205
32206 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32207 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32208 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32209 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32210 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32211
32212
32213 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32214 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32215 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32216 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32217 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32218 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32219 .code
32220 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32221 .endd
32222 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32223 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32224 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32225 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32226 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32227 zero-terminated.
32228
32229 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32230 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32231 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32232 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32233 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32234 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32235 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32236 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32237
32238 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32239 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32240 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32241 .display
32242 &`OK `& match succeeded
32243 &`FAIL `& match failed
32244 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32245 .endd
32246 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32247 inability to contact a database.
32248
32249 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32250 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32251 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32252 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32253 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32254
32255 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32256 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32257 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32258 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32259 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32260
32261 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32262 uschar&~*list)*&"
32263 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32264 expected to be
32265 .code
32266 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32267 .endd
32268 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32269 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32270 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32271 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32272 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32273 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32274 failed.
32275
32276 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32277 *format,&~...)*&"
32278 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32279 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32280 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32281 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32282 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32283 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32284
32285
32286 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32287 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32288 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32289 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32290
32291 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32292 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32293 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32294 value afterwards. For example:
32295 .code
32296 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32297 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32298 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32299 .endd
32300
32301 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32302 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32303 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32304 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32305 address.
32306 .endlist
32307
32308
32309 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32310 .vlist
32311 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32312 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32313 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32314 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32315 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32316 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32317 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32318 binary string is returned with an error message.
32319
32320 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32321 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32322 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32323
32324 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32325 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32326 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32327 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32328 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32329
32330 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32331 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32332 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32333
32334 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32335 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32336 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32337 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32338 with translation.
32339
32340
32341 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32342 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32343 below.
32344
32345 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32346 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32347 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32348 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32349 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32350 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32351 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32352 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32353 is involved.
32354
32355 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32356 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32357
32358 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32359 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32360 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32361 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32362 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32363 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32364 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32365 .code
32366 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32367 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32368 .endd
32369 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32370 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32371 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32372 multiple output lines.
32373
32374 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32375 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32376 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32377 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32378 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32379 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32380 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32381 is an error.
32382
32383 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32384 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32385 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32386 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32387
32388 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32389 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32390 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32391
32392 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32393 See below.
32394
32395 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32396 See below.
32397
32398 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32399 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32400 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32401 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32402 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32403 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32404 more discussion.
32405 .endlist
32406
32407
32408
32409 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32410 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32411 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32412 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32413 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32414 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32415 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32416 terminates.
32417
32418 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32419 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32420 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32421 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32422
32423 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32424 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32425 .code
32426 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32427 .endd
32428 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32429 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32430 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32431 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32432
32433 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32434 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32435 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32436 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32437 &%store_pool%&.
32438 .ecindex IIDlosca
32439
32440
32441
32442
32443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32445
32446 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32447 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32448 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32449 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32450 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32451 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32452 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32453 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32454
32455 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32456 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32457 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32458 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32459 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32460
32461 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32462 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32463 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32464 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32465 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32466 prevent it happening on retries.
32467
32468 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32469 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32470 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32471 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32472 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32473 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32474 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32475 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32476
32477
32478 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32479 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32480 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32481 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32482 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32483 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32484 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32485 .code
32486 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32487 system_filter_user = exim
32488 .endd
32489 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32490 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32491 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32492 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32493 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32494 by the &%reply%& command.
32495
32496
32497 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32498 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32499 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32500 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32501
32502 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32503 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32504
32505
32506
32507 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32508 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32509 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32510 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32511 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32512 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32513 they cause errors.
32514
32515 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32516 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32517 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32518 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32519 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32520 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32521 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32522
32523 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32524 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32525 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32526 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32527 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32528
32529 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32530 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32531 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32532 to which users' filter files can refer.
32533
32534
32535
32536 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32537 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32538 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32539 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32540 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32541
32542
32543
32544 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32545 .cindex "freezing messages"
32546 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32547 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32548 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32549 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32550 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32551 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32552 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32553 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32554 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32555 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32556 .code
32557 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32558 .endd
32559 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32560
32561 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32562 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32563 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32564 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32565 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32566 run.
32567
32568 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32569 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32570 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32571 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32572
32573 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32574 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32575 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32576 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32577 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32578 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32579 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32580 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32581 message. For example:
32582 .code
32583 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32584 because it contains attachments that we are \
32585 not prepared to receive."
32586 .endd
32587
32588 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32589 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32590 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32591 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32592 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32593 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32594 use, for example
32595 .code
32596 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32597 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32598 .endd
32599 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32600 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32601 generated by the filter.
32602
32603 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32604 &%defer%&,
32605 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32606 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32607 as
32608 .code
32609 mail ...
32610 freeze
32611 .endd
32612 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32613 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32614 take place.
32615
32616
32617
32618 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32619 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32620 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32621 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32622 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32623 .code
32624 headers add <string>
32625 headers remove <string>
32626 .endd
32627 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32628 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32629 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32630 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32631 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32632
32633 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32634 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32635 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32636 example:
32637 .code
32638 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32639 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32640 X-header-2: ...."
32641 .endd
32642 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32643 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32644 space after input continuations is ignored.
32645
32646 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32647 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32648 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32649 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32650 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32651
32652 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32653 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32654 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32655 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32656 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32657 used for all recipients of the message.
32658
32659 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32660 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32661 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32662 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32663 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32664 until the message is actually being written (see section
32665 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32666
32667 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32668 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32669 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32670 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32671 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32672 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32673 modified more than once.
32674
32675 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32676 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32677 For example:
32678 .code
32679 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32680 headers remove "Subject"
32681 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32682 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32683 .endd
32684
32685
32686
32687 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32688 .cindex "envelope sender"
32689 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32690 .code
32691 errors_to <some address>
32692 .endd
32693 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32694 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32695 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32696 might use
32697 .code
32698 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32699 .endd
32700 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32701 address if its delivery failed.
32702
32703
32704
32705 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32706 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32707 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32708 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32709 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32710 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32711 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32712 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32713 which implements such a filter:
32714 .code
32715 central_filter:
32716 check_local_user
32717 driver = redirect
32718 domains = +local_domains
32719 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32720 no_verify
32721 allow_filter
32722 allow_freeze
32723 .endd
32724 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32725 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32726 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32727 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32728
32729 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32730 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32731 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32732 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32733 normal way.
32734 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32735 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32736 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32737
32738
32739
32740
32741
32742
32743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32745
32746 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32747 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32748 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32749 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32750 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32751 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32752 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32753 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32754
32755 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32756 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32757 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32758 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32759 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32760
32761 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32762 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32763 loopback interface specially in any way.
32764
32765 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32766 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32767
32768
32769
32770
32771 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32772 .cindex "message" "submission"
32773 .cindex "submission mode"
32774 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32775 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32776 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32777 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32778 .code
32779 control = submission
32780 .endd
32781 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32782 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32783 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32784 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32785 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32786 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32787 .code
32788 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32789 control = submission
32790 .endd
32791 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32792 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32793 is used to separate options. For example:
32794 .code
32795 control = submission/sender_retain
32796 .endd
32797 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32798 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32799 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32800 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32801 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32802 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32803 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32804
32805 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32806 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32807 example:
32808 .code
32809 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32810 .endd
32811 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32812 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32813 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32814 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32815 .code
32816 accept authenticated = *
32817 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32818 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32819 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32820 .endd
32821 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32822 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32823 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32824 .code
32825 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32826 .endd
32827 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32828 line would be:
32829 .code
32830 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32831 .endd
32832 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32833 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32834 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32835 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32836
32837 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32838 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32839 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32840 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32841 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32842 spoof another's address.
32843
32844 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32845 .cindex "line endings"
32846 .cindex "carriage return"
32847 .cindex "linefeed"
32848 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32849 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32850 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32851 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32852 use CRLF or just CR.
32853
32854 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32855 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32856 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32857 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32858 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32859 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32860 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32861 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32862 follows:
32863
32864 .ilist
32865 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32866 .next
32867 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32868 is ignored.
32869 .next
32870 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32871 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32872 terminator.
32873 .next
32874 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32875 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32876 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32877 people trying to play silly games.
32878 .next
32879 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32880 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32881 line.
32882 .endlist
32883
32884
32885
32886
32887
32888 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32889 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32890 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32891 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32892 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32893 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32894 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32895 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32896
32897 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32898 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32899 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32900 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32901 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32902
32903 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32904 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32905 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32906 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32907 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32908 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32909 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32910 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32911
32912
32913
32914
32915 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32916 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32917 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32918 .cindex "sender" "address"
32919 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32920 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32921 .cindex "envelope sender"
32922 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32923 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32924 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32925 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32926 .code
32927 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32928 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32929 .endd
32930 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32931 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32932 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32933 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32934 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32935 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32936 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32937 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32938 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32939
32940 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32941 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32942 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32943 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32944 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32945 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32946 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32947
32948 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32949 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32950 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32951
32952 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32953 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32954 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32955 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32956
32957
32958
32959 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32960 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32961 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32962 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32963 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32964 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32965 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32966
32967 .blockquote
32968 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32969 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32970 .endblockquote
32971
32972 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32973 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32974 follows:
32975
32976 .ilist
32977 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32978 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32979 .next
32980 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32981 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32982 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32983 .next
32984 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32985 also removed.
32986 .next
32987 For a locally-submitted message,
32988 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32989 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32990 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32991 included in log lines in this case.
32992 .next
32993 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32994 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32995 .endlist
32996
32997
32998
32999
33000 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33001 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33002 includes the header line:
33003 .code
33004 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33005 .endd
33006
33007 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33008 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33009 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33010 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33011 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33012 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33013
33014
33015 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33016 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33017 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33018 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33019 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33020
33021 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33022 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33023 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33024 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33025 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33026 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33027 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33028 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33029 messages.
33030
33031
33032 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33033 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33034 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33035 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33036 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33037 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33038 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33039 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33040 messages.
33041
33042
33043 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33044 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33045 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33046 .cindex "message" "submission"
33047 .cindex "submission mode"
33048 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33049 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33050
33051 .ilist
33052 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33053 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33054 .next
33055 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33056 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33057 .olist
33058 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33059 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33060 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33061 .next
33062 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33063 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33064 .next
33065 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33066 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33067 .endlist
33068 .endlist
33069
33070 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33071
33072 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33073 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33074 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33075 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33076 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33077 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33078 &%qualify_domain%&.
33079
33080 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33081 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33082 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33083 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33084
33085
33086 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33087 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33088 .cindex "message" "submission"
33089 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33090 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33091 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33092 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33093 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33094 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33095 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33096 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33097 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33098 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33099
33100
33101 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33102 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33103 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33104 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33105 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33106
33107 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33108 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33109 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33110 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33111
33112 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33113 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33114 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33115
33116
33117 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33118 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33119 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33120 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33121 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33122 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33123 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33124 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33125 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33126 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33127 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33128
33129
33130
33131 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33132 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33133 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33134 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33135 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33136 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33137 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33138 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33139
33140
33141
33142 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33143 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33144 .cindex "message" "submission"
33145 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33146 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33147 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33148 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33149 control setting.
33150
33151 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33152 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33153 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33154 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33155 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33156 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33157 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33158 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33159 line is added to the message.
33160
33161 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33162 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33163 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33164 options true at the same time.
33165
33166 .cindex "submission mode"
33167 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33168 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33169 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33170 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33171
33172 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33173 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33174 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33175 created as follows:
33176
33177 .ilist
33178 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33179 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33180 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33181 .next
33182 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33183 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33184 .next
33185 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33186 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33187 .endlist
33188
33189 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33190 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33191 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33192 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33193
33194 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33195 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33196 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33197 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33198
33199
33200
33201 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33202 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33203 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33204 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33205 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33206 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33207 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33208 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33209 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33210
33211 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33212 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33213 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33214 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33215 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33216 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33217
33218 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33219 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33220 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33221
33222 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33223 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33224 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33225 .code
33226 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33227 X-added-second: another added header line
33228 .endd
33229 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33230
33231 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33232 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33233 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33234
33235 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33236 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33237 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33238 not part of the names. For example:
33239 .code
33240 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33241 .endd
33242
33243 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33244 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33245 Each item is separately expanded.
33246 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33247 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33248 will act as list separators.
33249
33250 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33251 items are expanded at routing time,
33252 and then associated with all addresses that are
33253 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33254 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33255 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33256
33257 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33258 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33259 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33260 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33261
33262 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33263 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33264 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33265 requirements.
33266
33267 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33268 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33269 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33270 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33271 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33272 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33273 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33274
33275 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33276 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33277 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33278 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33279
33280 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33281 the following consequences:
33282
33283 .ilist
33284 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33285 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33286 to it, at all times.
33287 .next
33288 Header lines that are added by a router's
33289 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33290 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33291 .next
33292 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33293 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33294 .next
33295 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33296 a later router or by a transport.
33297 .next
33298 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33299 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33300 .code
33301 headers_remove = subject
33302 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33303 .endd
33304 .endlist
33305
33306 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33307 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33308
33309
33310
33311
33312
33313 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33314 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33315 .cindex "constructed address"
33316 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33317 the form
33318 .display
33319 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33320 .endd
33321 For example:
33322 .code
33323 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33324 .endd
33325 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33326 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33327 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33328 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33329 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33330 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33331 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33332 there is no password file entry.
33333
33334 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33335 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33336 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33337 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33338 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33339 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33340 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33341 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33342 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33343
33344
33345
33346 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33347 .cindex "case of local parts"
33348 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33349 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33350 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33351 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33352 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33353 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33354 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33355 router option.
33356
33357 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33358 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33359 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33360 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33361 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33362 .code
33363 correct_case:
33364 driver = redirect
33365 domains = +local_domains
33366 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33367 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33368 @$domain
33369 .endd
33370 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33371 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33372 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33373 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33374 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33375
33376
33377
33378 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33379 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33380 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33381 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33382 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33383 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33384 empty components for compatibility.
33385
33386
33387
33388 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33389 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33390 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33391 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33392 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33393 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33394
33395 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33396 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33397 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33398 example, a header such as
33399 .code
33400 To: hare@teaparty
33401 .endd
33402 might get rewritten as
33403 .code
33404 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33405 .endd
33406 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33407 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33408 been routed.
33409
33410 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33411 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33412 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33413 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33414 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33415 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33416 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33417
33418
33419
33420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33422
33423 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33424 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33425 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33426 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33427 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33428 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33429 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33430
33431 .ilist
33432 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33433 .next
33434 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33435 .next
33436 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33437 .endlist
33438
33439 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33440
33441 .ilist
33442 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33443 .next
33444 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33445 &"lmtp"&);
33446 .next
33447 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33448 transport);
33449 .next
33450 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33451 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33452 .endlist
33453
33454 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33455 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33456 used to contain the envelope information.
33457
33458
33459
33460 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33461 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33462 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33463 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33464 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33465 .cindex "EHLO"
33466 .cindex "HELO"
33467 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33468 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33469 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33470 processing is the same in both cases.
33471
33472 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33473 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33474 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33475 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33476 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33477 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33478 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33479 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33480 suppressed.
33481
33482 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33483 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33484 required for the transaction.
33485
33486 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33487 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33488 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33489 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33490 is called for verification.
33491
33492 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33493 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33494 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33495
33496 .cindex "carriage return"
33497 .cindex "linefeed"
33498 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33499 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33500 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33501 line terminator.
33502
33503 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33504 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33505 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33506 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33507 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33508 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33509 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33510 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33511 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33512
33513 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33514 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33515 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33516 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33517
33518 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33519 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33520 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33521 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33522
33523 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33524 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33525 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33526 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33527 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33528 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33529 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33530 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33531 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33532 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33533
33534 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33535 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33536
33537 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33538 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33539 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33540 square bracket of the IP address.
33541
33542
33543
33544
33545 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33546 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33547 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33548 .cindex "host" "error"
33549 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33550 message errors, and recipient errors.
33551
33552 .vlist
33553 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33554 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33555 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33556
33557 .ilist
33558 Connection refused or timed out,
33559 .next
33560 Any error response code on connection,
33561 .next
33562 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33563 .next
33564 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33565 .next
33566 I/O errors at any time,
33567 .next
33568 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33569 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33570 .endlist ilist
33571
33572 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33573 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33574 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33575 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33576 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33577 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33578 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33579 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33580
33581 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33582 .cindex "message" "error"
33583 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33584 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33585 message errors are:
33586
33587 .ilist
33588 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33589 the data,
33590 .next
33591 Timeout after MAIL,
33592 .next
33593 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33594 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33595 connection at any other time.
33596 .endlist ilist
33597
33598 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33599 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33600 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33601 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33602 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33603 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33604 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33605 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33606 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33607 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33608
33609 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33610 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33611 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33612 response to MAIL.
33613
33614 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33615 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33616 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33617 recipient errors are:
33618
33619 .ilist
33620 Any error response to RCPT,
33621 .next
33622 Timeout after RCPT.
33623 .endlist
33624
33625 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33626 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33627 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33628 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33629 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33630 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33631 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33632 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33633 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33634 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33635 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33636 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33637 the retry clock is reset.
33638
33639 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33640 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33641 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33642 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33643 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33644 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33645 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33646 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33647 recipient's retry time.
33648 .endlist
33649
33650 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33651 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33652 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33653 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33654 until the next delivery attempt.
33655
33656 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33657 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33658 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33659 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33660 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33661 is created.
33662
33663 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33664 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33665 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33666 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33667 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33668 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33669 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33670
33671 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33672 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33673 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33674 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33675 then to be treated as a host error.
33676
33677 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33678 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33679 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33680 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33681 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33682
33683
33684
33685
33686 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33687 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33688 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33689 .cindex "inetd"
33690 .cindex "daemon"
33691 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33692 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33693 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33694 .code
33695 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33696 .endd
33697 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33698 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33699 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33700 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33701 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33702 stream and exits with an error code.
33703
33704 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33705 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33706 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33707 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33708
33709 .cindex "carriage return"
33710 .cindex "linefeed"
33711 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33712 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33713 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33714 line terminator.
33715 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33716 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33717 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33718
33719 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33720 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33721 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33722 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33723 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33724 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33725 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33726 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33727
33728 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33729 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33730 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33731 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33732 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33733 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33734 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33735 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33736 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33737
33738 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33739 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33740 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33741
33742 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33743 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33744 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33745 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33746 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33747
33748 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33749 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33750 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33751 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33752 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33753 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33754 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33755
33756 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33757 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33758 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33759 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33760 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33761
33762 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33763 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33764 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33765 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33766 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33767 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33768 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33769 a delivery process.
33770
33771 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33772 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33773 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33774 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33775 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33776
33777 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33778 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33779 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33780 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33781
33782 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33783 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33784 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33785
33786
33787
33788 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33789 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33790 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33791 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33792 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33793 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33794 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33795 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33796
33797
33798 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33799 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33800 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33801 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33802 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33803 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33804 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33805 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33806 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33807 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33808 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33809
33810
33811
33812 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33813 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33814 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33815 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33816 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33817 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33818 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33819 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33820
33821 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33822 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33823 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33824 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33825 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33826 counted.
33827
33828 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33829 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33830 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33831
33832 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33833 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33834 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33835 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33836 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33837
33838
33839
33840
33841 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33842 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33843 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33844 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33845 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33846
33847 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33848 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33849 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33850
33851 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33852 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33853 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33854 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33855 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33856 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33857 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33858 RCPT failures.
33859
33860
33861
33862 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33863 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33864 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33865 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33866 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33867 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33868 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33869
33870 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33871 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33872 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33873 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33874 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33875 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33876 argument. For example,
33877 .code
33878 ETRN #brigadoon
33879 .endd
33880 runs the command
33881 .code
33882 exim -R brigadoon
33883 .endd
33884 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33885 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33886 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33887 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33888 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33889
33890 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33891 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33892 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33893 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33894 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33895 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33896 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33897 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33898
33899 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33900 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33901 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33902 whatever the form of its argument. For
33903 example:
33904 .code
33905 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33906 $sender_host_address
33907 .endd
33908 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33909 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33910 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33911 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33912 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33913 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33914 for it to change them before running the command.
33915
33916
33917
33918 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33919 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33920 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33921 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33922 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33923 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33924 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33925 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33926 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33927 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33928 runs for RCPT commands:
33929 .code
33930 accept hosts = :
33931 .endd
33932 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33933
33934
33935
33936 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33937 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33938 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33939 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33940 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33941 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33942 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33943 envelope along with the message.
33944
33945 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33946 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33947 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33948 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33949 can be used to specify it.
33950
33951 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33952 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33953 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33954 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33955 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33956
33957 .vindex "&$host$&"
33958 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33959 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33960 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33961 router:
33962 .code
33963 begin routers
33964 route_append:
33965 driver = manualroute
33966 transport = smtp_appendfile
33967 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33968
33969 begin transports
33970 smtp_appendfile:
33971 driver = appendfile
33972 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33973 batch_max = 1000
33974 use_bsmtp
33975 user = exim
33976 .endd
33977 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33978 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33979 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33980
33981
33982
33983 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33984 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33985 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33986 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33987 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33988 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33989 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33990 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33991 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33992 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33993
33994 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33995 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33996
33997 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33998 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33999 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34000 make some use of automatically, for example:
34001 .code
34002 554 Unexpected end of file
34003 Transaction started in line 10
34004 Error detected in line 14
34005 .endd
34006 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34007 file, for example:
34008 .code
34009 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34010 The error message was:
34011
34012 501 '>' missing at end of address
34013
34014 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34015 The error was detected in line 12.
34016 The SMTP command at fault was:
34017
34018 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34019
34020 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34021 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34022 .endd
34023 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34024 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34025 accepted.
34026 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34027 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34028
34029
34030
34031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34033
34034 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34035 "Customizing messages"
34036 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34037 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34038 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34039 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34040 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34041
34042 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34043 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34044 option. Exim also adds the line
34045 .code
34046 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34047 .endd
34048 to all warning and bounce messages,
34049
34050
34051 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34052 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34053 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34054 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34055 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34056 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34057 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34058
34059 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34060 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34061 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34062 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34063 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34064 item.
34065
34066 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34067 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34068 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34069 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34070 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34071 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34072 option, rounded to a whole number.
34073
34074 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34075
34076 .ilist
34077 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34078 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34079 .next
34080 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34081 failing addresses with their error messages.
34082 .next
34083 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34084 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34085 .next
34086 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34087 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34088 .endlist
34089
34090 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34091 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34092 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34093 .code
34094 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34095 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34096 {: returning message to sender}}
34097 ****
34098 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34099
34100 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34101 {that you sent }{sent by
34102
34103 <$sender_address>
34104
34105 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34106 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34107 ****
34108 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34109 ****
34110 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34111 ------
34112 ****
34113 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34114 only the first
34115 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34116 ****
34117 .endd
34118 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34119 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34120 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34121 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34122 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34123 text sections:
34124
34125 .ilist
34126 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34127 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34128 .next
34129 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34130 the delayed addresses.
34131 .next
34132 The third item then ends the message.
34133 .endlist
34134
34135 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34136 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34137 .code
34138 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34139 $warn_message_delay
34140 ****
34141 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34142
34143 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34144 {that you sent }{sent by
34145
34146 <$sender_address>
34147
34148 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34149 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34150
34151 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34152 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34153 The date of the message is: $h_date
34154
34155 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34156 ****
34157 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34158 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34159 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34160 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34161 the message will be returned to you.
34162 .endd
34163 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34164 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34165 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34166 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34167 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34168 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34169 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34170 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34171 handled them.
34172
34173
34174
34175
34176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34178
34179 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34180 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34181 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34182
34183
34184
34185 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34186 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34187 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34188 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34189 routing explicitly:
34190 .code
34191 send_to_smart_host:
34192 driver = manualroute
34193 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34194 transport = remote_smtp
34195 .endd
34196 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34197 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34198 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34199 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34200 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34201
34202
34203
34204
34205 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34206 .cindex "mailing lists"
34207 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34208 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34209 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34210
34211 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34212 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34213 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34214 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34215 .code
34216 lists:
34217 driver = redirect
34218 domains = lists.example
34219 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34220 forbid_pipe
34221 forbid_file
34222 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34223 no_more
34224 .endd
34225 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34226 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34227 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34228 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34229
34230 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34231 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34232 a mailing list.
34233
34234 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34235 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34236 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34237 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34238 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34239
34240 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34241 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34242 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34243 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34244 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34245 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34246 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34247 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34248 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34249
34250
34251
34252 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34253 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34254 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34255 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34256 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34257 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34258 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34259
34260 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34261 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34262 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34263 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34264 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34265
34266
34267
34268 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34269 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34270 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34271 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34272 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34273 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34274 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34275 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34276 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34277 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34278
34279 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34280 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34281 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34282 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34283 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34284 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34285 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34286 pre-existing messages.
34287
34288 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34289 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34290 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34291 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34292 one level of expansion anyway.
34293
34294
34295
34296 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34297 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34298 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34299 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34300 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34301 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34302
34303 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34304 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34305 .code
34306 lists_request:
34307 driver = redirect
34308 domains = lists.example
34309 local_part_suffix = -request
34310 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34311 no_more
34312
34313 lists_post:
34314 driver = redirect
34315 domains = lists.example
34316 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34317 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34318 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34319 forbid_pipe
34320 forbid_file
34321 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34322 no_more
34323
34324 lists_closed:
34325 driver = redirect
34326 domains = lists.example
34327 allow_fail
34328 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34329 .endd
34330 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34331 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34332 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34333 mailing list.
34334
34335 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34336 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34337 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34338 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34339 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34340 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34341 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34342 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34343 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34344
34345 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34346 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34347 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34348
34349
34350
34351
34352 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34353 .cindex "VERP"
34354 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34355 .cindex "envelope sender"
34356 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34357 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34358 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34359 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34360 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34361 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34362
34363 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34364 .oindex &%return_path%&
34365 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34366 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34367 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34368 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34369 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34370 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34371 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34372 .code
34373 verp_smtp:
34374 driver = smtp
34375 max_rcpt = 1
34376 return_path = \
34377 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34378 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34379 .endd
34380 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34381 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34382 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34383 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34384 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34385 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34386 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34387 rewritten as
34388 .code
34389 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34390 .endd
34391 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34392 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34393 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34394 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34395 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34396 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34397
34398 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34399 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34400 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34401 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34402 .code
34403 dnslookup:
34404 driver = dnslookup
34405 domains = ! +local_domains
34406 transport = \
34407 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34408 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34409 no_more
34410 .endd
34411 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34412 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34413 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34414 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34415 address.
34416
34417 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34418 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34419 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34420 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34421 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34422 .code
34423 verp_dnslookup:
34424 driver = dnslookup
34425 domains = ! +local_domains
34426 transport = remote_smtp
34427 errors_to = \
34428 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34429 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34430 no_more
34431 .endd
34432 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34433 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34434 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34435 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34436 them.
34437
34438 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34439 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34440 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34441 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34442 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34443 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34444 used).
34445
34446
34447
34448
34449
34450
34451 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34452 .cindex "virtual domains"
34453 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34454 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34455 meanings:
34456
34457 .ilist
34458 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34459 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34460 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34461 .next
34462 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34463 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34464 have login accounts on that host.
34465 .endlist
34466
34467 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34468 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34469 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34470 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34471 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34472 to a router of this form:
34473 .code
34474 virtual:
34475 driver = redirect
34476 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34477 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34478 no_more
34479 .endd
34480 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34481 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34482 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34483 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34484 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34485 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34486
34487 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34488 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34489 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34490 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34491
34492 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34493 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34494 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34495 .code
34496 my_domains:
34497 driver = accept
34498 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34499 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34500 transport = my_mailboxes
34501 .endd
34502 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34503 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34504 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34505 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34506 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34507 follows:
34508 .code
34509 my_mailboxes:
34510 driver = appendfile
34511 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34512 user = mail
34513 .endd
34514 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34515 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34516
34517 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34518 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34519 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34520 information about the domains.
34521
34522
34523
34524 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34525 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34526 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34527 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34528 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34529 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34530 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34531 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34532 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34533 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34534 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34535 example, consider this router:
34536 .code
34537 userforward:
34538 driver = redirect
34539 check_local_user
34540 file = $home/.forward
34541 local_part_suffix = -*
34542 local_part_suffix_optional
34543 allow_filter
34544 .endd
34545 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34546 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34547 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34548 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34549 .code
34550 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34551 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34552 endif
34553 .endd
34554 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34555 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34556 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34557 control over which suffixes are valid.
34558
34559 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34560 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34561 another MTA:
34562 .code
34563 userforward:
34564 driver = redirect
34565 check_local_user
34566 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34567 local_part_suffix = -*
34568 local_part_suffix_optional
34569 allow_filter
34570 .endd
34571 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34572 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34573 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34574 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34575 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34576
34577
34578
34579 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34580 .cindex "vacation processing"
34581 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34582 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34583 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34584 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34585 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34586
34587 .ilist
34588 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34589 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34590 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34591 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34592 .code
34593 spqr, vacation-spqr
34594 .endd
34595 .next
34596 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34597 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34598 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34599 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34600 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34601 message.
34602 .endlist
34603
34604 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34605 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34606
34607
34608
34609 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34610 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34611 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34612 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34613 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34614 each day's messages.
34615
34616 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34617 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34618 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34619 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34620
34621
34622
34623 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34624 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34625 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34626 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34627 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34628 permanently connected.
34629
34630 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34631 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34632 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34633
34634
34635 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34636 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34637 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34638 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34639 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34640 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34641 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34642 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34643
34644 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34645 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34646 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34647 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34648 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34649 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34650 if required.
34651
34652 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34653 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34654 intermittent host. For example:
34655 .code
34656 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34657 .endd
34658 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34659 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34660 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34661 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34662 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34663 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34664 immediately.
34665
34666 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34667 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34668 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34669 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34670 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34671 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34672 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34673
34674
34675
34676 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34677 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34678 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34679 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34680 delivered immediately.
34681
34682 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34683 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34684 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34685 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34686 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34687 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34688 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34689 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34690 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34691 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34692 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34693 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34694 single SMTP connection.
34695
34696
34697
34698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34700
34701 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34702 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34703 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34704 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34705 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34706 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34707 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34708 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34709 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34710 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34711 messages this way.
34712
34713 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34714 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34715 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34716 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34717 email is not desirable.
34718
34719 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34720 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34721 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34722 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34723 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34724 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34725 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34726
34727 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34728 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34729 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34730 before sending a message to the smart host.
34731
34732 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34733 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34734 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34735
34736 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34737 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34738 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34739 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34740 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34741 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34742 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34743
34744 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34745 following ways:
34746
34747 .ilist
34748 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34749 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34750 .next
34751 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34752 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34753 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34754 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34755 successful, a zero return code is given.
34756 .next
34757 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34758 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34759 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34760 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34761 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34762 are.
34763 .next
34764 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34765 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34766 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34767 .next
34768 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34769 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34770 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34771 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34772 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34773 .next
34774 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34775 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34776 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34777 .next
34778 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34779 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34780 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34781 are ever generated.
34782 .next
34783 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34784 .next
34785 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34786 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34787 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34788 .endlist
34789
34790 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34791 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34792 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34793 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34794 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34795 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34796
34797
34798
34799
34800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34802
34803 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34804 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34805 .cindex "log" "types of"
34806 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34807 and the panic log:
34808
34809 .ilist
34810 .cindex "main log"
34811 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34812 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34813 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34814 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34815 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34816 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34817 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34818 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34819 .next
34820 .cindex "reject log"
34821 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34822 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34823 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34824 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34825 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34826 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34827 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34828 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34829 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34830 false.
34831 .next
34832 .cindex "panic log"
34833 .cindex "system log"
34834 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34835 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34836 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34837 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34838 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34839 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34840 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34841 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34842 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34843 .endlist
34844
34845 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34846 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34847 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34848 .code
34849 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34850 by QUIT
34851 .endd
34852 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34853 ways of changing this:
34854
34855 .ilist
34856 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34857 you set
34858 .code
34859 timezone = UTC
34860 .endd
34861 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34862 .next
34863 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34864 example:
34865 .code
34866 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34867 .endd
34868 .endlist
34869
34870 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34871 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34872 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34873 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34874 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34875 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34876
34877
34878
34879
34880 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34881 .cindex "log" "destination"
34882 .cindex "log" "to file"
34883 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34884 .cindex "syslog"
34885 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34886 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34887 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34888 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34889 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34890 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34891 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34892
34893 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34894 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34895 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34896 references to the host name:
34897 .code
34898 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34899 .endd
34900 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34901 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34902 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34903 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34904 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34905 log at all.
34906
34907 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34908 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34909 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34910 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34911 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34912 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34913 implying the use of a default path.
34914
34915 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34916 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34917 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34918 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34919 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34920 equivalent to the setting:
34921 .code
34922 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34923 .endd
34924 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34925 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34926 that is where the logs are written.
34927
34928 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34929 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34930
34931 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34932 .display
34933 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34934 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34935 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34936 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34937 .endd
34938 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34939 error is logged.
34940
34941
34942
34943 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34944 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34945 .cindex "cycling logs"
34946 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34947 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34948 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34949 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34950 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34951 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34952 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34953
34954 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34955 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34956 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34957 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34958 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34959 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34960 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34961 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34962 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34963 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34964 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34965 renamed.
34966
34967
34968
34969 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34970 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34971 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34972 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34973 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34974 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34975 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34976 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34977 .code
34978 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34979 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34980 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34981 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34982 .endd
34983 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34984 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34985 .code
34986 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34987 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34988 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34989 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34990 .endd
34991 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34992 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34993 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34994 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34995
34996 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34997 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34998 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34999 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35000 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35001 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35002 log names:
35003 .code
35004 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35005 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35006 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35007 /var/log/exim/panic
35008 .endd
35009
35010
35011 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35012 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35013 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35014 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35015 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35016 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35017 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35018 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35019 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35020 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35021 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35022 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35023 the time and host name to each line.
35024 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35025
35026 .ilist
35027 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35028 .next
35029 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35030 .next
35031 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35032 .endlist
35033
35034 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35035 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35036 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35037 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35038
35039 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35040 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35041 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35042 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35043 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35044 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35045 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35046 RFC 3164, you should set
35047 .code
35048 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35049 .endd
35050 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35051 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35052
35053 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35054 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35055 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35056 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35057 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35058 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35059 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35060 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35061 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35062 .code
35063 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35064 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35065 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35066 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35067 [5/5] mple>)
35068 .endd
35069 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35070 (LOG_NOTICE):
35071 .code
35072 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35073 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35074 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35075 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35076 [5\18] .example>)
35077 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35078 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35079 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35080 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35081 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35082 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35083 [12\18] F From: <>
35084 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35085 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35086 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35087 [16\18] le>
35088 [17\18] B Bcc:
35089 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35090 .endd
35091 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35092 without modification.
35093
35094 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35095 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35096 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35097 where it is.
35098
35099
35100
35101 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35102 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35103 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35104 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35105 timestamp. The flags are:
35106 .display
35107 &`<=`& message arrival
35108 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35109 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35110 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35111 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35112 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35113 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35114 .endd
35115
35116
35117 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35118 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35119 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35120 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35121 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35122 .code
35123 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35124 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35125 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35126 .endd
35127 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35128 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35129 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35130 .code
35131 R=<message id>
35132 .endd
35133 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35134
35135 .cindex "HELO"
35136 .cindex "EHLO"
35137 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35138 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35139 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35140 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35141 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35142 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35143 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35144 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35145 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35146 name in parentheses.
35147
35148 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35149 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35150 the log containing text like these examples:
35151 .code
35152 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35153 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35154 .endd
35155 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35156 on.
35157
35158 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35159 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35160 of Exim.
35161
35162 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35163 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35164 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35165 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35166 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35167 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35168 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35169 suite that was used.
35170
35171 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35172 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35173 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35174 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35175 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35176 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35177 authenticator name.
35178
35179 .cindex "size" "of message"
35180 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35181 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35182 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35183 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35184 other).
35185
35186 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35187 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35188
35189
35190
35191 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35192 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35193 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35194 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35195 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35196 to fit it on the page:
35197 .code
35198 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35199 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35200 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35201 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35202 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35203 .endd
35204 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35205 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35206 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35207 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35208 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35209
35210 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35211 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35212 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35213 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35214
35215 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35216 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35217 .display
35218 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35219 .endd
35220 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35221 parentheses afterwards.
35222
35223 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35224 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35225 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35226 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35227 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35228 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35229
35230 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35231 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35232 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35233 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35234 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35235
35236 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35237 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35238
35239 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35240 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35241
35242
35243 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35244 .cindex "discarded messages"
35245 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35246 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35247 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35248 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35249 .code
35250 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35251 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35252 .endd
35253 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35254 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35255 .code
35256 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35257 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35258 .endd
35259
35260
35261 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35262 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35263 .code
35264 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35265 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35266 .endd
35267 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35268 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35269 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35270 .code
35271 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35272 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35273 .endd
35274 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35275 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35276 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35277
35278
35279
35280 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35281 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35282 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35283 following form is logged:
35284 .code
35285 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35286 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35287 .endd
35288 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35289 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35290 .code
35291 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35292 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35293 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35294 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35295 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35296 .endd
35297 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35298 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35299 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35300 flagged with &`**`&.
35301
35302
35303
35304 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35305 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35306 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35307 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35308 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35309
35310
35311
35312 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35313 A line of the form
35314 .code
35315 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35316 .endd
35317 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35318 at the end of its processing.
35319
35320
35321
35322
35323 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35324 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35325 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35326 the following table:
35327 .display
35328 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35329 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35330 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35331 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35332 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35333 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35334 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35335 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35336 &`H `& host name and IP address
35337 &`I `& local interface used
35338 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35339 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35340 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35341 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35342 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35343 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35344 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35345 &`S `& size of message
35346 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35347 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35348 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35349 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35350 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35351 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35352 .endd
35353
35354
35355 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35356 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35357 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35358
35359 .ilist
35360 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35361 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35362 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35363 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35364 during the first delivery attempt.
35365 .next
35366 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35367 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35368 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35369 .next
35370 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35371 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35372 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35373 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35374 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35375 doing.
35376 .next
35377 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35378 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35379 message:
35380 .olist
35381 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35382 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35383 .next
35384 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35385 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35386 .next
35387 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35388 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35389 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35390 .code
35391 errors_to = <>
35392 .endd
35393 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35394 .endlist olist
35395 .endlist ilist
35396
35397
35398
35399
35400
35401 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35402 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35403 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35404 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35405 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35406 example:
35407 .code
35408 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35409 .endd
35410 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35411 selection marked by asterisks:
35412 .display
35413 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35414 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35415 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35416 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35417 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35418 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35419 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35420 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35421 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35422 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35423 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35424 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35425 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35426 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35427 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35428 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35429 .new
35430 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35431 .wen
35432 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35433 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35434 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35435 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35436 &` pid `& Exim process id
35437 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35438 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35439 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35440 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35441 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35442 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35443 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35444 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35445 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35446 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35447 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35448 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35449 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35450 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35451 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35452 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35453 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35454 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35455 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35456 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35457 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35458 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35459
35460 &` all `& all of the above
35461 .endd
35462 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35463 section &<<SECID99>>&
35464
35465 More details on each of these items follows:
35466
35467 .ilist
35468 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35469 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35470 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35471 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35472 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35473 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35474 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35475 .next
35476 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35477 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35478 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35479 this log selector is set.
35480 .next
35481 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35482 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35483 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35484 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35485 such users cannot access the log).
35486 .next
35487 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35488 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35489 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35490 parentheses between them.
35491 .next
35492 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35493 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35494 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35495 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35496 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35497 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35498 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35499 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35500 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35501 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35502 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35503 between the caller and Exim.
35504 .next
35505 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35506 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35507 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35508 .next
35509 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35510 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35511 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35512 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35513 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35514 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35515 .next
35516 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35517 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35518 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35519 .next
35520 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35521 .cindex "size" "of message"
35522 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35523 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35524 .next
35525 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35526 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35527 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35528 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35529 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35530 .next
35531 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35532 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35533 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35534 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35535 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35536 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35537 .next
35538 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35539 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35540 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35541 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35542 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35543 .next
35544 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35545 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35546 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35547 client's ident port times out.
35548 .next
35549 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35550 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35551 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35552 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35553 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35554 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35555 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35556 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35557 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35558 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35559 .new
35560 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35561 .wen
35562 .next
35563 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35564 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35565 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35566 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35567 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35568 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35569 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35570 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35571 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35572 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35573 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35574 .next
35575 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35576 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35577 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35578 .next
35579 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35580 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35581 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35582 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35583 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35584 .new
35585 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35586 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35587 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35588 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35589 .wen
35590 .next
35591 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35592 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35593 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35594 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35595 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35596 .new
35597 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35598 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35599 .wen
35600 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35601 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35602 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35603 .next
35604 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35605 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35606 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35607 immediately after the time and date.
35608 .next
35609 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35610 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35611 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35612 .next
35613 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35614 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35615 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35616 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35617 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35618 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35619 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35620 message has been successfully received.
35621 .next
35622 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35623 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35624 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35625 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35626 .next
35627 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35628 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35629 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35630 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35631 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35632 has taken place.
35633 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35634 in the list.
35635 .next
35636 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35637 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35638 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35639 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35640 .next
35641 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35642 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35643 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35644 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35645 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35646 .next
35647 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35648 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35649 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35650 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35651 attempt.
35652 .next
35653 .cindex "log" "return path"
35654 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35655 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35656 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35657 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35658 .next
35659 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35660 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35661 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35662 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35663 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35664 .next
35665 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35666 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35667 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35668 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35669 detail is lost.
35670 .next
35671 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35672 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35673 it is too big.
35674 .next
35675 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35676 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35677 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35678 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35679 it.
35680 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35681 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35682 .next
35683 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35684 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35685 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35686 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35687 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35688 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35689 response.
35690 .next
35691 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35692 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35693 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35694 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35695 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35696 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35697 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35698 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35699 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35700 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35701
35702 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35703 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35704 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35705 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35706 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35707 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35708 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35709 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35710 .next
35711 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35712 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35713 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35714 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35715 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35716 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35717 .next
35718 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35719 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35720 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35721 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35722 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35723 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35724 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35725 already have their own log lines.
35726
35727 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35728 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35729 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35730 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35731 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35732 the same logging options.
35733
35734 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35735 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35736 .code
35737 C=EHLO,QUIT
35738 .endd
35739 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35740 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35741 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35742 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35743 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35744 .next
35745 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35746 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35747 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35748 was accepted or used.
35749 .next
35750 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35751 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35752 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35753 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35754 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35755 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35756 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35757 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35758 .next
35759 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35760 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35761 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35762 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35763 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35764 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35765 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35766 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35767 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35768 .next
35769 .cindex "log" "subject"
35770 .cindex "subject, logging"
35771 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35772 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35773 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35774 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35775 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35776 .next
35777 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35778 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35779 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35780 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35781 .next
35782 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35783 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35784 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35785 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35786 .next
35787 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35788 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35789 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35790 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35791 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35792 .next
35793 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35794 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35795 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35796 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35797 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35798 .next
35799 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35800 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35801 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35802 .endlist
35803
35804
35805 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35806 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35807 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35808 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35809 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35810 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35811 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35812 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35813 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35814 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35815 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35816 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35817 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35818
35819 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35820 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35821 &%message_logs%& option false.
35822 .ecindex IIDloggen
35823
35824
35825
35826
35827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35829
35830 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35831 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35832 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35833 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35834 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35835
35836 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35837 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35838 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35839 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35840 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35841 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35842 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35843 various criteria"
35844 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35845 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35846 "extract statistics from the log"
35847 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35848 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35849 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35850 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35851 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35852 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35853 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35854 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35855 .endtable
35856
35857 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35858 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35859 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35860
35861
35862
35863
35864 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35865 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35866 .cindex "process, querying"
35867 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35868 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35869 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35870 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35871 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35872 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35873 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35874 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35875 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35876
35877 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35878 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35879 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35880
35881
35882 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35883 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35884 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35885 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35886 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35887 options:
35888 .display
35889 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35890 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35891 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35892 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35893 .endd
35894 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35895 .code
35896 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35897 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35898 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35899 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35900 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35901 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35902 .endd
35903 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35904 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35905
35906
35907
35908 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35909 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35910 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35911 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35912 .code
35913 exim -bpu
35914 .endd
35915 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35916 .code
35917 exim -bp
35918 .endd
35919 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35920 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35921
35922 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35923 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35924
35925 .vlist
35926 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35927 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35928 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35929 .code
35930 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35931 .endd
35932 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35933 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35934 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35935
35936 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35937 Match against the size field.
35938
35939 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35940 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35941
35942 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35943 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35944
35945 .vitem &*-z*&
35946 Match only frozen messages.
35947
35948 .vitem &*-x*&
35949 Match only non-frozen messages.
35950 .endlist
35951
35952 The following options control the format of the output:
35953
35954 .vlist
35955 .vitem &*-c*&
35956 Display only the count of matching messages.
35957
35958 .vitem &*-l*&
35959 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35960 the default.
35961
35962 .vitem &*-i*&
35963 Display message ids only.
35964
35965 .vitem &*-b*&
35966 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35967
35968 .vitem &*-R*&
35969 Display messages in reverse order.
35970
35971 .vitem &*-a*&
35972 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35973 .endlist
35974
35975 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35976
35977
35978
35979 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35980 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35981 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35982 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35983 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35984 running a command such as
35985 .code
35986 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35987 .endd
35988 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35989 it, as in the following example:
35990 .code
35991 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35992 .endd
35993 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35994 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35995 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35996 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35997
35998 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35999 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36000 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36001 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36002 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36003 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36004 sender.
36005
36006 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36007 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36008 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36009 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36010 level"& addresses).
36011
36012
36013
36014
36015 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36016 "SECTextspeinf"
36017 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36018 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36019 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36020 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36021 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36022 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36023 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36024 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36025 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36026 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36027 .display
36028 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36029 .endd
36030 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36031
36032 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36033 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36034 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36035
36036 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36037 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36038 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36039 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36040 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36041
36042 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36043 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36044 regular expression.
36045
36046 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36047 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36048
36049 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36050 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36051 normally.
36052
36053 Example of &%-M%&:
36054 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36055 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36056 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36057 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36058 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36059 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36060 search term.
36061
36062 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36063 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36064 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36065 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36066 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36067
36068
36069 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36070 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36071 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36072 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36073 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36074 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36075 the &%--help%& option.
36076
36077
36078 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36079 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36080 .cindex "cycling logs"
36081 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36082 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36083 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36084 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36085 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36086 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36087 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36088 .ilist
36089 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36090 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36091 .next
36092 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36093 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36094 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36095 configuration.
36096 .endlist
36097
36098 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36099 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36100 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36101 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36102 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36103 logs are handled similarly.
36104
36105 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36106 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36107 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36108 any existing log files.
36109
36110 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36111 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36112 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36113 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36114 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36115 .code
36116 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36117 .endd
36118 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36119 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36120
36121
36122
36123 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36124 .cindex "statistics"
36125 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36126 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36127 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36128 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36129 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36130
36131 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36132 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36133 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36134 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36135 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36136 .code
36137 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36138 .endd
36139 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36140 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36141 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36142 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36143 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36144 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36145 also produced per user.
36146
36147 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36148 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36149 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36150 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36151 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36152
36153 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36154 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36155 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36156 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36157 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36158 an entirely separate message.
36159
36160 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36161 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36162 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36163 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36164 least one address that failed.
36165
36166 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36167 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36168 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36169 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36170 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36171 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36172 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36173
36174 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36175 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36176 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36177
36178 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36179 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36180 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36181 .code
36182 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36183 .endd
36184
36185 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36186 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36187 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36188 .cindex "checking access"
36189 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36190 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36191 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36192 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36193 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36194 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36195
36196 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36197 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36198 .code
36199 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36200 .endd
36201 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36202 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36203 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36204 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36205 .code
36206 Rejected:
36207 550 Relay not permitted
36208 .endd
36209 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36210 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36211 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36212 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36213 you can use:
36214 .code
36215 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36216 -f himself@there.example
36217 .endd
36218 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36219 mandatory arguments.
36220
36221 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36222 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36223 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36224
36225
36226
36227 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36228 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36229 .cindex "building DBM files"
36230 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36231 .cindex "lower casing"
36232 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36233 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36234 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36235 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36236 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36237 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36238
36239 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36240 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36241 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36242 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36243 files.
36244
36245 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36246 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36247 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36248 well.
36249
36250 .cindex "USE_DB"
36251 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36252 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36253 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36254 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36255 .code
36256 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36257 .endd
36258 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36259 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36260
36261 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36262 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36263 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36264 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36265 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36266 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36267
36268 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36269 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36270 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36271 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36272 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36273 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36274 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36275 return code is 2.
36276
36277
36278
36279
36280 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36281 .cindex "retry" "times"
36282 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36283 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36284 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36285 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36286 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36287 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36288 output. For example:
36289 .code
36290 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36291 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36292 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36293 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36294 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36295 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36296 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36297 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36298 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36299 past final cutoff time
36300 .endd
36301 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36302 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36303 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36304 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36305 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36306 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36307 run very often.
36308
36309 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36310 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36311 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36312 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36313 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36314 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36315
36316
36317
36318 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36319 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36320 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36321 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36322 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36323 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36324 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36325
36326 .ilist
36327 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36328 .next
36329 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36330 for remote hosts
36331 .next
36332 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36333 .next
36334 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36335 .next
36336 &'misc'&: other hints data
36337 .endlist
36338
36339 The &'misc'& database is used for
36340
36341 .ilist
36342 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36343 .next
36344 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36345 &(smtp)& transport)
36346 .next
36347 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36348 in a transport)
36349 .endlist
36350
36351
36352
36353 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36354 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36355 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36356 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36357 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36358 .code
36359 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36360 .endd
36361 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36362 .code
36363 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36364 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36365 .endd
36366 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36367 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36368 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36369 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36370 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36371 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36372 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36373 and a textual description of the error.
36374
36375 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36376 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36377 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36378 exceeded.
36379
36380 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36381 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36382 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36383 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36384 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36385 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36386 cross-references.
36387
36388
36389
36390 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36391 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36392 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36393 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36394 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36395 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36396 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36397 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36398 updated sufficiently often.
36399
36400 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36401 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36402 the retry database:
36403 .code
36404 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36405 .endd
36406 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36407 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36408 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36409 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36410 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36411 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36412 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36413 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36414 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36415 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36416 whenever it removes information from the database.
36417
36418 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36419 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36420 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36421 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36422 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36423
36424 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36425 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36426 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36427 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36428 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36429 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36430 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36431 tidied.
36432
36433 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36434 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36435
36436
36437
36438
36439 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36440 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36441 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36442 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36443 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36444 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36445 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36446 displayed.
36447
36448 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36449 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36450 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36451 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36452 by new data, for example:
36453 .code
36454 > 4 951102:1000
36455 .endd
36456 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36457 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36458 used as optional separators.
36459
36460
36461
36462
36463 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36464 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36465 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36466 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36467 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36468 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36469 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36470 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36471 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36472 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36473 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36474 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36475 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36476
36477 .vlist
36478 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36479 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36480
36481 .vitem &%-flock%&
36482 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36483 supports it.
36484
36485 .vitem &%-interval%&
36486 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36487 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36488
36489 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36490 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36491
36492 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36493 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36494
36495 .vitem &%-q%&
36496 Suppress verification output.
36497
36498 .vitem &%-retries%&
36499 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36500 the lock (default 10).
36501
36502 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36503 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36504 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36505 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36506 subsequently sees.
36507
36508 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36509 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36510 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36511 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36512
36513 .vitem &%-v%&
36514 Generate verbose output.
36515 .endlist
36516
36517 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36518 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36519 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36520 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36521 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36522 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36523 more than 30 minutes old.
36524
36525 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36526 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36527 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36528 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36529 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36530 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36531
36532 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36533 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36534 suppresses all output except error messages.
36535
36536 A command such as
36537 .code
36538 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36539 .endd
36540 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36541 .display
36542 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36543 <&'some commands'&>
36544 &`End`&
36545 .endd
36546 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36547 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36548 such as
36549 .code
36550 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36551 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36552 .endd
36553 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36554 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36555 .ecindex IIDutils
36556
36557
36558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36560
36561 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36562 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36563 .cindex "X-windows"
36564 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36565 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36566 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36567 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36568 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36569 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36570 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36571 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36572
36573
36574
36575 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36576 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36577 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36578 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36579 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36580 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36581 parameters are for.
36582
36583 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36584 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36585 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36586 .code
36587 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36588 .endd
36589 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36590 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36591 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36592 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36593 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36594
36595 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36596 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36597 .code
36598 Eximon*background: gray94
36599 .endd
36600 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36601 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36602 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36603 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36604 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36605 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36606 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36607 .code
36608 xrdb -merge <<End
36609 Eximon*highlight: gray
36610 End
36611 .endd
36612 .cindex "admin user"
36613 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36614 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36615
36616 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36617 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36618 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36619 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36620 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36621
36622 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36623 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36624 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36625 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36626 different parts of the display.
36627
36628
36629
36630
36631 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36632 .cindex "stripchart"
36633 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36634 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36635 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36636 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36637 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36638 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36639 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36640 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36641 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36642
36643 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36644 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36645 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36646 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36647
36648 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36649 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36650 to a single partition.
36651
36652 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36653 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36654 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36655 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36656 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36657 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36658 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36659
36660
36661
36662
36663 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36664 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36665 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36666 .cindex "window size"
36667 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36668 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36669 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36670 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36671 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36672 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36673
36674 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36675 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36676 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36677 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36678
36679 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36680 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36681 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36682 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36683 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36684 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36685
36686 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36687 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36688 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36689
36690
36691
36692 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36693 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36694 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36695 the main log is maintained.
36696 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36697 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36698 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36699 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36700 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36701
36702 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36703 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36704 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36705 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36706 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36707 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36708 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36709 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36710 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36711 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36712 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36713
36714 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36715 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36716 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36717 It cannot go further back up the log.
36718
36719 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36720 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36721 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36722 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36723 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36724 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36725
36726 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36727 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36728 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36729 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36730 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36731 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36732
36733 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36734 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36735 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36736 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36737 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36738 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36739 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36740 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36741 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36742 window.
36743
36744
36745
36746 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36747 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36748 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36749 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36750 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36751 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36752 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36753 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36754 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36755 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36756
36757 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36758 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36759 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36760 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36761 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36762 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36763 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36764
36765 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36766 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36767 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36768 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36769 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36770 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36771 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36772
36773 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36774 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36775 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36776 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36777
36778 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36779 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36780 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36781 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36782 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36783 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36784 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36785 not shown.
36786
36787 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36788 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36789
36790 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36791 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36792 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36793 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36794 display is updated.
36795
36796
36797
36798 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36799 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36800 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36801 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36802 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36803 any selected text.
36804
36805 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36806 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36807 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36808 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36809 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36810 .code
36811 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36812 .endd
36813 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36814 follows:
36815
36816 .ilist
36817 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36818 in a new text window.
36819 .next
36820 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36821 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36822 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36823 .next
36824 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36825 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36826 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36827 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36828 .next
36829 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36830 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36831 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36832 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36833 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36834 .next
36835 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36836 that the message be frozen.
36837 .next
36838 .cindex "thawing messages"
36839 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36840 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36841 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36842 that the message be thawed.
36843 .next
36844 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36845 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36846 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36847 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36848 .next
36849 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36850 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36851 message.
36852 .next
36853 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36854 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36855 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36856 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36857 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36858 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36859 which case no action is taken.
36860 .next
36861 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36862 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36863 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36864 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36865 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36866 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36867 case no action is taken.
36868 .next
36869 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36870 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36871 .next
36872 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36873 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36874 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36875 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36876 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36877 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36878 the address is qualified with that domain.
36879 .endlist
36880
36881 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36882 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36883 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36884 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36885 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36886 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36887 if no output is generated.
36888
36889 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36890 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36891 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36892 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36893
36894 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36895 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36896 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36897 .ecindex IIDeximon
36898
36899
36900
36901
36902
36903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36905
36906 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36907 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36908 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36909 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36910
36911 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36912 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36913 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36914 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36915 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36916 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36917
36918 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36919 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36920 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36921 as soon as possible.
36922
36923
36924 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36925 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36926 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36927 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36928 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36929 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36930
36931 .ilist
36932 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36933 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36934 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36935 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36936 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36937 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36938
36939 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36940 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36941 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36942 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36943 .next
36944
36945 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36946 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36947 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36948 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36949 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36950 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36951 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36952 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36953 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36954 separate commands.
36955
36956 .next
36957 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36958 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36959 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36960 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36961 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36962 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36963 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36964 .next
36965 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36966 is disabled.
36967 .next
36968 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36969 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36970 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36971 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36972 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36973 .endlist
36974
36975
36976
36977 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36978 .cindex "setuid"
36979 .cindex "root privilege"
36980 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36981 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36982 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36983 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36984 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36985 is required for two things:
36986
36987 .ilist
36988 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36989 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36990 not required.
36991 .next
36992 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36993 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36994 configuration.
36995 .endlist
36996
36997 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36998 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36999 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37000 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37001 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37002 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37003 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37004 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37005
37006 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37007 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37008 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37009
37010 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37011 uid and gid in the following cases:
37012
37013 .ilist
37014 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37015 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37016 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37017 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37018 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37019 the calling process.
37020 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37021 option may not be used at all.
37022 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37023 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37024 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37025 .next
37026 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37027 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37028 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37029 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37030 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37031 calling process.
37032 .next
37033 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37034 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37035 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37036 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37037 testing address verification
37038 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37039 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37040 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37041 option).
37042 .next
37043 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37044 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37045 .endlist
37046
37047 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37048
37049 .ilist
37050 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37051 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37052 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37053 will be used during message reception.
37054 .next
37055 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37056 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37057 .next
37058 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37059 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37060 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37061 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37062 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37063 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37064 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37065 generating bounce and warning messages.
37066
37067 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37068 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37069 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37070 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37071 .next
37072 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37073 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37074 .endlist
37075
37076
37077
37078
37079 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37080 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37081 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37082 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37083 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37084 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37085 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37086 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37087 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37088 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37089 to any other uid.
37090
37091 .cindex SIGHUP
37092 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37093 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37094 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37095 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37096
37097 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37098 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37099 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37100 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37101 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37102
37103 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37104 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37105 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37106 effect.
37107
37108 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37109 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37110 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37111
37112 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37113 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37114 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37115 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37116 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37117 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37118 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37119 address this problem at this time.
37120
37121 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37122 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37123 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37124 be used in the most straightforward way.
37125
37126 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37127 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37128
37129 .ilist
37130 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37131 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37132 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37133 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37134 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37135 .next
37136 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37137 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37138 .next
37139 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37140 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37141 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37142 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37143 .next
37144 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37145 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37146
37147 .olist
37148 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37149 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37150 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37151 .next
37152 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37153 owned by the Exim user.
37154 .next
37155 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37156 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37157 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37158 .endlist olist
37159 .endlist ilist
37160
37161
37162 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37163 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37164 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37165 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37166
37167 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37168 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37169
37170
37171
37172
37173 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37174 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37175 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37176
37177
37178
37179 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37180 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37181 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37182 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37183 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37184 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37185 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37186
37187 .ilist
37188 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37189 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37190 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37191 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37192 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37193 .next
37194 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37195 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37196 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37197 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37198 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37199 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37200 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37201 .next
37202 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37203 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37204 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37205 .next
37206 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37207 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37208 .next
37209 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37210 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37211 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37212 .next
37213 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37214 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37215 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37216 of opaque strings.
37217 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37218 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37219 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37220 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37221 .endlist
37222
37223
37224
37225
37226 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37227 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37228 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37229 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37230 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37231 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37232 are some issues to be aware of:
37233
37234 .ilist
37235 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37236 .next
37237 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37238 .next
37239 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37240 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37241 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37242 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37243 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37244 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37245 data.
37246 .next
37247 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37248 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37249 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37250 .next
37251 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37252 expected to yield one result.
37253 .endlist
37254
37255
37256
37257
37258 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37259 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37260 .cindex "IP source routing"
37261 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37262 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37263 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37264 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37265
37266
37267
37268 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37269 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37270 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37271
37272
37273
37274
37275 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37276 .cindex "trusted users"
37277 .cindex "admin user"
37278 .cindex "privileged user"
37279 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37280 .cindex "user" "admin"
37281 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37282 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37283 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37284 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37285 permit a remote host to be specified.
37286
37287 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37288 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37289 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37290 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37291 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37292 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37293 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37294
37295 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37296 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37297 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37298 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37299 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37300
37301 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37302 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37303 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37304 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37305 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37306
37307 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37308 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37309 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37310 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37311 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37312 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37313 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37314 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37315
37316 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37317 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37318 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37319 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37320 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37321 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37322 files.
37323
37324
37325
37326 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37327 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37328 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37329 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37330 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37331 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37332
37333
37334
37335 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37336 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37337 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37338 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37339 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37340 this.
37341
37342
37343
37344 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37345 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37346 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37347 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37348 converted output.
37349
37350
37351
37352 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37353 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37354 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37355 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37356 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37357
37358
37359
37360 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37361 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37362 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37363 loading it.
37364
37365
37366 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37367 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37368 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37369 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37370 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37371 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37372 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37373
37374 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37375 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37376 string.
37377
37378
37379
37380 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37381 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37382 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37383 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37384
37385
37386
37387 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37388 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37389 enough to hold the result.
37390 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37391
37392
37393
37394
37395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37397
37398 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37399 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37400 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37401 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37402 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37403 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37404 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37405 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37406 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37407 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37408 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37409 themselves are recoverable.
37410
37411 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37412 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37413 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37414
37415 .ilist
37416 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37417 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37418 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37419 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37420 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37421 .next
37422 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37423 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37424 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37425 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37426 will always be the case.
37427 .next
37428 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37429 .next
37430 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37431 signature.
37432 .endlist
37433 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37434
37435 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37436 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37437 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37438 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37439 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37440 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37441 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37442 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37443 attempt.
37444
37445 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37446 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37447 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37448 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37449 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37450 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37451 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37452 normally the Exim user.
37453
37454 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37455 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37456 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37457 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37458 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37459 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37460 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37461 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37462
37463 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37464 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37465 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37466 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37467
37468 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37469 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37470
37471 .vlist
37472 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37473 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37474 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37475 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37476 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37477 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37478 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37479 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37480 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37481 newlines.
37482
37483 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37484 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37485 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37486 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37487 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37488 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37489
37490 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37491 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37492 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37493 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37494 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37495 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37496
37497 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37498 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37499 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37500
37501 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37502 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37503 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37504 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37505 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37506
37507 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37508 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37509 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37510 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37511 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37512
37513 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37514 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37515 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37516
37517 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37518 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37519 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37520
37521 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37522 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37523 present.
37524
37525 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37526 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37527 present if the number is greater than zero.
37528
37529 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37530 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37531 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37532
37533 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37534 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37535 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37536
37537 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37538 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37539 command.
37540
37541 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37542 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37543 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37544 messages.
37545
37546 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37547 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37548 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37549 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37550
37551 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37552 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37553 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37554
37555 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37556 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37557 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37558 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37559 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37560 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37561
37562 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37563 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37564 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37565 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37566 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37567
37568 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37569 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37570 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37571 generated messages.
37572
37573 .vitem &%-local%&
37574 The message is from a local sender.
37575
37576 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37577 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37578
37579 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37580 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37581 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37582 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37583
37584 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37585 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37586 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37587
37588 .vitem &%-N%&
37589 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37590 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37591 &%-N%& is assumed.
37592
37593 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37594 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37595 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37596
37597 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37598 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37599 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37600
37601 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37602 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37603 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37604
37605 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37606 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37607 certificate was verified by the server.
37608
37609 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37610 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37611 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37612
37613 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37614 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37615 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37616 certificate.
37617 .endlist
37618
37619 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37620 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37621 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37622 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37623 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37624 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37625 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37626 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37627 addresses are complete.
37628
37629 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37630 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37631 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37632 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37633 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37634 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37635 .code
37636 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37637 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37638 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37639 .endd
37640 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37641 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37642 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37643 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37644 example:
37645 .code
37646 4
37647 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37648 darcy@austen.fict.example
37649 rdo@foundation
37650 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37651 .endd
37652 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37653 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37654 line is of the following form:
37655 .display
37656 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37657 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37658 .endd
37659 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37660 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37661 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37662 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37663 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37664 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37665 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37666 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37667
37668
37669 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37670 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37671 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37672 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37673 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37674 following:
37675
37676 .table2 50pt
37677 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37678 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37679 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37680 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37681 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37682 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37683 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37684 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37685 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37686 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37687 .endtable
37688
37689 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37690 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37691 typical set of headers:
37692 .code
37693 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37694 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37695 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37696 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37697 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37698 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37699 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37700 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37701 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37702 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37703 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37704 .endd
37705 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37706 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37707 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37708 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37709 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37710 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37711
37712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37714
37715 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37716 "DKIM Support"
37717 .cindex "DKIM"
37718
37719 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37720 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37721 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37722 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37723
37724 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37725 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37726
37727 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37728 .olist
37729 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37730 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37731 (including transport filters)
37732 except cutthrough delivery.
37733 .next
37734 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37735 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37736 different signature contexts.
37737 .endlist
37738
37739 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37740 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37741 Exim's standard controls.
37742
37743 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37744 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37745 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37746 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37747 .code
37748 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37749 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37750 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37751 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37752 .endd
37753 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37754 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37755 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37756 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37757 senders).
37758
37759
37760 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37761 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37762
37763 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37764 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37765
37766 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37767 MANDATORY:
37768 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37769 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37770
37771 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37772 MANDATORY:
37773 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37774 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37775 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37776 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37777
37778 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37779 MANDATORY:
37780 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37781 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37782 The result can either
37783 .ilist
37784 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37785 .next
37786 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37787 the private key.
37788 .next
37789 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37790 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37791 is set.
37792 .endlist
37793
37794 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37795 OPTIONAL:
37796 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37797 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37798 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37799 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37800
37801 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37802 OPTIONAL:
37803 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37804 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37805 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37806 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37807 variables here.
37808
37809 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37810 OPTIONAL:
37811 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37812 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37813 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37814 used.
37815
37816
37817 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37818 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37819
37820 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37821 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37822 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37823 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37824 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37825 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37826 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37827
37828 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37829 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37830 runtime of the ACL.
37831
37832 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37833 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37834 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37835 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37836
37837 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37838 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37839 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37840 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37841 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37842 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37843 it defaults as:
37844 .code
37845 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37846 .endd
37847 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37848 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37849 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37850 .code
37851 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37852 .endd
37853 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37854 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37855 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37856 .code
37857 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37858 .endd
37859
37860 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37861 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37862
37863
37864 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37865 available (from most to least important):
37866
37867
37868 .vlist
37869 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37870 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37871 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37872 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37873 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37874 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37875 .ilist
37876 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37877 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37878 .next
37879 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37880 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37881 .next
37882 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37883 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37884 .next
37885 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37886 .endlist
37887 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37888 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37889 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37890 .ilist
37891 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37892 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37893 .next
37894 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37895 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37896 .next
37897 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37898 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37899 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37900 .next
37901 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37902 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37903 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37904 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37905 .endlist
37906 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37907 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37908 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37909 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37910 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37911 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37912 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37913 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37914 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37915 The key record selector string.
37916 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37917 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37918 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37919 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37920 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37921 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37922 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37923 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37924 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37925 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37926 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37927 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37928 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37929 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37930 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37931 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37932 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37933 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37934 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37935 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37936 integer size comparisons against this value.
37937 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37938 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37939 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37940 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37941 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37942 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37943 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37944 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37945 in the key record.
37946 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37947 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37948 in the key record.
37949 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37950 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37951 .endlist
37952
37953 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37954
37955 .vlist
37956 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37957 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37958 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37959 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37960 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37961
37962 .code
37963 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37964 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37965 sender_domains = gmail.com
37966 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37967 dkim_status = none
37968 .endd
37969
37970 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37971 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37972 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37973 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37974
37975 .code
37976 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37977 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37978 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37979 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37980 .endd
37981
37982 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37983 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37984 for more information of what they mean.
37985 .endlist
37986
37987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37989
37990 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37991 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37992 .cindex "adding drivers"
37993 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37994 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37995 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37996 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37997
37998 .olist
37999 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38000 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38001 .next
38002 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38003 .display
38004 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38005 .endd
38006 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38007 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38008 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38009 .next
38010 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38011 .code
38012 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38013 .endd
38014 .next
38015 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38016 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38017 .next
38018 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38019 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38020 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38021 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38022 simple form that most lookups have.
38023 .next
38024 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38025 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38026 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38027 .next
38028 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38029 &_src_&.
38030 .next
38031 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38032 as for other drivers and lookups.
38033 .endlist
38034
38035 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38036 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38037 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38038 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38039 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38040
38041 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38042 the interface that is expected.
38043
38044
38045
38046
38047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38049
38050 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38051 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38052 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38053 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38054 . processors.
38055 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38056
38057 .literal xml
38058 <?sdop
38059 format="newpage"
38060 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38061 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38062 ?>
38063 .literal off
38064
38065 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38066 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38067 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38068
38069
38070 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38071 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////